target: remove unused event definitions
[openocd.git] / doc / openocd.texi
1 \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2 @c %**start of header
3 @setfilename openocd.info
4 @settitle OpenOCD User's Guide
5 @dircategory Development
6 @direntry
7 * OpenOCD: (openocd). OpenOCD User's Guide
8 @end direntry
9 @paragraphindent 0
10 @c %**end of header
11
12 @include version.texi
13
14 @copying
15
16 This User's Guide documents
17 release @value{VERSION},
18 dated @value{UPDATED},
19 of the Open On-Chip Debugger (OpenOCD).
20
21 @itemize @bullet
22 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008 The OpenOCD Project
23 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2007-2008 Spencer Oliver @email{spen@@spen-soft.co.uk}
24 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008-2010 Oyvind Harboe @email{oyvind.harboe@@zylin.com}
25 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008 Duane Ellis @email{openocd@@duaneellis.com}
26 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2009-2010 David Brownell
27 @end itemize
28
29 @quotation
30 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
31 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.2 or
32 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with no
33 Invariant Sections, with no Front-Cover Texts, and with no Back-Cover
34 Texts. A copy of the license is included in the section entitled ``GNU
35 Free Documentation License''.
36 @end quotation
37 @end copying
38
39 @titlepage
40 @titlefont{@emph{Open On-Chip Debugger:}}
41 @sp 1
42 @title OpenOCD User's Guide
43 @subtitle for release @value{VERSION}
44 @subtitle @value{UPDATED}
45
46 @page
47 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
48 @insertcopying
49 @end titlepage
50
51 @summarycontents
52 @contents
53
54 @ifnottex
55 @node Top
56 @top OpenOCD User's Guide
57
58 @insertcopying
59 @end ifnottex
60
61 @menu
62 * About:: About OpenOCD
63 * Developers:: OpenOCD Developer Resources
64 * Debug Adapter Hardware:: Debug Adapter Hardware
65 * About Jim-Tcl:: About Jim-Tcl
66 * Running:: Running OpenOCD
67 * OpenOCD Project Setup:: OpenOCD Project Setup
68 * Config File Guidelines:: Config File Guidelines
69 * Server Configuration:: Server Configuration
70 * Debug Adapter Configuration:: Debug Adapter Configuration
71 * Reset Configuration:: Reset Configuration
72 * TAP Declaration:: TAP Declaration
73 * CPU Configuration:: CPU Configuration
74 * Flash Commands:: Flash Commands
75 * Flash Programming:: Flash Programming
76 * PLD/FPGA Commands:: PLD/FPGA Commands
77 * General Commands:: General Commands
78 * Architecture and Core Commands:: Architecture and Core Commands
79 * JTAG Commands:: JTAG Commands
80 * Boundary Scan Commands:: Boundary Scan Commands
81 * Utility Commands:: Utility Commands
82 * TFTP:: TFTP
83 * GDB and OpenOCD:: Using GDB and OpenOCD
84 * Tcl Scripting API:: Tcl Scripting API
85 * FAQ:: Frequently Asked Questions
86 * Tcl Crash Course:: Tcl Crash Course
87 * License:: GNU Free Documentation License
88
89 @comment DO NOT use the plain word ``Index'', reason: CYGWIN filename
90 @comment case issue with ``Index.html'' and ``index.html''
91 @comment Occurs when creating ``--html --no-split'' output
92 @comment This fix is based on: http://sourceware.org/ml/binutils/2006-05/msg00215.html
93 * OpenOCD Concept Index:: Concept Index
94 * Command and Driver Index:: Command and Driver Index
95 @end menu
96
97 @node About
98 @unnumbered About
99 @cindex about
100
101 OpenOCD was created by Dominic Rath as part of a 2005 diploma thesis written
102 at the University of Applied Sciences Augsburg (@uref{http://www.hs-augsburg.de}).
103 Since that time, the project has grown into an active open-source project,
104 supported by a diverse community of software and hardware developers from
105 around the world.
106
107 @section What is OpenOCD?
108 @cindex TAP
109 @cindex JTAG
110
111 The Open On-Chip Debugger (OpenOCD) aims to provide debugging,
112 in-system programming and boundary-scan testing for embedded target
113 devices.
114
115 It does so with the assistance of a @dfn{debug adapter}, which is
116 a small hardware module which helps provide the right kind of
117 electrical signaling to the target being debugged. These are
118 required since the debug host (on which OpenOCD runs) won't
119 usually have native support for such signaling, or the connector
120 needed to hook up to the target.
121
122 Such debug adapters support one or more @dfn{transport} protocols,
123 each of which involves different electrical signaling (and uses
124 different messaging protocols on top of that signaling). There
125 are many types of debug adapter, and little uniformity in what
126 they are called. (There are also product naming differences.)
127
128 These adapters are sometimes packaged as discrete dongles, which
129 may generically be called @dfn{hardware interface dongles}.
130 Some development boards also integrate them directly, which may
131 let the development board connect directly to the debug
132 host over USB (and sometimes also to power it over USB).
133
134 For example, a @dfn{JTAG Adapter} supports JTAG
135 signaling, and is used to communicate
136 with JTAG (IEEE 1149.1) compliant TAPs on your target board.
137 A @dfn{TAP} is a ``Test Access Port'', a module which processes
138 special instructions and data. TAPs are daisy-chained within and
139 between chips and boards. JTAG supports debugging and boundary
140 scan operations.
141
142 There are also @dfn{SWD Adapters} that support Serial Wire Debug (SWD)
143 signaling to communicate with some newer ARM cores, as well as debug
144 adapters which support both JTAG and SWD transports. SWD supports only
145 debugging, whereas JTAG also supports boundary scan operations.
146
147 For some chips, there are also @dfn{Programming Adapters} supporting
148 special transports used only to write code to flash memory, without
149 support for on-chip debugging or boundary scan.
150 (At this writing, OpenOCD does not support such non-debug adapters.)
151
152
153 @b{Dongles:} OpenOCD currently supports many types of hardware dongles:
154 USB-based, parallel port-based, and other standalone boxes that run
155 OpenOCD internally. @xref{Debug Adapter Hardware}.
156
157 @b{GDB Debug:} It allows ARM7 (ARM7TDMI and ARM720t), ARM9 (ARM920T,
158 ARM922T, ARM926EJ--S, ARM966E--S), XScale (PXA25x, IXP42x), Cortex-M3
159 (Stellaris LM3, ST STM32 and Energy Micro EFM32) and Intel Quark (x10xx)
160 based cores to be debugged via the GDB protocol.
161
162 @b{Flash Programming:} Flash writing is supported for external
163 CFI-compatible NOR flashes (Intel and AMD/Spansion command set) and several
164 internal flashes (LPC1700, LPC1800, LPC2000, LPC4300, AT91SAM7, AT91SAM3U,
165 STR7x, STR9x, LM3, STM32x and EFM32). Preliminary support for various NAND flash
166 controllers (LPC3180, Orion, S3C24xx, more) is included.
167
168 @section OpenOCD Web Site
169
170 The OpenOCD web site provides the latest public news from the community:
171
172 @uref{http://openocd.org/}
173
174 @section Latest User's Guide:
175
176 The user's guide you are now reading may not be the latest one
177 available. A version for more recent code may be available.
178 Its HTML form is published regularly at:
179
180 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/html/index.html}
181
182 PDF form is likewise published at:
183
184 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/pdf/openocd.pdf}
185
186 @section OpenOCD User's Forum
187
188 There is an OpenOCD forum (phpBB) hosted by SparkFun,
189 which might be helpful to you. Note that if you want
190 anything to come to the attention of developers, you
191 should post it to the OpenOCD Developer Mailing List
192 instead of this forum.
193
194 @uref{http://forum.sparkfun.com/viewforum.php?f=18}
195
196 @section OpenOCD User's Mailing List
197
198 The OpenOCD User Mailing List provides the primary means of
199 communication between users:
200
201 @uref{https://lists.sourceforge.net/mailman/listinfo/openocd-user}
202
203 @section OpenOCD IRC
204
205 Support can also be found on irc:
206 @uref{irc://irc.freenode.net/openocd}
207
208 @node Developers
209 @chapter OpenOCD Developer Resources
210 @cindex developers
211
212 If you are interested in improving the state of OpenOCD's debugging and
213 testing support, new contributions will be welcome. Motivated developers
214 can produce new target, flash or interface drivers, improve the
215 documentation, as well as more conventional bug fixes and enhancements.
216
217 The resources in this chapter are available for developers wishing to explore
218 or expand the OpenOCD source code.
219
220 @section OpenOCD Git Repository
221
222 During the 0.3.x release cycle, OpenOCD switched from Subversion to
223 a Git repository hosted at SourceForge. The repository URL is:
224
225 @uref{git://git.code.sf.net/p/openocd/code}
226
227 or via http
228
229 @uref{http://git.code.sf.net/p/openocd/code}
230
231 You may prefer to use a mirror and the HTTP protocol:
232
233 @uref{http://repo.or.cz/r/openocd.git}
234
235 With standard Git tools, use @command{git clone} to initialize
236 a local repository, and @command{git pull} to update it.
237 There are also gitweb pages letting you browse the repository
238 with a web browser, or download arbitrary snapshots without
239 needing a Git client:
240
241 @uref{http://repo.or.cz/w/openocd.git}
242
243 The @file{README} file contains the instructions for building the project
244 from the repository or a snapshot.
245
246 Developers that want to contribute patches to the OpenOCD system are
247 @b{strongly} encouraged to work against mainline.
248 Patches created against older versions may require additional
249 work from their submitter in order to be updated for newer releases.
250
251 @section Doxygen Developer Manual
252
253 During the 0.2.x release cycle, the OpenOCD project began
254 providing a Doxygen reference manual. This document contains more
255 technical information about the software internals, development
256 processes, and similar documentation:
257
258 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/doxygen/html/index.html}
259
260 This document is a work-in-progress, but contributions would be welcome
261 to fill in the gaps. All of the source files are provided in-tree,
262 listed in the Doxyfile configuration at the top of the source tree.
263
264 @section Gerrit Review System
265
266 All changes in the OpenOCD Git repository go through the web-based Gerrit
267 Code Review System:
268
269 @uref{http://openocd.zylin.com/}
270
271 After a one-time registration and repository setup, anyone can push commits
272 from their local Git repository directly into Gerrit.
273 All users and developers are encouraged to review, test, discuss and vote
274 for changes in Gerrit. The feedback provides the basis for a maintainer to
275 eventually submit the change to the main Git repository.
276
277 The @file{HACKING} file, also available as the Patch Guide in the Doxygen
278 Developer Manual, contains basic information about how to connect a
279 repository to Gerrit, prepare and push patches. Patch authors are expected to
280 maintain their changes while they're in Gerrit, respond to feedback and if
281 necessary rework and push improved versions of the change.
282
283 @section OpenOCD Developer Mailing List
284
285 The OpenOCD Developer Mailing List provides the primary means of
286 communication between developers:
287
288 @uref{https://lists.sourceforge.net/mailman/listinfo/openocd-devel}
289
290 @section OpenOCD Bug Tracker
291
292 The OpenOCD Bug Tracker is hosted on SourceForge:
293
294 @uref{http://bugs.openocd.org/}
295
296
297 @node Debug Adapter Hardware
298 @chapter Debug Adapter Hardware
299 @cindex dongles
300 @cindex FTDI
301 @cindex wiggler
302 @cindex zy1000
303 @cindex printer port
304 @cindex USB Adapter
305 @cindex RTCK
306
307 Defined: @b{dongle}: A small device that plugs into a computer and serves as
308 an adapter .... [snip]
309
310 In the OpenOCD case, this generally refers to @b{a small adapter} that
311 attaches to your computer via USB or the parallel port. One
312 exception is the Ultimate Solutions ZY1000, packaged as a small box you
313 attach via an ethernet cable. The ZY1000 has the advantage that it does not
314 require any drivers to be installed on the developer PC. It also has
315 a built in web interface. It supports RTCK/RCLK or adaptive clocking
316 and has a built-in relay to power cycle targets remotely.
317
318
319 @section Choosing a Dongle
320
321 There are several things you should keep in mind when choosing a dongle.
322
323 @enumerate
324 @item @b{Transport} Does it support the kind of communication that you need?
325 OpenOCD focusses mostly on JTAG. Your version may also support
326 other ways to communicate with target devices.
327 @item @b{Voltage} What voltage is your target - 1.8, 2.8, 3.3, or 5V?
328 Does your dongle support it? You might need a level converter.
329 @item @b{Pinout} What pinout does your target board use?
330 Does your dongle support it? You may be able to use jumper
331 wires, or an "octopus" connector, to convert pinouts.
332 @item @b{Connection} Does your computer have the USB, parallel, or
333 Ethernet port needed?
334 @item @b{RTCK} Do you expect to use it with ARM chips and boards with
335 RTCK support (also known as ``adaptive clocking'')?
336 @end enumerate
337
338 @section Stand-alone JTAG Probe
339
340 The ZY1000 from Ultimate Solutions is technically not a dongle but a
341 stand-alone JTAG probe that, unlike most dongles, doesn't require any drivers
342 running on the developer's host computer.
343 Once installed on a network using DHCP or a static IP assignment, users can
344 access the ZY1000 probe locally or remotely from any host with access to the
345 IP address assigned to the probe.
346 The ZY1000 provides an intuitive web interface with direct access to the
347 OpenOCD debugger.
348 Users may also run a GDBSERVER directly on the ZY1000 to take full advantage
349 of GCC & GDB to debug any distribution of embedded Linux or NetBSD running on
350 the target.
351 The ZY1000 supports RTCK & RCLK or adaptive clocking and has a built-in relay
352 to power cycle the target remotely.
353
354 For more information, visit:
355
356 @b{ZY1000} See: @url{http://www.ultsol.com/index.php/component/content/article/8/210-zylin-zy1000-main}
357
358 @section USB FT2232 Based
359
360 There are many USB JTAG dongles on the market, many of them based
361 on a chip from ``Future Technology Devices International'' (FTDI)
362 known as the FTDI FT2232; this is a USB full speed (12 Mbps) chip.
363 See: @url{http://www.ftdichip.com} for more information.
364 In summer 2009, USB high speed (480 Mbps) versions of these FTDI
365 chips started to become available in JTAG adapters. Around 2012, a new
366 variant appeared - FT232H - this is a single-channel version of FT2232H.
367 (Adapters using those high speed FT2232H or FT232H chips may support adaptive
368 clocking.)
369
370 The FT2232 chips are flexible enough to support some other
371 transport options, such as SWD or the SPI variants used to
372 program some chips. They have two communications channels,
373 and one can be used for a UART adapter at the same time the
374 other one is used to provide a debug adapter.
375
376 Also, some development boards integrate an FT2232 chip to serve as
377 a built-in low-cost debug adapter and USB-to-serial solution.
378
379 @itemize @bullet
380 @item @b{usbjtag}
381 @* Link @url{http://elk.informatik.fh-augsburg.de/hhweb/doc/openocd/usbjtag/usbjtag.html}
382 @item @b{jtagkey}
383 @* See: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtagkey.shtml}
384 @item @b{jtagkey2}
385 @* See: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtagkey2.shtml}
386 @item @b{oocdlink}
387 @* See: @url{http://www.oocdlink.com} By Joern Kaipf
388 @item @b{signalyzer}
389 @* See: @url{http://www.signalyzer.com}
390 @item @b{Stellaris Eval Boards}
391 @* See: @url{http://www.ti.com} - The Stellaris eval boards
392 bundle FT2232-based JTAG and SWD support, which can be used to debug
393 the Stellaris chips. Using separate JTAG adapters is optional.
394 These boards can also be used in a "pass through" mode as JTAG adapters
395 to other target boards, disabling the Stellaris chip.
396 @item @b{TI/Luminary ICDI}
397 @* See: @url{http://www.ti.com} - TI/Luminary In-Circuit Debug
398 Interface (ICDI) Boards are included in Stellaris LM3S9B9x
399 Evaluation Kits. Like the non-detachable FT2232 support on the other
400 Stellaris eval boards, they can be used to debug other target boards.
401 @item @b{olimex-jtag}
402 @* See: @url{http://www.olimex.com}
403 @item @b{Flyswatter/Flyswatter2}
404 @* See: @url{http://www.tincantools.com}
405 @item @b{turtelizer2}
406 @* See:
407 @uref{http://www.ethernut.de/en/hardware/turtelizer/index.html, Turtelizer 2}, or
408 @url{http://www.ethernut.de}
409 @item @b{comstick}
410 @* Link: @url{http://www.hitex.com/index.php?id=383}
411 @item @b{stm32stick}
412 @* Link @url{http://www.hitex.com/stm32-stick}
413 @item @b{axm0432_jtag}
414 @* Axiom AXM-0432 Link @url{http://www.axman.com} - NOTE: This JTAG does not appear
415 to be available anymore as of April 2012.
416 @item @b{cortino}
417 @* Link @url{http://www.hitex.com/index.php?id=cortino}
418 @item @b{dlp-usb1232h}
419 @* Link @url{http://www.dlpdesign.com/usb/usb1232h.shtml}
420 @item @b{digilent-hs1}
421 @* Link @url{http://www.digilentinc.com/Products/Detail.cfm?Prod=JTAG-HS1}
422 @item @b{opendous}
423 @* Link @url{http://code.google.com/p/opendous/wiki/JTAG} FT2232H-based
424 (OpenHardware).
425 @item @b{JTAG-lock-pick Tiny 2}
426 @* Link @url{http://www.distortec.com/jtag-lock-pick-tiny-2} FT232H-based
427
428 @item @b{GW16042}
429 @* Link: @url{http://shop.gateworks.com/index.php?route=product/product&path=70_80&product_id=64}
430 FT2232H-based
431
432 @end itemize
433 @section USB-JTAG / Altera USB-Blaster compatibles
434
435 These devices also show up as FTDI devices, but are not
436 protocol-compatible with the FT2232 devices. They are, however,
437 protocol-compatible among themselves. USB-JTAG devices typically consist
438 of a FT245 followed by a CPLD that understands a particular protocol,
439 or emulates this protocol using some other hardware.
440
441 They may appear under different USB VID/PID depending on the particular
442 product. The driver can be configured to search for any VID/PID pair
443 (see the section on driver commands).
444
445 @itemize
446 @item @b{USB-JTAG} Kolja Waschk's USB Blaster-compatible adapter
447 @* Link: @url{http://ixo-jtag.sourceforge.net/}
448 @item @b{Altera USB-Blaster}
449 @* Link: @url{http://www.altera.com/literature/ug/ug_usb_blstr.pdf}
450 @end itemize
451
452 @section USB J-Link based
453 There are several OEM versions of the SEGGER @b{J-Link} adapter. It is
454 an example of a microcontroller based JTAG adapter, it uses an
455 AT91SAM764 internally.
456
457 @itemize @bullet
458 @item @b{SEGGER J-Link}
459 @* Link: @url{http://www.segger.com/jlink.html}
460 @item @b{Atmel SAM-ICE} (Only works with Atmel chips!)
461 @* Link: @url{http://www.atmel.com/tools/atmelsam-ice.aspx}
462 @item @b{IAR J-Link}
463 @end itemize
464
465 @section USB RLINK based
466 Raisonance has an adapter called @b{RLink}. It exists in a stripped-down form on the STM32 Primer,
467 permanently attached to the JTAG lines. It also exists on the STM32 Primer2, but that is wired for
468 SWD and not JTAG, thus not supported.
469
470 @itemize @bullet
471 @item @b{Raisonance RLink}
472 @* Link: @url{http://www.mcu-raisonance.com/~rlink-debugger-programmer__@/microcontrollers__tool~tool__T018:4cn9ziz4bnx6.html}
473 @item @b{STM32 Primer}
474 @* Link: @url{http://www.stm32circle.com/resources/stm32primer.php}
475 @item @b{STM32 Primer2}
476 @* Link: @url{http://www.stm32circle.com/resources/stm32primer2.php}
477 @end itemize
478
479 @section USB ST-LINK based
480 ST Micro has an adapter called @b{ST-LINK}.
481 They only work with ST Micro chips, notably STM32 and STM8.
482
483 @itemize @bullet
484 @item @b{ST-LINK}
485 @* This is available standalone and as part of some kits, eg. STM32VLDISCOVERY.
486 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/evalboard/product/219866.jsp}
487 @item @b{ST-LINK/V2}
488 @* This is available standalone and as part of some kits, eg. STM32F4DISCOVERY.
489 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/evalboard/product/251168.jsp}
490 @end itemize
491
492 For info the original ST-LINK enumerates using the mass storage usb class; however,
493 its implementation is completely broken. The result is this causes issues under Linux.
494 The simplest solution is to get Linux to ignore the ST-LINK using one of the following methods:
495 @itemize @bullet
496 @item modprobe -r usb-storage && modprobe usb-storage quirks=483:3744:i
497 @item add "options usb-storage quirks=483:3744:i" to /etc/modprobe.conf
498 @end itemize
499
500 @section USB TI/Stellaris ICDI based
501 Texas Instruments has an adapter called @b{ICDI}.
502 It is not to be confused with the FTDI based adapters that were originally fitted to their
503 evaluation boards. This is the adapter fitted to the Stellaris LaunchPad.
504
505 @section USB CMSIS-DAP based
506 ARM has released a interface standard called CMSIS-DAP that simplifies connecting
507 debuggers to ARM Cortex based targets @url{http://www.keil.com/support/man/docs/dapdebug/dapdebug_introduction.htm}.
508
509 @section USB Other
510 @itemize @bullet
511 @item @b{USBprog}
512 @* Link: @url{http://shop.embedded-projects.net/} - which uses an Atmel MEGA32 and a UBN9604
513
514 @item @b{USB - Presto}
515 @* Link: @url{http://tools.asix.net/prg_presto.htm}
516
517 @item @b{Versaloon-Link}
518 @* Link: @url{http://www.versaloon.com}
519
520 @item @b{ARM-JTAG-EW}
521 @* Link: @url{http://www.olimex.com/dev/arm-jtag-ew.html}
522
523 @item @b{Buspirate}
524 @* Link: @url{http://dangerousprototypes.com/bus-pirate-manual/}
525
526 @item @b{opendous}
527 @* Link: @url{http://code.google.com/p/opendous-jtag/} - which uses an AT90USB162
528
529 @item @b{estick}
530 @* Link: @url{http://code.google.com/p/estick-jtag/}
531
532 @item @b{Keil ULINK v1}
533 @* Link: @url{http://www.keil.com/ulink1/}
534 @end itemize
535
536 @section IBM PC Parallel Printer Port Based
537
538 The two well-known ``JTAG Parallel Ports'' cables are the Xilinx DLC5
539 and the Macraigor Wiggler. There are many clones and variations of
540 these on the market.
541
542 Note that parallel ports are becoming much less common, so if you
543 have the choice you should probably avoid these adapters in favor
544 of USB-based ones.
545
546 @itemize @bullet
547
548 @item @b{Wiggler} - There are many clones of this.
549 @* Link: @url{http://www.macraigor.com/wiggler.htm}
550
551 @item @b{DLC5} - From XILINX - There are many clones of this
552 @* Link: Search the web for: ``XILINX DLC5'' - it is no longer
553 produced, PDF schematics are easily found and it is easy to make.
554
555 @item @b{Amontec - JTAG Accelerator}
556 @* Link: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtag_accelerator.shtml}
557
558 @item @b{Wiggler2}
559 @* Link: @url{http://www.ccac.rwth-aachen.de/~michaels/index.php/hardware/armjtag}
560
561 @item @b{Wiggler_ntrst_inverted}
562 @* Yet another variation - See the source code, src/jtag/parport.c
563
564 @item @b{old_amt_wiggler}
565 @* Unknown - probably not on the market today
566
567 @item @b{arm-jtag}
568 @* Link: Most likely @url{http://www.olimex.com/dev/arm-jtag.html} [another wiggler clone]
569
570 @item @b{chameleon}
571 @* Link: @url{http://www.amontec.com/chameleon.shtml}
572
573 @item @b{Triton}
574 @* Unknown.
575
576 @item @b{Lattice}
577 @* ispDownload from Lattice Semiconductor
578 @url{http://www.latticesemi.com/lit/docs/@/devtools/dlcable.pdf}
579
580 @item @b{flashlink}
581 @* From ST Microsystems;
582 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/com/TECHNICAL_RESOURCES/TECHNICAL_LITERATURE/DATA_BRIEF/DM00039500.pdf}
583
584 @end itemize
585
586 @section Other...
587 @itemize @bullet
588
589 @item @b{ep93xx}
590 @* An EP93xx based Linux machine using the GPIO pins directly.
591
592 @item @b{at91rm9200}
593 @* Like the EP93xx - but an ATMEL AT91RM9200 based solution using the GPIO pins on the chip.
594
595 @item @b{bcm2835gpio}
596 @* A BCM2835-based board (e.g. Raspberry Pi) using the GPIO pins of the expansion header.
597
598 @item @b{imx_gpio}
599 @* A NXP i.MX-based board (e.g. Wandboard) using the GPIO pins (should work on any i.MX processor).
600
601 @item @b{jtag_vpi}
602 @* A JTAG driver acting as a client for the JTAG VPI server interface.
603 @* Link: @url{http://github.com/fjullien/jtag_vpi}
604
605 @end itemize
606
607 @node About Jim-Tcl
608 @chapter About Jim-Tcl
609 @cindex Jim-Tcl
610 @cindex tcl
611
612 OpenOCD uses a small ``Tcl Interpreter'' known as Jim-Tcl.
613 This programming language provides a simple and extensible
614 command interpreter.
615
616 All commands presented in this Guide are extensions to Jim-Tcl.
617 You can use them as simple commands, without needing to learn
618 much of anything about Tcl.
619 Alternatively, you can write Tcl programs with them.
620
621 You can learn more about Jim at its website, @url{http://jim.tcl.tk}.
622 There is an active and responsive community, get on the mailing list
623 if you have any questions. Jim-Tcl maintainers also lurk on the
624 OpenOCD mailing list.
625
626 @itemize @bullet
627 @item @b{Jim vs. Tcl}
628 @* Jim-Tcl is a stripped down version of the well known Tcl language,
629 which can be found here: @url{http://www.tcl.tk}. Jim-Tcl has far
630 fewer features. Jim-Tcl is several dozens of .C files and .H files and
631 implements the basic Tcl command set. In contrast: Tcl 8.6 is a
632 4.2 MB .zip file containing 1540 files.
633
634 @item @b{Missing Features}
635 @* Our practice has been: Add/clone the real Tcl feature if/when
636 needed. We welcome Jim-Tcl improvements, not bloat. Also there
637 are a large number of optional Jim-Tcl features that are not
638 enabled in OpenOCD.
639
640 @item @b{Scripts}
641 @* OpenOCD configuration scripts are Jim-Tcl Scripts. OpenOCD's
642 command interpreter today is a mixture of (newer)
643 Jim-Tcl commands, and the (older) original command interpreter.
644
645 @item @b{Commands}
646 @* At the OpenOCD telnet command line (or via the GDB monitor command) one
647 can type a Tcl for() loop, set variables, etc.
648 Some of the commands documented in this guide are implemented
649 as Tcl scripts, from a @file{startup.tcl} file internal to the server.
650
651 @item @b{Historical Note}
652 @* Jim-Tcl was introduced to OpenOCD in spring 2008. Fall 2010,
653 before OpenOCD 0.5 release, OpenOCD switched to using Jim-Tcl
654 as a Git submodule, which greatly simplified upgrading Jim-Tcl
655 to benefit from new features and bugfixes in Jim-Tcl.
656
657 @item @b{Need a crash course in Tcl?}
658 @*@xref{Tcl Crash Course}.
659 @end itemize
660
661 @node Running
662 @chapter Running
663 @cindex command line options
664 @cindex logfile
665 @cindex directory search
666
667 Properly installing OpenOCD sets up your operating system to grant it access
668 to the debug adapters. On Linux, this usually involves installing a file
669 in @file{/etc/udev/rules.d,} so OpenOCD has permissions. An example rules file
670 that works for many common adapters is shipped with OpenOCD in the
671 @file{contrib} directory. MS-Windows needs
672 complex and confusing driver configuration for every peripheral. Such issues
673 are unique to each operating system, and are not detailed in this User's Guide.
674
675 Then later you will invoke the OpenOCD server, with various options to
676 tell it how each debug session should work.
677 The @option{--help} option shows:
678 @verbatim
679 bash$ openocd --help
680
681 --help | -h display this help
682 --version | -v display OpenOCD version
683 --file | -f use configuration file <name>
684 --search | -s dir to search for config files and scripts
685 --debug | -d set debug level to 3
686 | -d<n> set debug level to <level>
687 --log_output | -l redirect log output to file <name>
688 --command | -c run <command>
689 @end verbatim
690
691 If you don't give any @option{-f} or @option{-c} options,
692 OpenOCD tries to read the configuration file @file{openocd.cfg}.
693 To specify one or more different
694 configuration files, use @option{-f} options. For example:
695
696 @example
697 openocd -f config1.cfg -f config2.cfg -f config3.cfg
698 @end example
699
700 Configuration files and scripts are searched for in
701 @enumerate
702 @item the current directory,
703 @item any search dir specified on the command line using the @option{-s} option,
704 @item any search dir specified using the @command{add_script_search_dir} command,
705 @item @file{$HOME/.openocd} (not on Windows),
706 @item a directory in the @env{OPENOCD_SCRIPTS} environment variable (if set),
707 @item the site wide script library @file{$pkgdatadir/site} and
708 @item the OpenOCD-supplied script library @file{$pkgdatadir/scripts}.
709 @end enumerate
710 The first found file with a matching file name will be used.
711
712 @quotation Note
713 Don't try to use configuration script names or paths which
714 include the "#" character. That character begins Tcl comments.
715 @end quotation
716
717 @section Simple setup, no customization
718
719 In the best case, you can use two scripts from one of the script
720 libraries, hook up your JTAG adapter, and start the server ... and
721 your JTAG setup will just work "out of the box". Always try to
722 start by reusing those scripts, but assume you'll need more
723 customization even if this works. @xref{OpenOCD Project Setup}.
724
725 If you find a script for your JTAG adapter, and for your board or
726 target, you may be able to hook up your JTAG adapter then start
727 the server with some variation of one of the following:
728
729 @example
730 openocd -f interface/ADAPTER.cfg -f board/MYBOARD.cfg
731 openocd -f interface/ftdi/ADAPTER.cfg -f board/MYBOARD.cfg
732 @end example
733
734 You might also need to configure which reset signals are present,
735 using @option{-c 'reset_config trst_and_srst'} or something similar.
736 If all goes well you'll see output something like
737
738 @example
739 Open On-Chip Debugger 0.4.0 (2010-01-14-15:06)
740 For bug reports, read
741 http://openocd.org/doc/doxygen/bugs.html
742 Info : JTAG tap: lm3s.cpu tap/device found: 0x3ba00477
743 (mfg: 0x23b, part: 0xba00, ver: 0x3)
744 @end example
745
746 Seeing that "tap/device found" message, and no warnings, means
747 the JTAG communication is working. That's a key milestone, but
748 you'll probably need more project-specific setup.
749
750 @section What OpenOCD does as it starts
751
752 OpenOCD starts by processing the configuration commands provided
753 on the command line or, if there were no @option{-c command} or
754 @option{-f file.cfg} options given, in @file{openocd.cfg}.
755 @xref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage}.
756 At the end of the configuration stage it verifies the JTAG scan
757 chain defined using those commands; your configuration should
758 ensure that this always succeeds.
759 Normally, OpenOCD then starts running as a server.
760 Alternatively, commands may be used to terminate the configuration
761 stage early, perform work (such as updating some flash memory),
762 and then shut down without acting as a server.
763
764 Once OpenOCD starts running as a server, it waits for connections from
765 clients (Telnet, GDB, RPC) and processes the commands issued through
766 those channels.
767
768 If you are having problems, you can enable internal debug messages via
769 the @option{-d} option.
770
771 Also it is possible to interleave Jim-Tcl commands w/config scripts using the
772 @option{-c} command line switch.
773
774 To enable debug output (when reporting problems or working on OpenOCD
775 itself), use the @option{-d} command line switch. This sets the
776 @option{debug_level} to "3", outputting the most information,
777 including debug messages. The default setting is "2", outputting only
778 informational messages, warnings and errors. You can also change this
779 setting from within a telnet or gdb session using @command{debug_level<n>}
780 (@pxref{debuglevel,,debug_level}).
781
782 You can redirect all output from the server to a file using the
783 @option{-l <logfile>} switch.
784
785 Note! OpenOCD will launch the GDB & telnet server even if it can not
786 establish a connection with the target. In general, it is possible for
787 the JTAG controller to be unresponsive until the target is set up
788 correctly via e.g. GDB monitor commands in a GDB init script.
789
790 @node OpenOCD Project Setup
791 @chapter OpenOCD Project Setup
792
793 To use OpenOCD with your development projects, you need to do more than
794 just connect the JTAG adapter hardware (dongle) to your development board
795 and start the OpenOCD server.
796 You also need to configure your OpenOCD server so that it knows
797 about your adapter and board, and helps your work.
798 You may also want to connect OpenOCD to GDB, possibly
799 using Eclipse or some other GUI.
800
801 @section Hooking up the JTAG Adapter
802
803 Today's most common case is a dongle with a JTAG cable on one side
804 (such as a ribbon cable with a 10-pin or 20-pin IDC connector)
805 and a USB cable on the other.
806 Instead of USB, some cables use Ethernet;
807 older ones may use a PC parallel port, or even a serial port.
808
809 @enumerate
810 @item @emph{Start with power to your target board turned off},
811 and nothing connected to your JTAG adapter.
812 If you're particularly paranoid, unplug power to the board.
813 It's important to have the ground signal properly set up,
814 unless you are using a JTAG adapter which provides
815 galvanic isolation between the target board and the
816 debugging host.
817
818 @item @emph{Be sure it's the right kind of JTAG connector.}
819 If your dongle has a 20-pin ARM connector, you need some kind
820 of adapter (or octopus, see below) to hook it up to
821 boards using 14-pin or 10-pin connectors ... or to 20-pin
822 connectors which don't use ARM's pinout.
823
824 In the same vein, make sure the voltage levels are compatible.
825 Not all JTAG adapters have the level shifters needed to work
826 with 1.2 Volt boards.
827
828 @item @emph{Be certain the cable is properly oriented} or you might
829 damage your board. In most cases there are only two possible
830 ways to connect the cable.
831 Connect the JTAG cable from your adapter to the board.
832 Be sure it's firmly connected.
833
834 In the best case, the connector is keyed to physically
835 prevent you from inserting it wrong.
836 This is most often done using a slot on the board's male connector
837 housing, which must match a key on the JTAG cable's female connector.
838 If there's no housing, then you must look carefully and
839 make sure pin 1 on the cable hooks up to pin 1 on the board.
840 Ribbon cables are frequently all grey except for a wire on one
841 edge, which is red. The red wire is pin 1.
842
843 Sometimes dongles provide cables where one end is an ``octopus'' of
844 color coded single-wire connectors, instead of a connector block.
845 These are great when converting from one JTAG pinout to another,
846 but are tedious to set up.
847 Use these with connector pinout diagrams to help you match up the
848 adapter signals to the right board pins.
849
850 @item @emph{Connect the adapter's other end} once the JTAG cable is connected.
851 A USB, parallel, or serial port connector will go to the host which
852 you are using to run OpenOCD.
853 For Ethernet, consult the documentation and your network administrator.
854
855 For USB-based JTAG adapters you have an easy sanity check at this point:
856 does the host operating system see the JTAG adapter? If you're running
857 Linux, try the @command{lsusb} command. If that host is an
858 MS-Windows host, you'll need to install a driver before OpenOCD works.
859
860 @item @emph{Connect the adapter's power supply, if needed.}
861 This step is primarily for non-USB adapters,
862 but sometimes USB adapters need extra power.
863
864 @item @emph{Power up the target board.}
865 Unless you just let the magic smoke escape,
866 you're now ready to set up the OpenOCD server
867 so you can use JTAG to work with that board.
868
869 @end enumerate
870
871 Talk with the OpenOCD server using
872 telnet (@code{telnet localhost 4444} on many systems) or GDB.
873 @xref{GDB and OpenOCD}.
874
875 @section Project Directory
876
877 There are many ways you can configure OpenOCD and start it up.
878
879 A simple way to organize them all involves keeping a
880 single directory for your work with a given board.
881 When you start OpenOCD from that directory,
882 it searches there first for configuration files, scripts,
883 files accessed through semihosting,
884 and for code you upload to the target board.
885 It is also the natural place to write files,
886 such as log files and data you download from the board.
887
888 @section Configuration Basics
889
890 There are two basic ways of configuring OpenOCD, and
891 a variety of ways you can mix them.
892 Think of the difference as just being how you start the server:
893
894 @itemize
895 @item Many @option{-f file} or @option{-c command} options on the command line
896 @item No options, but a @dfn{user config file}
897 in the current directory named @file{openocd.cfg}
898 @end itemize
899
900 Here is an example @file{openocd.cfg} file for a setup
901 using a Signalyzer FT2232-based JTAG adapter to talk to
902 a board with an Atmel AT91SAM7X256 microcontroller:
903
904 @example
905 source [find interface/ftdi/signalyzer.cfg]
906
907 # GDB can also flash my flash!
908 gdb_memory_map enable
909 gdb_flash_program enable
910
911 source [find target/sam7x256.cfg]
912 @end example
913
914 Here is the command line equivalent of that configuration:
915
916 @example
917 openocd -f interface/ftdi/signalyzer.cfg \
918 -c "gdb_memory_map enable" \
919 -c "gdb_flash_program enable" \
920 -f target/sam7x256.cfg
921 @end example
922
923 You could wrap such long command lines in shell scripts,
924 each supporting a different development task.
925 One might re-flash the board with a specific firmware version.
926 Another might set up a particular debugging or run-time environment.
927
928 @quotation Important
929 At this writing (October 2009) the command line method has
930 problems with how it treats variables.
931 For example, after @option{-c "set VAR value"}, or doing the
932 same in a script, the variable @var{VAR} will have no value
933 that can be tested in a later script.
934 @end quotation
935
936 Here we will focus on the simpler solution: one user config
937 file, including basic configuration plus any TCL procedures
938 to simplify your work.
939
940 @section User Config Files
941 @cindex config file, user
942 @cindex user config file
943 @cindex config file, overview
944
945 A user configuration file ties together all the parts of a project
946 in one place.
947 One of the following will match your situation best:
948
949 @itemize
950 @item Ideally almost everything comes from configuration files
951 provided by someone else.
952 For example, OpenOCD distributes a @file{scripts} directory
953 (probably in @file{/usr/share/openocd/scripts} on Linux).
954 Board and tool vendors can provide these too, as can individual
955 user sites; the @option{-s} command line option lets you say
956 where to find these files. (@xref{Running}.)
957 The AT91SAM7X256 example above works this way.
958
959 Three main types of non-user configuration file each have their
960 own subdirectory in the @file{scripts} directory:
961
962 @enumerate
963 @item @b{interface} -- one for each different debug adapter;
964 @item @b{board} -- one for each different board
965 @item @b{target} -- the chips which integrate CPUs and other JTAG TAPs
966 @end enumerate
967
968 Best case: include just two files, and they handle everything else.
969 The first is an interface config file.
970 The second is board-specific, and it sets up the JTAG TAPs and
971 their GDB targets (by deferring to some @file{target.cfg} file),
972 declares all flash memory, and leaves you nothing to do except
973 meet your deadline:
974
975 @example
976 source [find interface/olimex-jtag-tiny.cfg]
977 source [find board/csb337.cfg]
978 @end example
979
980 Boards with a single microcontroller often won't need more
981 than the target config file, as in the AT91SAM7X256 example.
982 That's because there is no external memory (flash, DDR RAM), and
983 the board differences are encapsulated by application code.
984
985 @item Maybe you don't know yet what your board looks like to JTAG.
986 Once you know the @file{interface.cfg} file to use, you may
987 need help from OpenOCD to discover what's on the board.
988 Once you find the JTAG TAPs, you can just search for appropriate
989 target and board
990 configuration files ... or write your own, from the bottom up.
991 @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
992
993 @item You can often reuse some standard config files but
994 need to write a few new ones, probably a @file{board.cfg} file.
995 You will be using commands described later in this User's Guide,
996 and working with the guidelines in the next chapter.
997
998 For example, there may be configuration files for your JTAG adapter
999 and target chip, but you need a new board-specific config file
1000 giving access to your particular flash chips.
1001 Or you might need to write another target chip configuration file
1002 for a new chip built around the Cortex-M3 core.
1003
1004 @quotation Note
1005 When you write new configuration files, please submit
1006 them for inclusion in the next OpenOCD release.
1007 For example, a @file{board/newboard.cfg} file will help the
1008 next users of that board, and a @file{target/newcpu.cfg}
1009 will help support users of any board using that chip.
1010 @end quotation
1011
1012 @item
1013 You may may need to write some C code.
1014 It may be as simple as supporting a new FT2232 or parport
1015 based adapter; a bit more involved, like a NAND or NOR flash
1016 controller driver; or a big piece of work like supporting
1017 a new chip architecture.
1018 @end itemize
1019
1020 Reuse the existing config files when you can.
1021 Look first in the @file{scripts/boards} area, then @file{scripts/targets}.
1022 You may find a board configuration that's a good example to follow.
1023
1024 When you write config files, separate the reusable parts
1025 (things every user of that interface, chip, or board needs)
1026 from ones specific to your environment and debugging approach.
1027 @itemize
1028
1029 @item
1030 For example, a @code{gdb-attach} event handler that invokes
1031 the @command{reset init} command will interfere with debugging
1032 early boot code, which performs some of the same actions
1033 that the @code{reset-init} event handler does.
1034
1035 @item
1036 Likewise, the @command{arm9 vector_catch} command (or
1037 @cindex vector_catch
1038 its siblings @command{xscale vector_catch}
1039 and @command{cortex_m vector_catch}) can be a timesaver
1040 during some debug sessions, but don't make everyone use that either.
1041 Keep those kinds of debugging aids in your user config file,
1042 along with messaging and tracing setup.
1043 (@xref{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing,,Software Debug Messages and Tracing}.)
1044
1045 @item
1046 You might need to override some defaults.
1047 For example, you might need to move, shrink, or back up the target's
1048 work area if your application needs much SRAM.
1049
1050 @item
1051 TCP/IP port configuration is another example of something which
1052 is environment-specific, and should only appear in
1053 a user config file. @xref{tcpipports,,TCP/IP Ports}.
1054 @end itemize
1055
1056 @section Project-Specific Utilities
1057
1058 A few project-specific utility
1059 routines may well speed up your work.
1060 Write them, and keep them in your project's user config file.
1061
1062 For example, if you are making a boot loader work on a
1063 board, it's nice to be able to debug the ``after it's
1064 loaded to RAM'' parts separately from the finicky early
1065 code which sets up the DDR RAM controller and clocks.
1066 A script like this one, or a more GDB-aware sibling,
1067 may help:
1068
1069 @example
1070 proc ramboot @{ @} @{
1071 # Reset, running the target's "reset-init" scripts
1072 # to initialize clocks and the DDR RAM controller.
1073 # Leave the CPU halted.
1074 reset init
1075
1076 # Load CONFIG_SKIP_LOWLEVEL_INIT version into DDR RAM.
1077 load_image u-boot.bin 0x20000000
1078
1079 # Start running.
1080 resume 0x20000000
1081 @}
1082 @end example
1083
1084 Then once that code is working you will need to make it
1085 boot from NOR flash; a different utility would help.
1086 Alternatively, some developers write to flash using GDB.
1087 (You might use a similar script if you're working with a flash
1088 based microcontroller application instead of a boot loader.)
1089
1090 @example
1091 proc newboot @{ @} @{
1092 # Reset, leaving the CPU halted. The "reset-init" event
1093 # proc gives faster access to the CPU and to NOR flash;
1094 # "reset halt" would be slower.
1095 reset init
1096
1097 # Write standard version of U-Boot into the first two
1098 # sectors of NOR flash ... the standard version should
1099 # do the same lowlevel init as "reset-init".
1100 flash protect 0 0 1 off
1101 flash erase_sector 0 0 1
1102 flash write_bank 0 u-boot.bin 0x0
1103 flash protect 0 0 1 on
1104
1105 # Reboot from scratch using that new boot loader.
1106 reset run
1107 @}
1108 @end example
1109
1110 You may need more complicated utility procedures when booting
1111 from NAND.
1112 That often involves an extra bootloader stage,
1113 running from on-chip SRAM to perform DDR RAM setup so it can load
1114 the main bootloader code (which won't fit into that SRAM).
1115
1116 Other helper scripts might be used to write production system images,
1117 involving considerably more than just a three stage bootloader.
1118
1119 @section Target Software Changes
1120
1121 Sometimes you may want to make some small changes to the software
1122 you're developing, to help make JTAG debugging work better.
1123 For example, in C or assembly language code you might
1124 use @code{#ifdef JTAG_DEBUG} (or its converse) around code
1125 handling issues like:
1126
1127 @itemize @bullet
1128
1129 @item @b{Watchdog Timers}...
1130 Watchog timers are typically used to automatically reset systems if
1131 some application task doesn't periodically reset the timer. (The
1132 assumption is that the system has locked up if the task can't run.)
1133 When a JTAG debugger halts the system, that task won't be able to run
1134 and reset the timer ... potentially causing resets in the middle of
1135 your debug sessions.
1136
1137 It's rarely a good idea to disable such watchdogs, since their usage
1138 needs to be debugged just like all other parts of your firmware.
1139 That might however be your only option.
1140
1141 Look instead for chip-specific ways to stop the watchdog from counting
1142 while the system is in a debug halt state. It may be simplest to set
1143 that non-counting mode in your debugger startup scripts. You may however
1144 need a different approach when, for example, a motor could be physically
1145 damaged by firmware remaining inactive in a debug halt state. That might
1146 involve a type of firmware mode where that "non-counting" mode is disabled
1147 at the beginning then re-enabled at the end; a watchdog reset might fire
1148 and complicate the debug session, but hardware (or people) would be
1149 protected.@footnote{Note that many systems support a "monitor mode" debug
1150 that is a somewhat cleaner way to address such issues. You can think of
1151 it as only halting part of the system, maybe just one task,
1152 instead of the whole thing.
1153 At this writing, January 2010, OpenOCD based debugging does not support
1154 monitor mode debug, only "halt mode" debug.}
1155
1156 @item @b{ARM Semihosting}...
1157 @cindex ARM semihosting
1158 When linked with a special runtime library provided with many
1159 toolchains@footnote{See chapter 8 "Semihosting" in
1160 @uref{http://infocenter.arm.com/help/topic/com.arm.doc.dui0203i/DUI0203I_rvct_developer_guide.pdf,
1161 ARM DUI 0203I}, the "RealView Compilation Tools Developer Guide".
1162 The CodeSourcery EABI toolchain also includes a semihosting library.},
1163 your target code can use I/O facilities on the debug host. That library
1164 provides a small set of system calls which are handled by OpenOCD.
1165 It can let the debugger provide your system console and a file system,
1166 helping with early debugging or providing a more capable environment
1167 for sometimes-complex tasks like installing system firmware onto
1168 NAND or SPI flash.
1169
1170 @item @b{ARM Wait-For-Interrupt}...
1171 Many ARM chips synchronize the JTAG clock using the core clock.
1172 Low power states which stop that core clock thus prevent JTAG access.
1173 Idle loops in tasking environments often enter those low power states
1174 via the @code{WFI} instruction (or its coprocessor equivalent, before ARMv7).
1175
1176 You may want to @emph{disable that instruction} in source code,
1177 or otherwise prevent using that state,
1178 to ensure you can get JTAG access at any time.@footnote{As a more
1179 polite alternative, some processors have special debug-oriented
1180 registers which can be used to change various features including
1181 how the low power states are clocked while debugging.
1182 The STM32 DBGMCU_CR register is an example; at the cost of extra
1183 power consumption, JTAG can be used during low power states.}
1184 For example, the OpenOCD @command{halt} command may not
1185 work for an idle processor otherwise.
1186
1187 @item @b{Delay after reset}...
1188 Not all chips have good support for debugger access
1189 right after reset; many LPC2xxx chips have issues here.
1190 Similarly, applications that reconfigure pins used for
1191 JTAG access as they start will also block debugger access.
1192
1193 To work with boards like this, @emph{enable a short delay loop}
1194 the first thing after reset, before "real" startup activities.
1195 For example, one second's delay is usually more than enough
1196 time for a JTAG debugger to attach, so that
1197 early code execution can be debugged
1198 or firmware can be replaced.
1199
1200 @item @b{Debug Communications Channel (DCC)}...
1201 Some processors include mechanisms to send messages over JTAG.
1202 Many ARM cores support these, as do some cores from other vendors.
1203 (OpenOCD may be able to use this DCC internally, speeding up some
1204 operations like writing to memory.)
1205
1206 Your application may want to deliver various debugging messages
1207 over JTAG, by @emph{linking with a small library of code}
1208 provided with OpenOCD and using the utilities there to send
1209 various kinds of message.
1210 @xref{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing,,Software Debug Messages and Tracing}.
1211
1212 @end itemize
1213
1214 @section Target Hardware Setup
1215
1216 Chip vendors often provide software development boards which
1217 are highly configurable, so that they can support all options
1218 that product boards may require. @emph{Make sure that any
1219 jumpers or switches match the system configuration you are
1220 working with.}
1221
1222 Common issues include:
1223
1224 @itemize @bullet
1225
1226 @item @b{JTAG setup} ...
1227 Boards may support more than one JTAG configuration.
1228 Examples include jumpers controlling pullups versus pulldowns
1229 on the nTRST and/or nSRST signals, and choice of connectors
1230 (e.g. which of two headers on the base board,
1231 or one from a daughtercard).
1232 For some Texas Instruments boards, you may need to jumper the
1233 EMU0 and EMU1 signals (which OpenOCD won't currently control).
1234
1235 @item @b{Boot Modes} ...
1236 Complex chips often support multiple boot modes, controlled
1237 by external jumpers. Make sure this is set up correctly.
1238 For example many i.MX boards from NXP need to be jumpered
1239 to "ATX mode" to start booting using the on-chip ROM, when
1240 using second stage bootloader code stored in a NAND flash chip.
1241
1242 Such explicit configuration is common, and not limited to
1243 booting from NAND. You might also need to set jumpers to
1244 start booting using code loaded from an MMC/SD card; external
1245 SPI flash; Ethernet, UART, or USB links; NOR flash; OneNAND
1246 flash; some external host; or various other sources.
1247
1248
1249 @item @b{Memory Addressing} ...
1250 Boards which support multiple boot modes may also have jumpers
1251 to configure memory addressing. One board, for example, jumpers
1252 external chipselect 0 (used for booting) to address either
1253 a large SRAM (which must be pre-loaded via JTAG), NOR flash,
1254 or NAND flash. When it's jumpered to address NAND flash, that
1255 board must also be told to start booting from on-chip ROM.
1256
1257 Your @file{board.cfg} file may also need to be told this jumper
1258 configuration, so that it can know whether to declare NOR flash
1259 using @command{flash bank} or instead declare NAND flash with
1260 @command{nand device}; and likewise which probe to perform in
1261 its @code{reset-init} handler.
1262
1263 A closely related issue is bus width. Jumpers might need to
1264 distinguish between 8 bit or 16 bit bus access for the flash
1265 used to start booting.
1266
1267 @item @b{Peripheral Access} ...
1268 Development boards generally provide access to every peripheral
1269 on the chip, sometimes in multiple modes (such as by providing
1270 multiple audio codec chips).
1271 This interacts with software
1272 configuration of pin multiplexing, where for example a
1273 given pin may be routed either to the MMC/SD controller
1274 or the GPIO controller. It also often interacts with
1275 configuration jumpers. One jumper may be used to route
1276 signals to an MMC/SD card slot or an expansion bus (which
1277 might in turn affect booting); others might control which
1278 audio or video codecs are used.
1279
1280 @end itemize
1281
1282 Plus you should of course have @code{reset-init} event handlers
1283 which set up the hardware to match that jumper configuration.
1284 That includes in particular any oscillator or PLL used to clock
1285 the CPU, and any memory controllers needed to access external
1286 memory and peripherals. Without such handlers, you won't be
1287 able to access those resources without working target firmware
1288 which can do that setup ... this can be awkward when you're
1289 trying to debug that target firmware. Even if there's a ROM
1290 bootloader which handles a few issues, it rarely provides full
1291 access to all board-specific capabilities.
1292
1293
1294 @node Config File Guidelines
1295 @chapter Config File Guidelines
1296
1297 This chapter is aimed at any user who needs to write a config file,
1298 including developers and integrators of OpenOCD and any user who
1299 needs to get a new board working smoothly.
1300 It provides guidelines for creating those files.
1301
1302 You should find the following directories under
1303 @t{$(INSTALLDIR)/scripts}, with config files maintained upstream. Use
1304 them as-is where you can; or as models for new files.
1305 @itemize @bullet
1306 @item @file{interface} ...
1307 These are for debug adapters. Files that specify configuration to use
1308 specific JTAG, SWD and other adapters go here.
1309 @item @file{board} ...
1310 Think Circuit Board, PWA, PCB, they go by many names. Board files
1311 contain initialization items that are specific to a board.
1312
1313 They reuse target configuration files, since the same
1314 microprocessor chips are used on many boards,
1315 but support for external parts varies widely. For
1316 example, the SDRAM initialization sequence for the board, or the type
1317 of external flash and what address it uses. Any initialization
1318 sequence to enable that external flash or SDRAM should be found in the
1319 board file. Boards may also contain multiple targets: two CPUs; or
1320 a CPU and an FPGA.
1321 @item @file{target} ...
1322 Think chip. The ``target'' directory represents the JTAG TAPs
1323 on a chip
1324 which OpenOCD should control, not a board. Two common types of targets
1325 are ARM chips and FPGA or CPLD chips.
1326 When a chip has multiple TAPs (maybe it has both ARM and DSP cores),
1327 the target config file defines all of them.
1328 @item @emph{more} ... browse for other library files which may be useful.
1329 For example, there are various generic and CPU-specific utilities.
1330 @end itemize
1331
1332 The @file{openocd.cfg} user config
1333 file may override features in any of the above files by
1334 setting variables before sourcing the target file, or by adding
1335 commands specific to their situation.
1336
1337 @section Interface Config Files
1338
1339 The user config file
1340 should be able to source one of these files with a command like this:
1341
1342 @example
1343 source [find interface/FOOBAR.cfg]
1344 @end example
1345
1346 A preconfigured interface file should exist for every debug adapter
1347 in use today with OpenOCD.
1348 That said, perhaps some of these config files
1349 have only been used by the developer who created it.
1350
1351 A separate chapter gives information about how to set these up.
1352 @xref{Debug Adapter Configuration}.
1353 Read the OpenOCD source code (and Developer's Guide)
1354 if you have a new kind of hardware interface
1355 and need to provide a driver for it.
1356
1357 @section Board Config Files
1358 @cindex config file, board
1359 @cindex board config file
1360
1361 The user config file
1362 should be able to source one of these files with a command like this:
1363
1364 @example
1365 source [find board/FOOBAR.cfg]
1366 @end example
1367
1368 The point of a board config file is to package everything
1369 about a given board that user config files need to know.
1370 In summary the board files should contain (if present)
1371
1372 @enumerate
1373 @item One or more @command{source [find target/...cfg]} statements
1374 @item NOR flash configuration (@pxref{norconfiguration,,NOR Configuration})
1375 @item NAND flash configuration (@pxref{nandconfiguration,,NAND Configuration})
1376 @item Target @code{reset} handlers for SDRAM and I/O configuration
1377 @item JTAG adapter reset configuration (@pxref{Reset Configuration})
1378 @item All things that are not ``inside a chip''
1379 @end enumerate
1380
1381 Generic things inside target chips belong in target config files,
1382 not board config files. So for example a @code{reset-init} event
1383 handler should know board-specific oscillator and PLL parameters,
1384 which it passes to target-specific utility code.
1385
1386 The most complex task of a board config file is creating such a
1387 @code{reset-init} event handler.
1388 Define those handlers last, after you verify the rest of the board
1389 configuration works.
1390
1391 @subsection Communication Between Config files
1392
1393 In addition to target-specific utility code, another way that
1394 board and target config files communicate is by following a
1395 convention on how to use certain variables.
1396
1397 The full Tcl/Tk language supports ``namespaces'', but Jim-Tcl does not.
1398 Thus the rule we follow in OpenOCD is this: Variables that begin with
1399 a leading underscore are temporary in nature, and can be modified and
1400 used at will within a target configuration file.
1401
1402 Complex board config files can do the things like this,
1403 for a board with three chips:
1404
1405 @example
1406 # Chip #1: PXA270 for network side, big endian
1407 set CHIPNAME network
1408 set ENDIAN big
1409 source [find target/pxa270.cfg]
1410 # on return: _TARGETNAME = network.cpu
1411 # other commands can refer to the "network.cpu" target.
1412 $_TARGETNAME configure .... events for this CPU..
1413
1414 # Chip #2: PXA270 for video side, little endian
1415 set CHIPNAME video
1416 set ENDIAN little
1417 source [find target/pxa270.cfg]
1418 # on return: _TARGETNAME = video.cpu
1419 # other commands can refer to the "video.cpu" target.
1420 $_TARGETNAME configure .... events for this CPU..
1421
1422 # Chip #3: Xilinx FPGA for glue logic
1423 set CHIPNAME xilinx
1424 unset ENDIAN
1425 source [find target/spartan3.cfg]
1426 @end example
1427
1428 That example is oversimplified because it doesn't show any flash memory,
1429 or the @code{reset-init} event handlers to initialize external DRAM
1430 or (assuming it needs it) load a configuration into the FPGA.
1431 Such features are usually needed for low-level work with many boards,
1432 where ``low level'' implies that the board initialization software may
1433 not be working. (That's a common reason to need JTAG tools. Another
1434 is to enable working with microcontroller-based systems, which often
1435 have no debugging support except a JTAG connector.)
1436
1437 Target config files may also export utility functions to board and user
1438 config files. Such functions should use name prefixes, to help avoid
1439 naming collisions.
1440
1441 Board files could also accept input variables from user config files.
1442 For example, there might be a @code{J4_JUMPER} setting used to identify
1443 what kind of flash memory a development board is using, or how to set
1444 up other clocks and peripherals.
1445
1446 @subsection Variable Naming Convention
1447 @cindex variable names
1448
1449 Most boards have only one instance of a chip.
1450 However, it should be easy to create a board with more than
1451 one such chip (as shown above).
1452 Accordingly, we encourage these conventions for naming
1453 variables associated with different @file{target.cfg} files,
1454 to promote consistency and
1455 so that board files can override target defaults.
1456
1457 Inputs to target config files include:
1458
1459 @itemize @bullet
1460 @item @code{CHIPNAME} ...
1461 This gives a name to the overall chip, and is used as part of
1462 tap identifier dotted names.
1463 While the default is normally provided by the chip manufacturer,
1464 board files may need to distinguish between instances of a chip.
1465 @item @code{ENDIAN} ...
1466 By default @option{little} - although chips may hard-wire @option{big}.
1467 Chips that can't change endianness don't need to use this variable.
1468 @item @code{CPUTAPID} ...
1469 When OpenOCD examines the JTAG chain, it can be told verify the
1470 chips against the JTAG IDCODE register.
1471 The target file will hold one or more defaults, but sometimes the
1472 chip in a board will use a different ID (perhaps a newer revision).
1473 @end itemize
1474
1475 Outputs from target config files include:
1476
1477 @itemize @bullet
1478 @item @code{_TARGETNAME} ...
1479 By convention, this variable is created by the target configuration
1480 script. The board configuration file may make use of this variable to
1481 configure things like a ``reset init'' script, or other things
1482 specific to that board and that target.
1483 If the chip has 2 targets, the names are @code{_TARGETNAME0},
1484 @code{_TARGETNAME1}, ... etc.
1485 @end itemize
1486
1487 @subsection The reset-init Event Handler
1488 @cindex event, reset-init
1489 @cindex reset-init handler
1490
1491 Board config files run in the OpenOCD configuration stage;
1492 they can't use TAPs or targets, since they haven't been
1493 fully set up yet.
1494 This means you can't write memory or access chip registers;
1495 you can't even verify that a flash chip is present.
1496 That's done later in event handlers, of which the target @code{reset-init}
1497 handler is one of the most important.
1498
1499 Except on microcontrollers, the basic job of @code{reset-init} event
1500 handlers is setting up flash and DRAM, as normally handled by boot loaders.
1501 Microcontrollers rarely use boot loaders; they run right out of their
1502 on-chip flash and SRAM memory. But they may want to use one of these
1503 handlers too, if just for developer convenience.
1504
1505 @quotation Note
1506 Because this is so very board-specific, and chip-specific, no examples
1507 are included here.
1508 Instead, look at the board config files distributed with OpenOCD.
1509 If you have a boot loader, its source code will help; so will
1510 configuration files for other JTAG tools
1511 (@pxref{translatingconfigurationfiles,,Translating Configuration Files}).
1512 @end quotation
1513
1514 Some of this code could probably be shared between different boards.
1515 For example, setting up a DRAM controller often doesn't differ by
1516 much except the bus width (16 bits or 32?) and memory timings, so a
1517 reusable TCL procedure loaded by the @file{target.cfg} file might take
1518 those as parameters.
1519 Similarly with oscillator, PLL, and clock setup;
1520 and disabling the watchdog.
1521 Structure the code cleanly, and provide comments to help
1522 the next developer doing such work.
1523 (@emph{You might be that next person} trying to reuse init code!)
1524
1525 The last thing normally done in a @code{reset-init} handler is probing
1526 whatever flash memory was configured. For most chips that needs to be
1527 done while the associated target is halted, either because JTAG memory
1528 access uses the CPU or to prevent conflicting CPU access.
1529
1530 @subsection JTAG Clock Rate
1531
1532 Before your @code{reset-init} handler has set up
1533 the PLLs and clocking, you may need to run with
1534 a low JTAG clock rate.
1535 @xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.
1536 Then you'd increase that rate after your handler has
1537 made it possible to use the faster JTAG clock.
1538 When the initial low speed is board-specific, for example
1539 because it depends on a board-specific oscillator speed, then
1540 you should probably set it up in the board config file;
1541 if it's target-specific, it belongs in the target config file.
1542
1543 For most ARM-based processors the fastest JTAG clock@footnote{A FAQ
1544 @uref{http://www.arm.com/support/faqdev/4170.html} gives details.}
1545 is one sixth of the CPU clock; or one eighth for ARM11 cores.
1546 Consult chip documentation to determine the peak JTAG clock rate,
1547 which might be less than that.
1548
1549 @quotation Warning
1550 On most ARMs, JTAG clock detection is coupled to the core clock, so
1551 software using a @option{wait for interrupt} operation blocks JTAG access.
1552 Adaptive clocking provides a partial workaround, but a more complete
1553 solution just avoids using that instruction with JTAG debuggers.
1554 @end quotation
1555
1556 If both the chip and the board support adaptive clocking,
1557 use the @command{jtag_rclk}
1558 command, in case your board is used with JTAG adapter which
1559 also supports it. Otherwise use @command{adapter_khz}.
1560 Set the slow rate at the beginning of the reset sequence,
1561 and the faster rate as soon as the clocks are at full speed.
1562
1563 @anchor{theinitboardprocedure}
1564 @subsection The init_board procedure
1565 @cindex init_board procedure
1566
1567 The concept of @code{init_board} procedure is very similar to @code{init_targets}
1568 (@xref{theinittargetsprocedure,,The init_targets procedure}.) - it's a replacement of ``linear''
1569 configuration scripts. This procedure is meant to be executed when OpenOCD enters run stage
1570 (@xref{enteringtherunstage,,Entering the Run Stage},) after @code{init_targets}. The idea to have
1571 separate @code{init_targets} and @code{init_board} procedures is to allow the first one to configure
1572 everything target specific (internal flash, internal RAM, etc.) and the second one to configure
1573 everything board specific (reset signals, chip frequency, reset-init event handler, external memory, etc.).
1574 Additionally ``linear'' board config file will most likely fail when target config file uses
1575 @code{init_targets} scheme (``linear'' script is executed before @code{init} and @code{init_targets} - after),
1576 so separating these two configuration stages is very convenient, as the easiest way to overcome this
1577 problem is to convert board config file to use @code{init_board} procedure. Board config scripts don't
1578 need to override @code{init_targets} defined in target config files when they only need to add some specifics.
1579
1580 Just as @code{init_targets}, the @code{init_board} procedure can be overridden by ``next level'' script (which sources
1581 the original), allowing greater code reuse.
1582
1583 @example
1584 ### board_file.cfg ###
1585
1586 # source target file that does most of the config in init_targets
1587 source [find target/target.cfg]
1588
1589 proc enable_fast_clock @{@} @{
1590 # enables fast on-board clock source
1591 # configures the chip to use it
1592 @}
1593
1594 # initialize only board specifics - reset, clock, adapter frequency
1595 proc init_board @{@} @{
1596 reset_config trst_and_srst trst_pulls_srst
1597
1598 $_TARGETNAME configure -event reset-init @{
1599 adapter_khz 1
1600 enable_fast_clock
1601 adapter_khz 10000
1602 @}
1603 @}
1604 @end example
1605
1606 @section Target Config Files
1607 @cindex config file, target
1608 @cindex target config file
1609
1610 Board config files communicate with target config files using
1611 naming conventions as described above, and may source one or
1612 more target config files like this:
1613
1614 @example
1615 source [find target/FOOBAR.cfg]
1616 @end example
1617
1618 The point of a target config file is to package everything
1619 about a given chip that board config files need to know.
1620 In summary the target files should contain
1621
1622 @enumerate
1623 @item Set defaults
1624 @item Add TAPs to the scan chain
1625 @item Add CPU targets (includes GDB support)
1626 @item CPU/Chip/CPU-Core specific features
1627 @item On-Chip flash
1628 @end enumerate
1629
1630 As a rule of thumb, a target file sets up only one chip.
1631 For a microcontroller, that will often include a single TAP,
1632 which is a CPU needing a GDB target, and its on-chip flash.
1633
1634 More complex chips may include multiple TAPs, and the target
1635 config file may need to define them all before OpenOCD
1636 can talk to the chip.
1637 For example, some phone chips have JTAG scan chains that include
1638 an ARM core for operating system use, a DSP,
1639 another ARM core embedded in an image processing engine,
1640 and other processing engines.
1641
1642 @subsection Default Value Boiler Plate Code
1643
1644 All target configuration files should start with code like this,
1645 letting board config files express environment-specific
1646 differences in how things should be set up.
1647
1648 @example
1649 # Boards may override chip names, perhaps based on role,
1650 # but the default should match what the vendor uses
1651 if @{ [info exists CHIPNAME] @} @{
1652 set _CHIPNAME $CHIPNAME
1653 @} else @{
1654 set _CHIPNAME sam7x256
1655 @}
1656
1657 # ONLY use ENDIAN with targets that can change it.
1658 if @{ [info exists ENDIAN] @} @{
1659 set _ENDIAN $ENDIAN
1660 @} else @{
1661 set _ENDIAN little
1662 @}
1663
1664 # TAP identifiers may change as chips mature, for example with
1665 # new revision fields (the "3" here). Pick a good default; you
1666 # can pass several such identifiers to the "jtag newtap" command.
1667 if @{ [info exists CPUTAPID ] @} @{
1668 set _CPUTAPID $CPUTAPID
1669 @} else @{
1670 set _CPUTAPID 0x3f0f0f0f
1671 @}
1672 @end example
1673 @c but 0x3f0f0f0f is for an str73x part ...
1674
1675 @emph{Remember:} Board config files may include multiple target
1676 config files, or the same target file multiple times
1677 (changing at least @code{CHIPNAME}).
1678
1679 Likewise, the target configuration file should define
1680 @code{_TARGETNAME} (or @code{_TARGETNAME0} etc) and
1681 use it later on when defining debug targets:
1682
1683 @example
1684 set _TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.cpu
1685 target create $_TARGETNAME arm7tdmi -chain-position $_TARGETNAME
1686 @end example
1687
1688 @subsection Adding TAPs to the Scan Chain
1689 After the ``defaults'' are set up,
1690 add the TAPs on each chip to the JTAG scan chain.
1691 @xref{TAP Declaration}, and the naming convention
1692 for taps.
1693
1694 In the simplest case the chip has only one TAP,
1695 probably for a CPU or FPGA.
1696 The config file for the Atmel AT91SAM7X256
1697 looks (in part) like this:
1698
1699 @example
1700 jtag newtap $_CHIPNAME cpu -irlen 4 -expected-id $_CPUTAPID
1701 @end example
1702
1703 A board with two such at91sam7 chips would be able
1704 to source such a config file twice, with different
1705 values for @code{CHIPNAME}, so
1706 it adds a different TAP each time.
1707
1708 If there are nonzero @option{-expected-id} values,
1709 OpenOCD attempts to verify the actual tap id against those values.
1710 It will issue error messages if there is mismatch, which
1711 can help to pinpoint problems in OpenOCD configurations.
1712
1713 @example
1714 JTAG tap: sam7x256.cpu tap/device found: 0x3f0f0f0f
1715 (Manufacturer: 0x787, Part: 0xf0f0, Version: 0x3)
1716 ERROR: Tap: sam7x256.cpu - Expected id: 0x12345678, Got: 0x3f0f0f0f
1717 ERROR: expected: mfg: 0x33c, part: 0x2345, ver: 0x1
1718 ERROR: got: mfg: 0x787, part: 0xf0f0, ver: 0x3
1719 @end example
1720
1721 There are more complex examples too, with chips that have
1722 multiple TAPs. Ones worth looking at include:
1723
1724 @itemize
1725 @item @file{target/omap3530.cfg} -- with disabled ARM and DSP,
1726 plus a JRC to enable them
1727 @item @file{target/str912.cfg} -- with flash, CPU, and boundary scan
1728 @item @file{target/ti_dm355.cfg} -- with ETM, ARM, and JRC (this JRC
1729 is not currently used)
1730 @end itemize
1731
1732 @subsection Add CPU targets
1733
1734 After adding a TAP for a CPU, you should set it up so that
1735 GDB and other commands can use it.
1736 @xref{CPU Configuration}.
1737 For the at91sam7 example above, the command can look like this;
1738 note that @code{$_ENDIAN} is not needed, since OpenOCD defaults
1739 to little endian, and this chip doesn't support changing that.
1740
1741 @example
1742 set _TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.cpu
1743 target create $_TARGETNAME arm7tdmi -chain-position $_TARGETNAME
1744 @end example
1745
1746 Work areas are small RAM areas associated with CPU targets.
1747 They are used by OpenOCD to speed up downloads,
1748 and to download small snippets of code to program flash chips.
1749 If the chip includes a form of ``on-chip-ram'' - and many do - define
1750 a work area if you can.
1751 Again using the at91sam7 as an example, this can look like:
1752
1753 @example
1754 $_TARGETNAME configure -work-area-phys 0x00200000 \
1755 -work-area-size 0x4000 -work-area-backup 0
1756 @end example
1757
1758 @anchor{definecputargetsworkinginsmp}
1759 @subsection Define CPU targets working in SMP
1760 @cindex SMP
1761 After setting targets, you can define a list of targets working in SMP.
1762
1763 @example
1764 set _TARGETNAME_1 $_CHIPNAME.cpu1
1765 set _TARGETNAME_2 $_CHIPNAME.cpu2
1766 target create $_TARGETNAME_1 cortex_a -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.dap \
1767 -coreid 0 -dbgbase $_DAP_DBG1
1768 target create $_TARGETNAME_2 cortex_a -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.dap \
1769 -coreid 1 -dbgbase $_DAP_DBG2
1770 #define 2 targets working in smp.
1771 target smp $_CHIPNAME.cpu2 $_CHIPNAME.cpu1
1772 @end example
1773 In the above example on cortex_a, 2 cpus are working in SMP.
1774 In SMP only one GDB instance is created and :
1775 @itemize @bullet
1776 @item a set of hardware breakpoint sets the same breakpoint on all targets in the list.
1777 @item halt command triggers the halt of all targets in the list.
1778 @item resume command triggers the write context and the restart of all targets in the list.
1779 @item following a breakpoint: the target stopped by the breakpoint is displayed to the GDB session.
1780 @item dedicated GDB serial protocol packets are implemented for switching/retrieving the target
1781 displayed by the GDB session @pxref{usingopenocdsmpwithgdb,,Using OpenOCD SMP with GDB}.
1782 @end itemize
1783
1784 The SMP behaviour can be disabled/enabled dynamically. On cortex_a following
1785 command have been implemented.
1786 @itemize @bullet
1787 @item cortex_a smp_on : enable SMP mode, behaviour is as described above.
1788 @item cortex_a smp_off : disable SMP mode, the current target is the one
1789 displayed in the GDB session, only this target is now controlled by GDB
1790 session. This behaviour is useful during system boot up.
1791 @item cortex_a smp_gdb : display/fix the core id displayed in GDB session see
1792 following example.
1793 @end itemize
1794
1795 @example
1796 >cortex_a smp_gdb
1797 gdb coreid 0 -> -1
1798 #0 : coreid 0 is displayed to GDB ,
1799 #-> -1 : next resume triggers a real resume
1800 > cortex_a smp_gdb 1
1801 gdb coreid 0 -> 1
1802 #0 :coreid 0 is displayed to GDB ,
1803 #->1 : next resume displays coreid 1 to GDB
1804 > resume
1805 > cortex_a smp_gdb
1806 gdb coreid 1 -> 1
1807 #1 :coreid 1 is displayed to GDB ,
1808 #->1 : next resume displays coreid 1 to GDB
1809 > cortex_a smp_gdb -1
1810 gdb coreid 1 -> -1
1811 #1 :coreid 1 is displayed to GDB,
1812 #->-1 : next resume triggers a real resume
1813 @end example
1814
1815
1816 @subsection Chip Reset Setup
1817
1818 As a rule, you should put the @command{reset_config} command
1819 into the board file. Most things you think you know about a
1820 chip can be tweaked by the board.
1821
1822 Some chips have specific ways the TRST and SRST signals are
1823 managed. In the unusual case that these are @emph{chip specific}
1824 and can never be changed by board wiring, they could go here.
1825 For example, some chips can't support JTAG debugging without
1826 both signals.
1827
1828 Provide a @code{reset-assert} event handler if you can.
1829 Such a handler uses JTAG operations to reset the target,
1830 letting this target config be used in systems which don't
1831 provide the optional SRST signal, or on systems where you
1832 don't want to reset all targets at once.
1833 Such a handler might write to chip registers to force a reset,
1834 use a JRC to do that (preferable -- the target may be wedged!),
1835 or force a watchdog timer to trigger.
1836 (For Cortex-M targets, this is not necessary. The target
1837 driver knows how to use trigger an NVIC reset when SRST is
1838 not available.)
1839
1840 Some chips need special attention during reset handling if
1841 they're going to be used with JTAG.
1842 An example might be needing to send some commands right
1843 after the target's TAP has been reset, providing a
1844 @code{reset-deassert-post} event handler that writes a chip
1845 register to report that JTAG debugging is being done.
1846 Another would be reconfiguring the watchdog so that it stops
1847 counting while the core is halted in the debugger.
1848
1849 JTAG clocking constraints often change during reset, and in
1850 some cases target config files (rather than board config files)
1851 are the right places to handle some of those issues.
1852 For example, immediately after reset most chips run using a
1853 slower clock than they will use later.
1854 That means that after reset (and potentially, as OpenOCD
1855 first starts up) they must use a slower JTAG clock rate
1856 than they will use later.
1857 @xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.
1858
1859 @quotation Important
1860 When you are debugging code that runs right after chip
1861 reset, getting these issues right is critical.
1862 In particular, if you see intermittent failures when
1863 OpenOCD verifies the scan chain after reset,
1864 look at how you are setting up JTAG clocking.
1865 @end quotation
1866
1867 @anchor{theinittargetsprocedure}
1868 @subsection The init_targets procedure
1869 @cindex init_targets procedure
1870
1871 Target config files can either be ``linear'' (script executed line-by-line when parsed in
1872 configuration stage, @xref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage},) or they can contain a special
1873 procedure called @code{init_targets}, which will be executed when entering run stage
1874 (after parsing all config files or after @code{init} command, @xref{enteringtherunstage,,Entering the Run Stage}.)
1875 Such procedure can be overriden by ``next level'' script (which sources the original).
1876 This concept faciliates code reuse when basic target config files provide generic configuration
1877 procedures and @code{init_targets} procedure, which can then be sourced and enchanced or changed in
1878 a ``more specific'' target config file. This is not possible with ``linear'' config scripts,
1879 because sourcing them executes every initialization commands they provide.
1880
1881 @example
1882 ### generic_file.cfg ###
1883
1884 proc setup_my_chip @{chip_name flash_size ram_size@} @{
1885 # basic initialization procedure ...
1886 @}
1887
1888 proc init_targets @{@} @{
1889 # initializes generic chip with 4kB of flash and 1kB of RAM
1890 setup_my_chip MY_GENERIC_CHIP 4096 1024
1891 @}
1892
1893 ### specific_file.cfg ###
1894
1895 source [find target/generic_file.cfg]
1896
1897 proc init_targets @{@} @{
1898 # initializes specific chip with 128kB of flash and 64kB of RAM
1899 setup_my_chip MY_CHIP_WITH_128K_FLASH_64KB_RAM 131072 65536
1900 @}
1901 @end example
1902
1903 The easiest way to convert ``linear'' config files to @code{init_targets} version is to
1904 enclose every line of ``code'' (i.e. not @code{source} commands, procedures, etc.) in this procedure.
1905
1906 For an example of this scheme see LPC2000 target config files.
1907
1908 The @code{init_boards} procedure is a similar concept concerning board config files
1909 (@xref{theinitboardprocedure,,The init_board procedure}.)
1910
1911 @anchor{theinittargeteventsprocedure}
1912 @subsection The init_target_events procedure
1913 @cindex init_target_events procedure
1914
1915 A special procedure called @code{init_target_events} is run just after
1916 @code{init_targets} (@xref{theinittargetsprocedure,,The init_targets
1917 procedure}.) and before @code{init_board}
1918 (@xref{theinitboardprocedure,,The init_board procedure}.) It is used
1919 to set up default target events for the targets that do not have those
1920 events already assigned.
1921
1922 @subsection ARM Core Specific Hacks
1923
1924 If the chip has a DCC, enable it. If the chip is an ARM9 with some
1925 special high speed download features - enable it.
1926
1927 If present, the MMU, the MPU and the CACHE should be disabled.
1928
1929 Some ARM cores are equipped with trace support, which permits
1930 examination of the instruction and data bus activity. Trace
1931 activity is controlled through an ``Embedded Trace Module'' (ETM)
1932 on one of the core's scan chains. The ETM emits voluminous data
1933 through a ``trace port''. (@xref{armhardwaretracing,,ARM Hardware Tracing}.)
1934 If you are using an external trace port,
1935 configure it in your board config file.
1936 If you are using an on-chip ``Embedded Trace Buffer'' (ETB),
1937 configure it in your target config file.
1938
1939 @example
1940 etm config $_TARGETNAME 16 normal full etb
1941 etb config $_TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.etb
1942 @end example
1943
1944 @subsection Internal Flash Configuration
1945
1946 This applies @b{ONLY TO MICROCONTROLLERS} that have flash built in.
1947
1948 @b{Never ever} in the ``target configuration file'' define any type of
1949 flash that is external to the chip. (For example a BOOT flash on
1950 Chip Select 0.) Such flash information goes in a board file - not
1951 the TARGET (chip) file.
1952
1953 Examples:
1954 @itemize @bullet
1955 @item at91sam7x256 - has 256K flash YES enable it.
1956 @item str912 - has flash internal YES enable it.
1957 @item imx27 - uses boot flash on CS0 - it goes in the board file.
1958 @item pxa270 - again - CS0 flash - it goes in the board file.
1959 @end itemize
1960
1961 @anchor{translatingconfigurationfiles}
1962 @section Translating Configuration Files
1963 @cindex translation
1964 If you have a configuration file for another hardware debugger
1965 or toolset (Abatron, BDI2000, BDI3000, CCS,
1966 Lauterbach, SEGGER, Macraigor, etc.), translating
1967 it into OpenOCD syntax is often quite straightforward. The most tricky
1968 part of creating a configuration script is oftentimes the reset init
1969 sequence where e.g. PLLs, DRAM and the like is set up.
1970
1971 One trick that you can use when translating is to write small
1972 Tcl procedures to translate the syntax into OpenOCD syntax. This
1973 can avoid manual translation errors and make it easier to
1974 convert other scripts later on.
1975
1976 Example of transforming quirky arguments to a simple search and
1977 replace job:
1978
1979 @example
1980 # Lauterbach syntax(?)
1981 #
1982 # Data.Set c15:0x042f %long 0x40000015
1983 #
1984 # OpenOCD syntax when using procedure below.
1985 #
1986 # setc15 0x01 0x00050078
1987
1988 proc setc15 @{regs value@} @{
1989 global TARGETNAME
1990
1991 echo [format "set p15 0x%04x, 0x%08x" $regs $value]
1992
1993 arm mcr 15 [expr ($regs>>12)&0x7] \
1994 [expr ($regs>>0)&0xf] [expr ($regs>>4)&0xf] \
1995 [expr ($regs>>8)&0x7] $value
1996 @}
1997 @end example
1998
1999
2000
2001 @node Server Configuration
2002 @chapter Server Configuration
2003 @cindex initialization
2004 The commands here are commonly found in the openocd.cfg file and are
2005 used to specify what TCP/IP ports are used, and how GDB should be
2006 supported.
2007
2008 @anchor{configurationstage}
2009 @section Configuration Stage
2010 @cindex configuration stage
2011 @cindex config command
2012
2013 When the OpenOCD server process starts up, it enters a
2014 @emph{configuration stage} which is the only time that
2015 certain commands, @emph{configuration commands}, may be issued.
2016 Normally, configuration commands are only available
2017 inside startup scripts.
2018
2019 In this manual, the definition of a configuration command is
2020 presented as a @emph{Config Command}, not as a @emph{Command}
2021 which may be issued interactively.
2022 The runtime @command{help} command also highlights configuration
2023 commands, and those which may be issued at any time.
2024
2025 Those configuration commands include declaration of TAPs,
2026 flash banks,
2027 the interface used for JTAG communication,
2028 and other basic setup.
2029 The server must leave the configuration stage before it
2030 may access or activate TAPs.
2031 After it leaves this stage, configuration commands may no
2032 longer be issued.
2033
2034 @anchor{enteringtherunstage}
2035 @section Entering the Run Stage
2036
2037 The first thing OpenOCD does after leaving the configuration
2038 stage is to verify that it can talk to the scan chain
2039 (list of TAPs) which has been configured.
2040 It will warn if it doesn't find TAPs it expects to find,
2041 or finds TAPs that aren't supposed to be there.
2042 You should see no errors at this point.
2043 If you see errors, resolve them by correcting the
2044 commands you used to configure the server.
2045 Common errors include using an initial JTAG speed that's too
2046 fast, and not providing the right IDCODE values for the TAPs
2047 on the scan chain.
2048
2049 Once OpenOCD has entered the run stage, a number of commands
2050 become available.
2051 A number of these relate to the debug targets you may have declared.
2052 For example, the @command{mww} command will not be available until
2053 a target has been successfuly instantiated.
2054 If you want to use those commands, you may need to force
2055 entry to the run stage.
2056
2057 @deffn {Config Command} init
2058 This command terminates the configuration stage and
2059 enters the run stage. This helps when you need to have
2060 the startup scripts manage tasks such as resetting the target,
2061 programming flash, etc. To reset the CPU upon startup, add "init" and
2062 "reset" at the end of the config script or at the end of the OpenOCD
2063 command line using the @option{-c} command line switch.
2064
2065 If this command does not appear in any startup/configuration file
2066 OpenOCD executes the command for you after processing all
2067 configuration files and/or command line options.
2068
2069 @b{NOTE:} This command normally occurs at or near the end of your
2070 openocd.cfg file to force OpenOCD to ``initialize'' and make the
2071 targets ready. For example: If your openocd.cfg file needs to
2072 read/write memory on your target, @command{init} must occur before
2073 the memory read/write commands. This includes @command{nand probe}.
2074 @end deffn
2075
2076 @deffn {Overridable Procedure} jtag_init
2077 This is invoked at server startup to verify that it can talk
2078 to the scan chain (list of TAPs) which has been configured.
2079
2080 The default implementation first tries @command{jtag arp_init},
2081 which uses only a lightweight JTAG reset before examining the
2082 scan chain.
2083 If that fails, it tries again, using a harder reset
2084 from the overridable procedure @command{init_reset}.
2085
2086 Implementations must have verified the JTAG scan chain before
2087 they return.
2088 This is done by calling @command{jtag arp_init}
2089 (or @command{jtag arp_init-reset}).
2090 @end deffn
2091
2092 @anchor{tcpipports}
2093 @section TCP/IP Ports
2094 @cindex TCP port
2095 @cindex server
2096 @cindex port
2097 @cindex security
2098 The OpenOCD server accepts remote commands in several syntaxes.
2099 Each syntax uses a different TCP/IP port, which you may specify
2100 only during configuration (before those ports are opened).
2101
2102 For reasons including security, you may wish to prevent remote
2103 access using one or more of these ports.
2104 In such cases, just specify the relevant port number as "disabled".
2105 If you disable all access through TCP/IP, you will need to
2106 use the command line @option{-pipe} option.
2107
2108 @deffn {Command} gdb_port [number]
2109 @cindex GDB server
2110 Normally gdb listens to a TCP/IP port, but GDB can also
2111 communicate via pipes(stdin/out or named pipes). The name
2112 "gdb_port" stuck because it covers probably more than 90% of
2113 the normal use cases.
2114
2115 No arguments reports GDB port. "pipe" means listen to stdin
2116 output to stdout, an integer is base port number, "disabled"
2117 disables the gdb server.
2118
2119 When using "pipe", also use log_output to redirect the log
2120 output to a file so as not to flood the stdin/out pipes.
2121
2122 The -p/--pipe option is deprecated and a warning is printed
2123 as it is equivalent to passing in -c "gdb_port pipe; log_output openocd.log".
2124
2125 Any other string is interpreted as named pipe to listen to.
2126 Output pipe is the same name as input pipe, but with 'o' appended,
2127 e.g. /var/gdb, /var/gdbo.
2128
2129 The GDB port for the first target will be the base port, the
2130 second target will listen on gdb_port + 1, and so on.
2131 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2132 the port @var{number} defaults to 3333.
2133
2134 Note: when using "gdb_port pipe", increasing the default remote timeout in
2135 gdb (with 'set remotetimeout') is recommended. An insufficient timeout may
2136 cause initialization to fail with "Unknown remote qXfer reply: OK".
2137
2138 @end deffn
2139
2140 @deffn {Command} tcl_port [number]
2141 Specify or query the port used for a simplified RPC
2142 connection that can be used by clients to issue TCL commands and get the
2143 output from the Tcl engine.
2144 Intended as a machine interface.
2145 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2146 the port @var{number} defaults to 6666.
2147 When specified as "disabled", this service is not activated.
2148 @end deffn
2149
2150 @deffn {Command} telnet_port [number]
2151 Specify or query the
2152 port on which to listen for incoming telnet connections.
2153 This port is intended for interaction with one human through TCL commands.
2154 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2155 the port @var{number} defaults to 4444.
2156 When specified as "disabled", this service is not activated.
2157 @end deffn
2158
2159 @anchor{gdbconfiguration}
2160 @section GDB Configuration
2161 @cindex GDB
2162 @cindex GDB configuration
2163 You can reconfigure some GDB behaviors if needed.
2164 The ones listed here are static and global.
2165 @xref{targetconfiguration,,Target Configuration}, about configuring individual targets.
2166 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}, about configuring target-specific event handling.
2167
2168 @anchor{gdbbreakpointoverride}
2169 @deffn {Command} gdb_breakpoint_override [@option{hard}|@option{soft}|@option{disable}]
2170 Force breakpoint type for gdb @command{break} commands.
2171 This option supports GDB GUIs which don't
2172 distinguish hard versus soft breakpoints, if the default OpenOCD and
2173 GDB behaviour is not sufficient. GDB normally uses hardware
2174 breakpoints if the memory map has been set up for flash regions.
2175 @end deffn
2176
2177 @anchor{gdbflashprogram}
2178 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_flash_program (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2179 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to program the flash memory when a
2180 vFlash packet is received.
2181 The default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2182 @end deffn
2183
2184 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_memory_map (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2185 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to send the memory configuration to GDB when
2186 requested. GDB will then know when to set hardware breakpoints, and program flash
2187 using the GDB load command. @command{gdb_flash_program enable} must also be enabled
2188 for flash programming to work.
2189 Default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2190 @xref{gdbflashprogram,,gdb_flash_program}.
2191 @end deffn
2192
2193 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_report_data_abort (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2194 Specifies whether data aborts cause an error to be reported
2195 by GDB memory read packets.
2196 The default behaviour is @option{disable};
2197 use @option{enable} see these errors reported.
2198 @end deffn
2199
2200 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_target_description (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2201 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to send the target descriptions to gdb via qXfer:features:read packet.
2202 The default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2203 @end deffn
2204
2205 @deffn {Command} gdb_save_tdesc
2206 Saves the target descripton file to the local file system.
2207
2208 The file name is @i{target_name}.xml.
2209 @end deffn
2210
2211 @anchor{eventpolling}
2212 @section Event Polling
2213
2214 Hardware debuggers are parts of asynchronous systems,
2215 where significant events can happen at any time.
2216 The OpenOCD server needs to detect some of these events,
2217 so it can report them to through TCL command line
2218 or to GDB.
2219
2220 Examples of such events include:
2221
2222 @itemize
2223 @item One of the targets can stop running ... maybe it triggers
2224 a code breakpoint or data watchpoint, or halts itself.
2225 @item Messages may be sent over ``debug message'' channels ... many
2226 targets support such messages sent over JTAG,
2227 for receipt by the person debugging or tools.
2228 @item Loss of power ... some adapters can detect these events.
2229 @item Resets not issued through JTAG ... such reset sources
2230 can include button presses or other system hardware, sometimes
2231 including the target itself (perhaps through a watchdog).
2232 @item Debug instrumentation sometimes supports event triggering
2233 such as ``trace buffer full'' (so it can quickly be emptied)
2234 or other signals (to correlate with code behavior).
2235 @end itemize
2236
2237 None of those events are signaled through standard JTAG signals.
2238 However, most conventions for JTAG connectors include voltage
2239 level and system reset (SRST) signal detection.
2240 Some connectors also include instrumentation signals, which
2241 can imply events when those signals are inputs.
2242
2243 In general, OpenOCD needs to periodically check for those events,
2244 either by looking at the status of signals on the JTAG connector
2245 or by sending synchronous ``tell me your status'' JTAG requests
2246 to the various active targets.
2247 There is a command to manage and monitor that polling,
2248 which is normally done in the background.
2249
2250 @deffn Command poll [@option{on}|@option{off}]
2251 Poll the current target for its current state.
2252 (Also, @pxref{targetcurstate,,target curstate}.)
2253 If that target is in debug mode, architecture
2254 specific information about the current state is printed.
2255 An optional parameter
2256 allows background polling to be enabled and disabled.
2257
2258 You could use this from the TCL command shell, or
2259 from GDB using @command{monitor poll} command.
2260 Leave background polling enabled while you're using GDB.
2261 @example
2262 > poll
2263 background polling: on
2264 target state: halted
2265 target halted in ARM state due to debug-request, \
2266 current mode: Supervisor
2267 cpsr: 0x800000d3 pc: 0x11081bfc
2268 MMU: disabled, D-Cache: disabled, I-Cache: enabled
2269 >
2270 @end example
2271 @end deffn
2272
2273 @node Debug Adapter Configuration
2274 @chapter Debug Adapter Configuration
2275 @cindex config file, interface
2276 @cindex interface config file
2277
2278 Correctly installing OpenOCD includes making your operating system give
2279 OpenOCD access to debug adapters. Once that has been done, Tcl commands
2280 are used to select which one is used, and to configure how it is used.
2281
2282 @quotation Note
2283 Because OpenOCD started out with a focus purely on JTAG, you may find
2284 places where it wrongly presumes JTAG is the only transport protocol
2285 in use. Be aware that recent versions of OpenOCD are removing that
2286 limitation. JTAG remains more functional than most other transports.
2287 Other transports do not support boundary scan operations, or may be
2288 specific to a given chip vendor. Some might be usable only for
2289 programming flash memory, instead of also for debugging.
2290 @end quotation
2291
2292 Debug Adapters/Interfaces/Dongles are normally configured
2293 through commands in an interface configuration
2294 file which is sourced by your @file{openocd.cfg} file, or
2295 through a command line @option{-f interface/....cfg} option.
2296
2297 @example
2298 source [find interface/olimex-jtag-tiny.cfg]
2299 @end example
2300
2301 These commands tell
2302 OpenOCD what type of JTAG adapter you have, and how to talk to it.
2303 A few cases are so simple that you only need to say what driver to use:
2304
2305 @example
2306 # jlink interface
2307 interface jlink
2308 @end example
2309
2310 Most adapters need a bit more configuration than that.
2311
2312
2313 @section Interface Configuration
2314
2315 The interface command tells OpenOCD what type of debug adapter you are
2316 using. Depending on the type of adapter, you may need to use one or
2317 more additional commands to further identify or configure the adapter.
2318
2319 @deffn {Config Command} {interface} name
2320 Use the interface driver @var{name} to connect to the
2321 target.
2322 @end deffn
2323
2324 @deffn Command {interface_list}
2325 List the debug adapter drivers that have been built into
2326 the running copy of OpenOCD.
2327 @end deffn
2328 @deffn Command {interface transports} transport_name+
2329 Specifies the transports supported by this debug adapter.
2330 The adapter driver builds-in similar knowledge; use this only
2331 when external configuration (such as jumpering) changes what
2332 the hardware can support.
2333 @end deffn
2334
2335
2336
2337 @deffn Command {adapter_name}
2338 Returns the name of the debug adapter driver being used.
2339 @end deffn
2340
2341 @section Interface Drivers
2342
2343 Each of the interface drivers listed here must be explicitly
2344 enabled when OpenOCD is configured, in order to be made
2345 available at run time.
2346
2347 @deffn {Interface Driver} {amt_jtagaccel}
2348 Amontec Chameleon in its JTAG Accelerator configuration,
2349 connected to a PC's EPP mode parallel port.
2350 This defines some driver-specific commands:
2351
2352 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_port} number
2353 Specifies either the address of the I/O port (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or
2354 the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
2355 @end deffn
2356
2357 @deffn {Config Command} rtck [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
2358 Displays status of RTCK option.
2359 Optionally sets that option first.
2360 @end deffn
2361 @end deffn
2362
2363 @deffn {Interface Driver} {arm-jtag-ew}
2364 Olimex ARM-JTAG-EW USB adapter
2365 This has one driver-specific command:
2366
2367 @deffn Command {armjtagew_info}
2368 Logs some status
2369 @end deffn
2370 @end deffn
2371
2372 @deffn {Interface Driver} {at91rm9200}
2373 Supports bitbanged JTAG from the local system,
2374 presuming that system is an Atmel AT91rm9200
2375 and a specific set of GPIOs is used.
2376 @c command: at91rm9200_device NAME
2377 @c chooses among list of bit configs ... only one option
2378 @end deffn
2379
2380 @deffn {Interface Driver} {cmsis-dap}
2381 ARM CMSIS-DAP compliant based adapter.
2382
2383 @deffn {Config Command} {cmsis_dap_vid_pid} [vid pid]+
2384 The vendor ID and product ID of the CMSIS-DAP device. If not specified
2385 the driver will attempt to auto detect the CMSIS-DAP device.
2386 Currently, up to eight [@var{vid}, @var{pid}] pairs may be given, e.g.
2387 @example
2388 cmsis_dap_vid_pid 0xc251 0xf001 0x0d28 0x0204
2389 @end example
2390 @end deffn
2391
2392 @deffn {Config Command} {cmsis_dap_serial} [serial]
2393 Specifies the @var{serial} of the CMSIS-DAP device to use.
2394 If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2395 @end deffn
2396
2397 @deffn {Command} {cmsis-dap info}
2398 Display various device information, like hardware version, firmware version, current bus status.
2399 @end deffn
2400 @end deffn
2401
2402 @deffn {Interface Driver} {dummy}
2403 A dummy software-only driver for debugging.
2404 @end deffn
2405
2406 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ep93xx}
2407 Cirrus Logic EP93xx based single-board computer bit-banging (in development)
2408 @end deffn
2409
2410 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ftdi}
2411 This driver is for adapters using the MPSSE (Multi-Protocol Synchronous Serial
2412 Engine) mode built into many FTDI chips, such as the FT2232, FT4232 and FT232H.
2413
2414 The driver is using libusb-1.0 in asynchronous mode to talk to the FTDI device,
2415 bypassing intermediate libraries like libftdi or D2XX.
2416
2417 Support for new FTDI based adapters can be added competely through
2418 configuration files, without the need to patch and rebuild OpenOCD.
2419
2420 The driver uses a signal abstraction to enable Tcl configuration files to
2421 define outputs for one or several FTDI GPIO. These outputs can then be
2422 controlled using the @command{ftdi_set_signal} command. Special signal names
2423 are reserved for nTRST, nSRST and LED (for blink) so that they, if defined,
2424 will be used for their customary purpose. Inputs can be read using the
2425 @command{ftdi_get_signal} command.
2426
2427 To support SWD, a signal named SWD_EN must be defined. It is set to 1 when the
2428 SWD protocol is selected. When set, the adapter should route the SWDIO pin to
2429 the data input. An SWDIO_OE signal, if defined, will be set to 1 or 0 as
2430 required by the protocol, to tell the adapter to drive the data output onto
2431 the SWDIO pin or keep the SWDIO pin Hi-Z, respectively.
2432
2433 Depending on the type of buffer attached to the FTDI GPIO, the outputs have to
2434 be controlled differently. In order to support tristateable signals such as
2435 nSRST, both a data GPIO and an output-enable GPIO can be specified for each
2436 signal. The following output buffer configurations are supported:
2437
2438 @itemize @minus
2439 @item Push-pull with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted data line
2440 @item Open drain with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted output-enable
2441 @item Tristate with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted data line and another
2442 FTDI output as (non-)inverted output-enable
2443 @item Unbuffered, using the FTDI GPIO as a tristate output directly by
2444 switching data and direction as necessary
2445 @end itemize
2446
2447 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2448 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2449
2450 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_vid_pid} [vid pid]+
2451 The vendor ID and product ID of the adapter. Up to eight
2452 [@var{vid}, @var{pid}] pairs may be given, e.g.
2453 @example
2454 ftdi_vid_pid 0x0403 0xcff8 0x15ba 0x0003
2455 @end example
2456 @end deffn
2457
2458 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_device_desc} description
2459 Provides the USB device description (the @emph{iProduct string})
2460 of the adapter. If not specified, the device description is ignored
2461 during device selection.
2462 @end deffn
2463
2464 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_serial} serial-number
2465 Specifies the @var{serial-number} of the adapter to use,
2466 in case the vendor provides unique IDs and more than one adapter
2467 is connected to the host.
2468 If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2469 (Note that USB serial numbers can be arbitrary Unicode strings,
2470 and are not restricted to containing only decimal digits.)
2471 @end deffn
2472
2473 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_location} <bus>:<port>[,<port>]...
2474 Specifies the physical USB port of the adapter to use. The path
2475 roots at @var{bus} and walks down the physical ports, with each
2476 @var{port} option specifying a deeper level in the bus topology, the last
2477 @var{port} denoting where the target adapter is actually plugged.
2478 The USB bus topology can be queried with the command @emph{lsusb -t}.
2479
2480 This command is only available if your libusb1 is at least version 1.0.16.
2481 @end deffn
2482
2483 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_channel} channel
2484 Selects the channel of the FTDI device to use for MPSSE operations. Most
2485 adapters use the default, channel 0, but there are exceptions.
2486 @end deffn
2487
2488 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_layout_init} data direction
2489 Specifies the initial values of the FTDI GPIO data and direction registers.
2490 Each value is a 16-bit number corresponding to the concatenation of the high
2491 and low FTDI GPIO registers. The values should be selected based on the
2492 schematics of the adapter, such that all signals are set to safe levels with
2493 minimal impact on the target system. Avoid floating inputs, conflicting outputs
2494 and initially asserted reset signals.
2495 @end deffn
2496
2497 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_layout_signal} name [@option{-data}|@option{-ndata} data_mask] [@option{-input}|@option{-ninput} input_mask] [@option{-oe}|@option{-noe} oe_mask] [@option{-alias}|@option{-nalias} name]
2498 Creates a signal with the specified @var{name}, controlled by one or more FTDI
2499 GPIO pins via a range of possible buffer connections. The masks are FTDI GPIO
2500 register bitmasks to tell the driver the connection and type of the output
2501 buffer driving the respective signal. @var{data_mask} is the bitmask for the
2502 pin(s) connected to the data input of the output buffer. @option{-ndata} is
2503 used with inverting data inputs and @option{-data} with non-inverting inputs.
2504 The @option{-oe} (or @option{-noe}) option tells where the output-enable (or
2505 not-output-enable) input to the output buffer is connected. The options
2506 @option{-input} and @option{-ninput} specify the bitmask for pins to be read
2507 with the method @command{ftdi_get_signal}.
2508
2509 Both @var{data_mask} and @var{oe_mask} need not be specified. For example, a
2510 simple open-collector transistor driver would be specified with @option{-oe}
2511 only. In that case the signal can only be set to drive low or to Hi-Z and the
2512 driver will complain if the signal is set to drive high. Which means that if
2513 it's a reset signal, @command{reset_config} must be specified as
2514 @option{srst_open_drain}, not @option{srst_push_pull}.
2515
2516 A special case is provided when @option{-data} and @option{-oe} is set to the
2517 same bitmask. Then the FTDI pin is considered being connected straight to the
2518 target without any buffer. The FTDI pin is then switched between output and
2519 input as necessary to provide the full set of low, high and Hi-Z
2520 characteristics. In all other cases, the pins specified in a signal definition
2521 are always driven by the FTDI.
2522
2523 If @option{-alias} or @option{-nalias} is used, the signal is created
2524 identical (or with data inverted) to an already specified signal
2525 @var{name}.
2526 @end deffn
2527
2528 @deffn {Command} {ftdi_set_signal} name @option{0}|@option{1}|@option{z}
2529 Set a previously defined signal to the specified level.
2530 @itemize @minus
2531 @item @option{0}, drive low
2532 @item @option{1}, drive high
2533 @item @option{z}, set to high-impedance
2534 @end itemize
2535 @end deffn
2536
2537 @deffn {Command} {ftdi_get_signal} name
2538 Get the value of a previously defined signal.
2539 @end deffn
2540
2541 @deffn {Command} {ftdi_tdo_sample_edge} @option{rising}|@option{falling}
2542 Configure TCK edge at which the adapter samples the value of the TDO signal
2543
2544 Due to signal propagation delays, sampling TDO on rising TCK can become quite
2545 peculiar at high JTAG clock speeds. However, FTDI chips offer a possiblity to sample
2546 TDO on falling edge of TCK. With some board/adapter configurations, this may increase
2547 stability at higher JTAG clocks.
2548 @itemize @minus
2549 @item @option{rising}, sample TDO on rising edge of TCK - this is the default
2550 @item @option{falling}, sample TDO on falling edge of TCK
2551 @end itemize
2552 @end deffn
2553
2554 For example adapter definitions, see the configuration files shipped in the
2555 @file{interface/ftdi} directory.
2556
2557 @end deffn
2558
2559 @deffn {Interface Driver} {remote_bitbang}
2560 Drive JTAG from a remote process. This sets up a UNIX or TCP socket connection
2561 with a remote process and sends ASCII encoded bitbang requests to that process
2562 instead of directly driving JTAG.
2563
2564 The remote_bitbang driver is useful for debugging software running on
2565 processors which are being simulated.
2566
2567 @deffn {Config Command} {remote_bitbang_port} number
2568 Specifies the TCP port of the remote process to connect to or 0 to use UNIX
2569 sockets instead of TCP.
2570 @end deffn
2571
2572 @deffn {Config Command} {remote_bitbang_host} hostname
2573 Specifies the hostname of the remote process to connect to using TCP, or the
2574 name of the UNIX socket to use if remote_bitbang_port is 0.
2575 @end deffn
2576
2577 For example, to connect remotely via TCP to the host foobar you might have
2578 something like:
2579
2580 @example
2581 interface remote_bitbang
2582 remote_bitbang_port 3335
2583 remote_bitbang_host foobar
2584 @end example
2585
2586 To connect to another process running locally via UNIX sockets with socket
2587 named mysocket:
2588
2589 @example
2590 interface remote_bitbang
2591 remote_bitbang_port 0
2592 remote_bitbang_host mysocket
2593 @end example
2594 @end deffn
2595
2596 @deffn {Interface Driver} {usb_blaster}
2597 USB JTAG/USB-Blaster compatibles over one of the userspace libraries
2598 for FTDI chips. These interfaces have several commands, used to
2599 configure the driver before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2600
2601 @deffn {Config Command} {usb_blaster_device_desc} description
2602 Provides the USB device description (the @emph{iProduct string})
2603 of the FTDI FT245 device. If not
2604 specified, the FTDI default value is used. This setting is only valid
2605 if compiled with FTD2XX support.
2606 @end deffn
2607
2608 @deffn {Config Command} {usb_blaster_vid_pid} vid pid
2609 The vendor ID and product ID of the FTDI FT245 device. If not specified,
2610 default values are used.
2611 Currently, only one @var{vid}, @var{pid} pair may be given, e.g. for
2612 Altera USB-Blaster (default):
2613 @example
2614 usb_blaster_vid_pid 0x09FB 0x6001
2615 @end example
2616 The following VID/PID is for Kolja Waschk's USB JTAG:
2617 @example
2618 usb_blaster_vid_pid 0x16C0 0x06AD
2619 @end example
2620 @end deffn
2621
2622 @deffn {Command} {usb_blaster_pin} (@option{pin6}|@option{pin8}) (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{s}|@option{t})
2623 Sets the state or function of the unused GPIO pins on USB-Blasters
2624 (pins 6 and 8 on the female JTAG header). These pins can be used as
2625 SRST and/or TRST provided the appropriate connections are made on the
2626 target board.
2627
2628 For example, to use pin 6 as SRST:
2629 @example
2630 usb_blaster_pin pin6 s
2631 reset_config srst_only
2632 @end example
2633 @end deffn
2634
2635 @deffn {Command} {usb_blaster_lowlevel_driver} (@option{ftdi}|@option{ublast2})
2636 Chooses the low level access method for the adapter. If not specified,
2637 @option{ftdi} is selected unless it wasn't enabled during the
2638 configure stage. USB-Blaster II needs @option{ublast2}.
2639 @end deffn
2640
2641 @deffn {Command} {usb_blaster_firmware} @var{path}
2642 This command specifies @var{path} to access USB-Blaster II firmware
2643 image. To be used with USB-Blaster II only.
2644 @end deffn
2645
2646 @end deffn
2647
2648 @deffn {Interface Driver} {gw16012}
2649 Gateworks GW16012 JTAG programmer.
2650 This has one driver-specific command:
2651
2652 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_port} [port_number]
2653 Display either the address of the I/O port
2654 (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
2655 If a parameter is provided, first switch to use that port.
2656 This is a write-once setting.
2657 @end deffn
2658 @end deffn
2659
2660 @deffn {Interface Driver} {jlink}
2661 SEGGER J-Link family of USB adapters. It currently supports JTAG and SWD
2662 transports.
2663
2664 @quotation Compatibility Note
2665 SEGGER released many firmware versions for the many harware versions they
2666 produced. OpenOCD was extensively tested and intended to run on all of them,
2667 but some combinations were reported as incompatible. As a general
2668 recommendation, it is advisable to use the latest firmware version
2669 available for each hardware version. However the current V8 is a moving
2670 target, and SEGGER firmware versions released after the OpenOCD was
2671 released may not be compatible. In such cases it is recommended to
2672 revert to the last known functional version. For 0.5.0, this is from
2673 "Feb 8 2012 14:30:39", packed with 4.42c. For 0.6.0, the last known
2674 version is from "May 3 2012 18:36:22", packed with 4.46f.
2675 @end quotation
2676
2677 @deffn {Command} {jlink hwstatus}
2678 Display various hardware related information, for example target voltage and pin
2679 states.
2680 @end deffn
2681 @deffn {Command} {jlink freemem}
2682 Display free device internal memory.
2683 @end deffn
2684 @deffn {Command} {jlink jtag} [@option{2}|@option{3}]
2685 Set the JTAG command version to be used. Without argument, show the actual JTAG
2686 command version.
2687 @end deffn
2688 @deffn {Command} {jlink config}
2689 Display the device configuration.
2690 @end deffn
2691 @deffn {Command} {jlink config targetpower} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
2692 Set the target power state on JTAG-pin 19. Without argument, show the target
2693 power state.
2694 @end deffn
2695 @deffn {Command} {jlink config mac} [@option{ff:ff:ff:ff:ff:ff}]
2696 Set the MAC address of the device. Without argument, show the MAC address.
2697 @end deffn
2698 @deffn {Command} {jlink config ip} [@option{A.B.C.D}(@option{/E}|@option{F.G.H.I})]
2699 Set the IP configuration of the device, where A.B.C.D is the IP address, E the
2700 bit of the subnet mask and F.G.H.I the subnet mask. Without arguments, show the
2701 IP configuration.
2702 @end deffn
2703 @deffn {Command} {jlink config usb} [@option{0} to @option{3}]
2704 Set the USB address of the device. This will also change the USB Product ID
2705 (PID) of the device. Without argument, show the USB address.
2706 @end deffn
2707 @deffn {Command} {jlink config reset}
2708 Reset the current configuration.
2709 @end deffn
2710 @deffn {Command} {jlink config write}
2711 Write the current configuration to the internal persistent storage.
2712 @end deffn
2713 @deffn {Command} {jlink emucom write <channel> <data>}
2714 Write data to an EMUCOM channel. The data needs to be encoded as hexadecimal
2715 pairs.
2716
2717 The following example shows how to write the three bytes 0xaa, 0x0b and 0x23 to
2718 the EMUCOM channel 0x10:
2719 @example
2720 > jlink emucom write 0x10 aa0b23
2721 @end example
2722 @end deffn
2723 @deffn {Command} {jlink emucom read <channel> <length>}
2724 Read data from an EMUCOM channel. The read data is encoded as hexadecimal
2725 pairs.
2726
2727 The following example shows how to read 4 bytes from the EMUCOM channel 0x0:
2728 @example
2729 > jlink emucom read 0x0 4
2730 77a90000
2731 @end example
2732 @end deffn
2733 @deffn {Config} {jlink usb} <@option{0} to @option{3}>
2734 Set the USB address of the interface, in case more than one adapter is connected
2735 to the host. If not specified, USB addresses are not considered. Device
2736 selection via USB address is deprecated and the serial number should be used
2737 instead.
2738
2739 As a configuration command, it can be used only before 'init'.
2740 @end deffn
2741 @deffn {Config} {jlink serial} <serial number>
2742 Set the serial number of the interface, in case more than one adapter is
2743 connected to the host. If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2744
2745 As a configuration command, it can be used only before 'init'.
2746 @end deffn
2747 @end deffn
2748
2749 @deffn {Interface Driver} {kitprog}
2750 This driver is for Cypress Semiconductor's KitProg adapters. The KitProg is an
2751 SWD-only adapter that is designed to be used with Cypress's PSoC and PRoC device
2752 families, but it is possible to use it with some other devices. If you are using
2753 this adapter with a PSoC or a PRoC, you may need to add
2754 @command{kitprog_init_acquire_psoc} or @command{kitprog acquire_psoc} to your
2755 configuration script.
2756
2757 Note that this driver is for the proprietary KitProg protocol, not the CMSIS-DAP
2758 mode introduced in firmware 2.14. If the KitProg is in CMSIS-DAP mode, it cannot
2759 be used with this driver, and must either be used with the cmsis-dap driver or
2760 switched back to KitProg mode. See the Cypress KitProg User Guide for
2761 instructions on how to switch KitProg modes.
2762
2763 Known limitations:
2764 @itemize @bullet
2765 @item The frequency of SWCLK cannot be configured, and varies between 1.6 MHz
2766 and 2.7 MHz.
2767 @item For firmware versions below 2.14, "JTAG to SWD" sequences are replaced by
2768 "SWD line reset" in the driver. This is for two reasons. First, the KitProg does
2769 not support sending arbitrary SWD sequences, and only firmware 2.14 and later
2770 implement both "JTAG to SWD" and "SWD line reset" in firmware. Earlier firmware
2771 versions only implement "SWD line reset". Second, due to a firmware quirk, an
2772 SWD sequence must be sent after every target reset in order to re-establish
2773 communications with the target.
2774 @item Due in part to the limitation above, KitProg devices with firmware below
2775 version 2.14 will need to use @command{kitprog_init_acquire_psoc} in order to
2776 communicate with PSoC 5LP devices. This is because, assuming debug is not
2777 disabled on the PSoC, the PSoC 5LP needs its JTAG interface switched to SWD
2778 mode before communication can begin, but prior to firmware 2.14, "JTAG to SWD"
2779 could only be sent with an acquisition sequence.
2780 @end itemize
2781
2782 @deffn {Config Command} {kitprog_init_acquire_psoc}
2783 Indicate that a PSoC acquisition sequence needs to be run during adapter init.
2784 Please be aware that the acquisition sequence hard-resets the target.
2785 @end deffn
2786
2787 @deffn {Config Command} {kitprog_serial} serial
2788 Select a KitProg device by its @var{serial}. If left unspecified, the first
2789 device detected by OpenOCD will be used.
2790 @end deffn
2791
2792 @deffn {Command} {kitprog acquire_psoc}
2793 Run a PSoC acquisition sequence immediately. Typically, this should not be used
2794 outside of the target-specific configuration scripts since it hard-resets the
2795 target as a side-effect.
2796 This is necessary for "reset halt" on some PSoC 4 series devices.
2797 @end deffn
2798
2799 @deffn {Command} {kitprog info}
2800 Display various adapter information, such as the hardware version, firmware
2801 version, and target voltage.
2802 @end deffn
2803 @end deffn
2804
2805 @deffn {Interface Driver} {parport}
2806 Supports PC parallel port bit-banging cables:
2807 Wigglers, PLD download cable, and more.
2808 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2809 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2810
2811 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_cable} name
2812 Set the layout of the parallel port cable used to connect to the target.
2813 This is a write-once setting.
2814 Currently valid cable @var{name} values include:
2815
2816 @itemize @minus
2817 @item @b{altium} Altium Universal JTAG cable.
2818 @item @b{arm-jtag} Same as original wiggler except SRST and
2819 TRST connections reversed and TRST is also inverted.
2820 @item @b{chameleon} The Amontec Chameleon's CPLD when operated
2821 in configuration mode. This is only used to
2822 program the Chameleon itself, not a connected target.
2823 @item @b{dlc5} The Xilinx Parallel cable III.
2824 @item @b{flashlink} The ST Parallel cable.
2825 @item @b{lattice} Lattice ispDOWNLOAD Cable
2826 @item @b{old_amt_wiggler} The Wiggler configuration that comes with
2827 some versions of
2828 Amontec's Chameleon Programmer. The new version available from
2829 the website uses the original Wiggler layout ('@var{wiggler}')
2830 @item @b{triton} The parallel port adapter found on the
2831 ``Karo Triton 1 Development Board''.
2832 This is also the layout used by the HollyGates design
2833 (see @uref{http://www.lartmaker.nl/projects/jtag/}).
2834 @item @b{wiggler} The original Wiggler layout, also supported by
2835 several clones, such as the Olimex ARM-JTAG
2836 @item @b{wiggler2} Same as original wiggler except an led is fitted on D5.
2837 @item @b{wiggler_ntrst_inverted} Same as original wiggler except TRST is inverted.
2838 @end itemize
2839 @end deffn
2840
2841 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_port} [port_number]
2842 Display either the address of the I/O port
2843 (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
2844 If a parameter is provided, first switch to use that port.
2845 This is a write-once setting.
2846
2847 When using PPDEV to access the parallel port, use the number of the parallel port:
2848 @option{parport_port 0} (the default). If @option{parport_port 0x378} is specified
2849 you may encounter a problem.
2850 @end deffn
2851
2852 @deffn Command {parport_toggling_time} [nanoseconds]
2853 Displays how many nanoseconds the hardware needs to toggle TCK;
2854 the parport driver uses this value to obey the
2855 @command{adapter_khz} configuration.
2856 When the optional @var{nanoseconds} parameter is given,
2857 that setting is changed before displaying the current value.
2858
2859 The default setting should work reasonably well on commodity PC hardware.
2860 However, you may want to calibrate for your specific hardware.
2861 @quotation Tip
2862 To measure the toggling time with a logic analyzer or a digital storage
2863 oscilloscope, follow the procedure below:
2864 @example
2865 > parport_toggling_time 1000
2866 > adapter_khz 500
2867 @end example
2868 This sets the maximum JTAG clock speed of the hardware, but
2869 the actual speed probably deviates from the requested 500 kHz.
2870 Now, measure the time between the two closest spaced TCK transitions.
2871 You can use @command{runtest 1000} or something similar to generate a
2872 large set of samples.
2873 Update the setting to match your measurement:
2874 @example
2875 > parport_toggling_time <measured nanoseconds>
2876 @end example
2877 Now the clock speed will be a better match for @command{adapter_khz rate}
2878 commands given in OpenOCD scripts and event handlers.
2879
2880 You can do something similar with many digital multimeters, but note
2881 that you'll probably need to run the clock continuously for several
2882 seconds before it decides what clock rate to show. Adjust the
2883 toggling time up or down until the measured clock rate is a good
2884 match for the adapter_khz rate you specified; be conservative.
2885 @end quotation
2886 @end deffn
2887
2888 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_write_on_exit} (@option{on}|@option{off})
2889 This will configure the parallel driver to write a known
2890 cable-specific value to the parallel interface on exiting OpenOCD.
2891 @end deffn
2892
2893 For example, the interface configuration file for a
2894 classic ``Wiggler'' cable on LPT2 might look something like this:
2895
2896 @example
2897 interface parport
2898 parport_port 0x278
2899 parport_cable wiggler
2900 @end example
2901 @end deffn
2902
2903 @deffn {Interface Driver} {presto}
2904 ASIX PRESTO USB JTAG programmer.
2905 @deffn {Config Command} {presto_serial} serial_string
2906 Configures the USB serial number of the Presto device to use.
2907 @end deffn
2908 @end deffn
2909
2910 @deffn {Interface Driver} {rlink}
2911 Raisonance RLink USB adapter
2912 @end deffn
2913
2914 @deffn {Interface Driver} {usbprog}
2915 usbprog is a freely programmable USB adapter.
2916 @end deffn
2917
2918 @deffn {Interface Driver} {vsllink}
2919 vsllink is part of Versaloon which is a versatile USB programmer.
2920
2921 @quotation Note
2922 This defines quite a few driver-specific commands,
2923 which are not currently documented here.
2924 @end quotation
2925 @end deffn
2926
2927 @anchor{hla_interface}
2928 @deffn {Interface Driver} {hla}
2929 This is a driver that supports multiple High Level Adapters.
2930 This type of adapter does not expose some of the lower level api's
2931 that OpenOCD would normally use to access the target.
2932
2933 Currently supported adapters include the ST STLINK and TI ICDI.
2934 STLINK firmware version >= V2.J21.S4 recommended due to issues with earlier
2935 versions of firmware where serial number is reset after first use. Suggest
2936 using ST firmware update utility to upgrade STLINK firmware even if current
2937 version reported is V2.J21.S4.
2938
2939 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_device_desc} description
2940 Currently Not Supported.
2941 @end deffn
2942
2943 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_serial} serial
2944 Specifies the serial number of the adapter.
2945 @end deffn
2946
2947 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_layout} (@option{stlink}|@option{icdi})
2948 Specifies the adapter layout to use.
2949 @end deffn
2950
2951 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_vid_pid} [vid pid]+
2952 Pairs of vendor IDs and product IDs of the device.
2953 @end deffn
2954
2955 @deffn {Command} {hla_command} command
2956 Execute a custom adapter-specific command. The @var{command} string is
2957 passed as is to the underlying adapter layout handler.
2958 @end deffn
2959 @end deffn
2960
2961 @deffn {Interface Driver} {opendous}
2962 opendous-jtag is a freely programmable USB adapter.
2963 @end deffn
2964
2965 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ulink}
2966 This is the Keil ULINK v1 JTAG debugger.
2967 @end deffn
2968
2969 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ZY1000}
2970 This is the Zylin ZY1000 JTAG debugger.
2971 @end deffn
2972
2973 @quotation Note
2974 This defines some driver-specific commands,
2975 which are not currently documented here.
2976 @end quotation
2977
2978 @deffn Command power [@option{on}|@option{off}]
2979 Turn power switch to target on/off.
2980 No arguments: print status.
2981 @end deffn
2982
2983 @deffn {Interface Driver} {bcm2835gpio}
2984 This SoC is present in Raspberry Pi which is a cheap single-board computer
2985 exposing some GPIOs on its expansion header.
2986
2987 The driver accesses memory-mapped GPIO peripheral registers directly
2988 for maximum performance, but the only possible race condition is for
2989 the pins' modes/muxing (which is highly unlikely), so it should be
2990 able to coexist nicely with both sysfs bitbanging and various
2991 peripherals' kernel drivers. The driver restores the previous
2992 configuration on exit.
2993
2994 See @file{interface/raspberrypi-native.cfg} for a sample config and
2995 pinout.
2996
2997 @end deffn
2998
2999 @deffn {Interface Driver} {imx_gpio}
3000 i.MX SoC is present in many community boards. Wandboard is an example
3001 of the one which is most popular.
3002
3003 This driver is mostly the same as bcm2835gpio.
3004
3005 See @file{interface/imx-native.cfg} for a sample config and
3006 pinout.
3007
3008 @end deffn
3009
3010
3011 @deffn {Interface Driver} {openjtag}
3012 OpenJTAG compatible USB adapter.
3013 This defines some driver-specific commands:
3014
3015 @deffn {Config Command} {openjtag_variant} variant
3016 Specifies the variant of the OpenJTAG adapter (see @uref{http://www.openjtag.org/}).
3017 Currently valid @var{variant} values include:
3018
3019 @itemize @minus
3020 @item @b{standard} Standard variant (default).
3021 @item @b{cy7c65215} Cypress CY7C65215 Dual Channel USB-Serial Bridge Controller
3022 (see @uref{http://www.cypress.com/?rID=82870}).
3023 @end itemize
3024 @end deffn
3025
3026 @deffn {Config Command} {openjtag_device_desc} string
3027 The USB device description string of the adapter.
3028 This value is only used with the standard variant.
3029 @end deffn
3030 @end deffn
3031
3032 @section Transport Configuration
3033 @cindex Transport
3034 As noted earlier, depending on the version of OpenOCD you use,
3035 and the debug adapter you are using,
3036 several transports may be available to
3037 communicate with debug targets (or perhaps to program flash memory).
3038 @deffn Command {transport list}
3039 displays the names of the transports supported by this
3040 version of OpenOCD.
3041 @end deffn
3042
3043 @deffn Command {transport select} @option{transport_name}
3044 Select which of the supported transports to use in this OpenOCD session.
3045
3046 When invoked with @option{transport_name}, attempts to select the named
3047 transport. The transport must be supported by the debug adapter
3048 hardware and by the version of OpenOCD you are using (including the
3049 adapter's driver).
3050
3051 If no transport has been selected and no @option{transport_name} is
3052 provided, @command{transport select} auto-selects the first transport
3053 supported by the debug adapter.
3054
3055 @command{transport select} always returns the name of the session's selected
3056 transport, if any.
3057 @end deffn
3058
3059 @subsection JTAG Transport
3060 @cindex JTAG
3061 JTAG is the original transport supported by OpenOCD, and most
3062 of the OpenOCD commands support it.
3063 JTAG transports expose a chain of one or more Test Access Points (TAPs),
3064 each of which must be explicitly declared.
3065 JTAG supports both debugging and boundary scan testing.
3066 Flash programming support is built on top of debug support.
3067
3068 JTAG transport is selected with the command @command{transport select
3069 jtag}. Unless your adapter uses @ref{hla_interface,the hla interface
3070 driver}, in which case the command is @command{transport select
3071 hla_jtag}.
3072
3073 @subsection SWD Transport
3074 @cindex SWD
3075 @cindex Serial Wire Debug
3076 SWD (Serial Wire Debug) is an ARM-specific transport which exposes one
3077 Debug Access Point (DAP, which must be explicitly declared.
3078 (SWD uses fewer signal wires than JTAG.)
3079 SWD is debug-oriented, and does not support boundary scan testing.
3080 Flash programming support is built on top of debug support.
3081 (Some processors support both JTAG and SWD.)
3082
3083 SWD transport is selected with the command @command{transport select
3084 swd}. Unless your adapter uses @ref{hla_interface,the hla interface
3085 driver}, in which case the command is @command{transport select
3086 hla_swd}.
3087
3088 @deffn Command {swd newdap} ...
3089 Declares a single DAP which uses SWD transport.
3090 Parameters are currently the same as "jtag newtap" but this is
3091 expected to change.
3092 @end deffn
3093 @deffn Command {swd wcr trn prescale}
3094 Updates TRN (turnaraound delay) and prescaling.fields of the
3095 Wire Control Register (WCR).
3096 No parameters: displays current settings.
3097 @end deffn
3098
3099 @subsection SPI Transport
3100 @cindex SPI
3101 @cindex Serial Peripheral Interface
3102 The Serial Peripheral Interface (SPI) is a general purpose transport
3103 which uses four wire signaling. Some processors use it as part of a
3104 solution for flash programming.
3105
3106 @anchor{jtagspeed}
3107 @section JTAG Speed
3108 JTAG clock setup is part of system setup.
3109 It @emph{does not belong with interface setup} since any interface
3110 only knows a few of the constraints for the JTAG clock speed.
3111 Sometimes the JTAG speed is
3112 changed during the target initialization process: (1) slow at
3113 reset, (2) program the CPU clocks, (3) run fast.
3114 Both the "slow" and "fast" clock rates are functions of the
3115 oscillators used, the chip, the board design, and sometimes
3116 power management software that may be active.
3117
3118 The speed used during reset, and the scan chain verification which
3119 follows reset, can be adjusted using a @code{reset-start}
3120 target event handler.
3121 It can then be reconfigured to a faster speed by a
3122 @code{reset-init} target event handler after it reprograms those
3123 CPU clocks, or manually (if something else, such as a boot loader,
3124 sets up those clocks).
3125 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
3126 When the initial low JTAG speed is a chip characteristic, perhaps
3127 because of a required oscillator speed, provide such a handler
3128 in the target config file.
3129 When that speed is a function of a board-specific characteristic
3130 such as which speed oscillator is used, it belongs in the board
3131 config file instead.
3132 In both cases it's safest to also set the initial JTAG clock rate
3133 to that same slow speed, so that OpenOCD never starts up using a
3134 clock speed that's faster than the scan chain can support.
3135
3136 @example
3137 jtag_rclk 3000
3138 $_TARGET.cpu configure -event reset-start @{ jtag_rclk 3000 @}
3139 @end example
3140
3141 If your system supports adaptive clocking (RTCK), configuring
3142 JTAG to use that is probably the most robust approach.
3143 However, it introduces delays to synchronize clocks; so it
3144 may not be the fastest solution.
3145
3146 @b{NOTE:} Script writers should consider using @command{jtag_rclk}
3147 instead of @command{adapter_khz}, but only for (ARM) cores and boards
3148 which support adaptive clocking.
3149
3150 @deffn {Command} adapter_khz max_speed_kHz
3151 A non-zero speed is in KHZ. Hence: 3000 is 3mhz.
3152 JTAG interfaces usually support a limited number of
3153 speeds. The speed actually used won't be faster
3154 than the speed specified.
3155
3156 Chip data sheets generally include a top JTAG clock rate.
3157 The actual rate is often a function of a CPU core clock,
3158 and is normally less than that peak rate.
3159 For example, most ARM cores accept at most one sixth of the CPU clock.
3160
3161 Speed 0 (khz) selects RTCK method.
3162 @xref{faqrtck,,FAQ RTCK}.
3163 If your system uses RTCK, you won't need to change the
3164 JTAG clocking after setup.
3165 Not all interfaces, boards, or targets support ``rtck''.
3166 If the interface device can not
3167 support it, an error is returned when you try to use RTCK.
3168 @end deffn
3169
3170 @defun jtag_rclk fallback_speed_kHz
3171 @cindex adaptive clocking
3172 @cindex RTCK
3173 This Tcl proc (defined in @file{startup.tcl}) attempts to enable RTCK/RCLK.
3174 If that fails (maybe the interface, board, or target doesn't
3175 support it), falls back to the specified frequency.
3176 @example
3177 # Fall back to 3mhz if RTCK is not supported
3178 jtag_rclk 3000
3179 @end example
3180 @end defun
3181
3182 @node Reset Configuration
3183 @chapter Reset Configuration
3184 @cindex Reset Configuration
3185
3186 Every system configuration may require a different reset
3187 configuration. This can also be quite confusing.
3188 Resets also interact with @var{reset-init} event handlers,
3189 which do things like setting up clocks and DRAM, and
3190 JTAG clock rates. (@xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.)
3191 They can also interact with JTAG routers.
3192 Please see the various board files for examples.
3193
3194 @quotation Note
3195 To maintainers and integrators:
3196 Reset configuration touches several things at once.
3197 Normally the board configuration file
3198 should define it and assume that the JTAG adapter supports
3199 everything that's wired up to the board's JTAG connector.
3200
3201 However, the target configuration file could also make note
3202 of something the silicon vendor has done inside the chip,
3203 which will be true for most (or all) boards using that chip.
3204 And when the JTAG adapter doesn't support everything, the
3205 user configuration file will need to override parts of
3206 the reset configuration provided by other files.
3207 @end quotation
3208
3209 @section Types of Reset
3210
3211 There are many kinds of reset possible through JTAG, but
3212 they may not all work with a given board and adapter.
3213 That's part of why reset configuration can be error prone.
3214
3215 @itemize @bullet
3216 @item
3217 @emph{System Reset} ... the @emph{SRST} hardware signal
3218 resets all chips connected to the JTAG adapter, such as processors,
3219 power management chips, and I/O controllers. Normally resets triggered
3220 with this signal behave exactly like pressing a RESET button.
3221 @item
3222 @emph{JTAG TAP Reset} ... the @emph{TRST} hardware signal resets
3223 just the TAP controllers connected to the JTAG adapter.
3224 Such resets should not be visible to the rest of the system; resetting a
3225 device's TAP controller just puts that controller into a known state.
3226 @item
3227 @emph{Emulation Reset} ... many devices can be reset through JTAG
3228 commands. These resets are often distinguishable from system
3229 resets, either explicitly (a "reset reason" register says so)
3230 or implicitly (not all parts of the chip get reset).
3231 @item
3232 @emph{Other Resets} ... system-on-chip devices often support
3233 several other types of reset.
3234 You may need to arrange that a watchdog timer stops
3235 while debugging, preventing a watchdog reset.
3236 There may be individual module resets.
3237 @end itemize
3238
3239 In the best case, OpenOCD can hold SRST, then reset
3240 the TAPs via TRST and send commands through JTAG to halt the
3241 CPU at the reset vector before the 1st instruction is executed.
3242 Then when it finally releases the SRST signal, the system is
3243 halted under debugger control before any code has executed.
3244 This is the behavior required to support the @command{reset halt}
3245 and @command{reset init} commands; after @command{reset init} a
3246 board-specific script might do things like setting up DRAM.
3247 (@xref{resetcommand,,Reset Command}.)
3248
3249 @anchor{srstandtrstissues}
3250 @section SRST and TRST Issues
3251
3252 Because SRST and TRST are hardware signals, they can have a
3253 variety of system-specific constraints. Some of the most
3254 common issues are:
3255
3256 @itemize @bullet
3257
3258 @item @emph{Signal not available} ... Some boards don't wire
3259 SRST or TRST to the JTAG connector. Some JTAG adapters don't
3260 support such signals even if they are wired up.
3261 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{signals} options to say
3262 when either of those signals is not connected.
3263 When SRST is not available, your code might not be able to rely
3264 on controllers having been fully reset during code startup.
3265 Missing TRST is not a problem, since JTAG-level resets can
3266 be triggered using with TMS signaling.
3267
3268 @item @emph{Signals shorted} ... Sometimes a chip, board, or
3269 adapter will connect SRST to TRST, instead of keeping them separate.
3270 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{combination} options to say
3271 when those signals aren't properly independent.
3272
3273 @item @emph{Timing} ... Reset circuitry like a resistor/capacitor
3274 delay circuit, reset supervisor, or on-chip features can extend
3275 the effect of a JTAG adapter's reset for some time after the adapter
3276 stops issuing the reset. For example, there may be chip or board
3277 requirements that all reset pulses last for at least a
3278 certain amount of time; and reset buttons commonly have
3279 hardware debouncing.
3280 Use the @command{adapter_nsrst_delay} and @command{jtag_ntrst_delay}
3281 commands to say when extra delays are needed.
3282
3283 @item @emph{Drive type} ... Reset lines often have a pullup
3284 resistor, letting the JTAG interface treat them as open-drain
3285 signals. But that's not a requirement, so the adapter may need
3286 to use push/pull output drivers.
3287 Also, with weak pullups it may be advisable to drive
3288 signals to both levels (push/pull) to minimize rise times.
3289 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{trst_type} and
3290 @var{srst_type} parameters to say how to drive reset signals.
3291
3292 @item @emph{Special initialization} ... Targets sometimes need
3293 special JTAG initialization sequences to handle chip-specific
3294 issues (not limited to errata).
3295 For example, certain JTAG commands might need to be issued while
3296 the system as a whole is in a reset state (SRST active)
3297 but the JTAG scan chain is usable (TRST inactive).
3298 Many systems treat combined assertion of SRST and TRST as a
3299 trigger for a harder reset than SRST alone.
3300 Such custom reset handling is discussed later in this chapter.
3301 @end itemize
3302
3303 There can also be other issues.
3304 Some devices don't fully conform to the JTAG specifications.
3305 Trivial system-specific differences are common, such as
3306 SRST and TRST using slightly different names.
3307 There are also vendors who distribute key JTAG documentation for
3308 their chips only to developers who have signed a Non-Disclosure
3309 Agreement (NDA).
3310
3311 Sometimes there are chip-specific extensions like a requirement to use
3312 the normally-optional TRST signal (precluding use of JTAG adapters which
3313 don't pass TRST through), or needing extra steps to complete a TAP reset.
3314
3315 In short, SRST and especially TRST handling may be very finicky,
3316 needing to cope with both architecture and board specific constraints.
3317
3318 @section Commands for Handling Resets
3319
3320 @deffn {Command} adapter_nsrst_assert_width milliseconds
3321 Minimum amount of time (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait
3322 after asserting nSRST (active-low system reset) before
3323 allowing it to be deasserted.
3324 @end deffn
3325
3326 @deffn {Command} adapter_nsrst_delay milliseconds
3327 How long (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait after deasserting
3328 nSRST (active-low system reset) before starting new JTAG operations.
3329 When a board has a reset button connected to SRST line it will
3330 probably have hardware debouncing, implying you should use this.
3331 @end deffn
3332
3333 @deffn {Command} jtag_ntrst_assert_width milliseconds
3334 Minimum amount of time (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait
3335 after asserting nTRST (active-low JTAG TAP reset) before
3336 allowing it to be deasserted.
3337 @end deffn
3338
3339 @deffn {Command} jtag_ntrst_delay milliseconds
3340 How long (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait after deasserting
3341 nTRST (active-low JTAG TAP reset) before starting new JTAG operations.
3342 @end deffn
3343
3344 @deffn {Command} reset_config mode_flag ...
3345 This command displays or modifies the reset configuration
3346 of your combination of JTAG board and target in target
3347 configuration scripts.
3348
3349 Information earlier in this section describes the kind of problems
3350 the command is intended to address (@pxref{srstandtrstissues,,SRST and TRST Issues}).
3351 As a rule this command belongs only in board config files,
3352 describing issues like @emph{board doesn't connect TRST};
3353 or in user config files, addressing limitations derived
3354 from a particular combination of interface and board.
3355 (An unlikely example would be using a TRST-only adapter
3356 with a board that only wires up SRST.)
3357
3358 The @var{mode_flag} options can be specified in any order, but only one
3359 of each type -- @var{signals}, @var{combination}, @var{gates},
3360 @var{trst_type}, @var{srst_type} and @var{connect_type}
3361 -- may be specified at a time.
3362 If you don't provide a new value for a given type, its previous
3363 value (perhaps the default) is unchanged.
3364 For example, this means that you don't need to say anything at all about
3365 TRST just to declare that if the JTAG adapter should want to drive SRST,
3366 it must explicitly be driven high (@option{srst_push_pull}).
3367
3368 @itemize
3369 @item
3370 @var{signals} can specify which of the reset signals are connected.
3371 For example, If the JTAG interface provides SRST, but the board doesn't
3372 connect that signal properly, then OpenOCD can't use it.
3373 Possible values are @option{none} (the default), @option{trst_only},
3374 @option{srst_only} and @option{trst_and_srst}.
3375
3376 @quotation Tip
3377 If your board provides SRST and/or TRST through the JTAG connector,
3378 you must declare that so those signals can be used.
3379 @end quotation
3380
3381 @item
3382 The @var{combination} is an optional value specifying broken reset
3383 signal implementations.
3384 The default behaviour if no option given is @option{separate},
3385 indicating everything behaves normally.
3386 @option{srst_pulls_trst} states that the
3387 test logic is reset together with the reset of the system (e.g. NXP
3388 LPC2000, "broken" board layout), @option{trst_pulls_srst} says that
3389 the system is reset together with the test logic (only hypothetical, I
3390 haven't seen hardware with such a bug, and can be worked around).
3391 @option{combined} implies both @option{srst_pulls_trst} and
3392 @option{trst_pulls_srst}.
3393
3394 @item
3395 The @var{gates} tokens control flags that describe some cases where
3396 JTAG may be unvailable during reset.
3397 @option{srst_gates_jtag} (default)
3398 indicates that asserting SRST gates the
3399 JTAG clock. This means that no communication can happen on JTAG
3400 while SRST is asserted.
3401 Its converse is @option{srst_nogate}, indicating that JTAG commands
3402 can safely be issued while SRST is active.
3403
3404 @item
3405 The @var{connect_type} tokens control flags that describe some cases where
3406 SRST is asserted while connecting to the target. @option{srst_nogate}
3407 is required to use this option.
3408 @option{connect_deassert_srst} (default)
3409 indicates that SRST will not be asserted while connecting to the target.
3410 Its converse is @option{connect_assert_srst}, indicating that SRST will
3411 be asserted before any target connection.
3412 Only some targets support this feature, STM32 and STR9 are examples.
3413 This feature is useful if you are unable to connect to your target due
3414 to incorrect options byte config or illegal program execution.
3415 @end itemize
3416
3417 The optional @var{trst_type} and @var{srst_type} parameters allow the
3418 driver mode of each reset line to be specified. These values only affect
3419 JTAG interfaces with support for different driver modes, like the Amontec
3420 JTAGkey and JTAG Accelerator. Also, they are necessarily ignored if the
3421 relevant signal (TRST or SRST) is not connected.
3422
3423 @itemize
3424 @item
3425 Possible @var{trst_type} driver modes for the test reset signal (TRST)
3426 are the default @option{trst_push_pull}, and @option{trst_open_drain}.
3427 Most boards connect this signal to a pulldown, so the JTAG TAPs
3428 never leave reset unless they are hooked up to a JTAG adapter.
3429
3430 @item
3431 Possible @var{srst_type} driver modes for the system reset signal (SRST)
3432 are the default @option{srst_open_drain}, and @option{srst_push_pull}.
3433 Most boards connect this signal to a pullup, and allow the
3434 signal to be pulled low by various events including system
3435 powerup and pressing a reset button.
3436 @end itemize
3437 @end deffn
3438
3439 @section Custom Reset Handling
3440 @cindex events
3441
3442 OpenOCD has several ways to help support the various reset
3443 mechanisms provided by chip and board vendors.
3444 The commands shown in the previous section give standard parameters.
3445 There are also @emph{event handlers} associated with TAPs or Targets.
3446 Those handlers are Tcl procedures you can provide, which are invoked
3447 at particular points in the reset sequence.
3448
3449 @emph{When SRST is not an option} you must set
3450 up a @code{reset-assert} event handler for your target.
3451 For example, some JTAG adapters don't include the SRST signal;
3452 and some boards have multiple targets, and you won't always
3453 want to reset everything at once.
3454
3455 After configuring those mechanisms, you might still
3456 find your board doesn't start up or reset correctly.
3457 For example, maybe it needs a slightly different sequence
3458 of SRST and/or TRST manipulations, because of quirks that
3459 the @command{reset_config} mechanism doesn't address;
3460 or asserting both might trigger a stronger reset, which
3461 needs special attention.
3462
3463 Experiment with lower level operations, such as @command{jtag_reset}
3464 and the @command{jtag arp_*} operations shown here,
3465 to find a sequence of operations that works.
3466 @xref{JTAG Commands}.
3467 When you find a working sequence, it can be used to override
3468 @command{jtag_init}, which fires during OpenOCD startup
3469 (@pxref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage});
3470 or @command{init_reset}, which fires during reset processing.
3471
3472 You might also want to provide some project-specific reset
3473 schemes. For example, on a multi-target board the standard
3474 @command{reset} command would reset all targets, but you
3475 may need the ability to reset only one target at time and
3476 thus want to avoid using the board-wide SRST signal.
3477
3478 @deffn {Overridable Procedure} init_reset mode
3479 This is invoked near the beginning of the @command{reset} command,
3480 usually to provide as much of a cold (power-up) reset as practical.
3481 By default it is also invoked from @command{jtag_init} if
3482 the scan chain does not respond to pure JTAG operations.
3483 The @var{mode} parameter is the parameter given to the
3484 low level reset command (@option{halt},
3485 @option{init}, or @option{run}), @option{setup},
3486 or potentially some other value.
3487
3488 The default implementation just invokes @command{jtag arp_init-reset}.
3489 Replacements will normally build on low level JTAG
3490 operations such as @command{jtag_reset}.
3491 Operations here must not address individual TAPs
3492 (or their associated targets)
3493 until the JTAG scan chain has first been verified to work.
3494
3495 Implementations must have verified the JTAG scan chain before
3496 they return.
3497 This is done by calling @command{jtag arp_init}
3498 (or @command{jtag arp_init-reset}).
3499 @end deffn
3500
3501 @deffn Command {jtag arp_init}
3502 This validates the scan chain using just the four
3503 standard JTAG signals (TMS, TCK, TDI, TDO).
3504 It starts by issuing a JTAG-only reset.
3505 Then it performs checks to verify that the scan chain configuration
3506 matches the TAPs it can observe.
3507 Those checks include checking IDCODE values for each active TAP,
3508 and verifying the length of their instruction registers using
3509 TAP @code{-ircapture} and @code{-irmask} values.
3510 If these tests all pass, TAP @code{setup} events are
3511 issued to all TAPs with handlers for that event.
3512 @end deffn
3513
3514 @deffn Command {jtag arp_init-reset}
3515 This uses TRST and SRST to try resetting
3516 everything on the JTAG scan chain
3517 (and anything else connected to SRST).
3518 It then invokes the logic of @command{jtag arp_init}.
3519 @end deffn
3520
3521
3522 @node TAP Declaration
3523 @chapter TAP Declaration
3524 @cindex TAP declaration
3525 @cindex TAP configuration
3526
3527 @emph{Test Access Ports} (TAPs) are the core of JTAG.
3528 TAPs serve many roles, including:
3529
3530 @itemize @bullet
3531 @item @b{Debug Target} A CPU TAP can be used as a GDB debug target.
3532 @item @b{Flash Programming} Some chips program the flash directly via JTAG.
3533 Others do it indirectly, making a CPU do it.
3534 @item @b{Program Download} Using the same CPU support GDB uses,
3535 you can initialize a DRAM controller, download code to DRAM, and then
3536 start running that code.
3537 @item @b{Boundary Scan} Most chips support boundary scan, which
3538 helps test for board assembly problems like solder bridges
3539 and missing connections.
3540 @end itemize
3541
3542 OpenOCD must know about the active TAPs on your board(s).
3543 Setting up the TAPs is the core task of your configuration files.
3544 Once those TAPs are set up, you can pass their names to code
3545 which sets up CPUs and exports them as GDB targets,
3546 probes flash memory, performs low-level JTAG operations, and more.
3547
3548 @section Scan Chains
3549 @cindex scan chain
3550
3551 TAPs are part of a hardware @dfn{scan chain},
3552 which is a daisy chain of TAPs.
3553 They also need to be added to
3554 OpenOCD's software mirror of that hardware list,
3555 giving each member a name and associating other data with it.
3556 Simple scan chains, with a single TAP, are common in
3557 systems with a single microcontroller or microprocessor.
3558 More complex chips may have several TAPs internally.
3559 Very complex scan chains might have a dozen or more TAPs:
3560 several in one chip, more in the next, and connecting
3561 to other boards with their own chips and TAPs.
3562
3563 You can display the list with the @command{scan_chain} command.
3564 (Don't confuse this with the list displayed by the @command{targets}
3565 command, presented in the next chapter.
3566 That only displays TAPs for CPUs which are configured as
3567 debugging targets.)
3568 Here's what the scan chain might look like for a chip more than one TAP:
3569
3570 @verbatim
3571 TapName Enabled IdCode Expected IrLen IrCap IrMask
3572 -- ------------------ ------- ---------- ---------- ----- ----- ------
3573 0 omap5912.dsp Y 0x03df1d81 0x03df1d81 38 0x01 0x03
3574 1 omap5912.arm Y 0x0692602f 0x0692602f 4 0x01 0x0f
3575 2 omap5912.unknown Y 0x00000000 0x00000000 8 0x01 0x03
3576 @end verbatim
3577
3578 OpenOCD can detect some of that information, but not all
3579 of it. @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
3580 Unfortunately, those TAPs can't always be autoconfigured,
3581 because not all devices provide good support for that.
3582 JTAG doesn't require supporting IDCODE instructions, and
3583 chips with JTAG routers may not link TAPs into the chain
3584 until they are told to do so.
3585
3586 The configuration mechanism currently supported by OpenOCD
3587 requires explicit configuration of all TAP devices using
3588 @command{jtag newtap} commands, as detailed later in this chapter.
3589 A command like this would declare one tap and name it @code{chip1.cpu}:
3590
3591 @example
3592 jtag newtap chip1 cpu -irlen 4 -expected-id 0x3ba00477
3593 @end example
3594
3595 Each target configuration file lists the TAPs provided
3596 by a given chip.
3597 Board configuration files combine all the targets on a board,
3598 and so forth.
3599 Note that @emph{the order in which TAPs are declared is very important.}
3600 That declaration order must match the order in the JTAG scan chain,
3601 both inside a single chip and between them.
3602 @xref{faqtaporder,,FAQ TAP Order}.
3603
3604 For example, the ST Microsystems STR912 chip has
3605 three separate TAPs@footnote{See the ST
3606 document titled: @emph{STR91xFAxxx, Section 3.15 Jtag Interface, Page:
3607 28/102, Figure 3: JTAG chaining inside the STR91xFA}.
3608 @url{http://eu.st.com/stonline/products/literature/ds/13495.pdf}}.
3609 To configure those taps, @file{target/str912.cfg}
3610 includes commands something like this:
3611
3612 @example
3613 jtag newtap str912 flash ... params ...
3614 jtag newtap str912 cpu ... params ...
3615 jtag newtap str912 bs ... params ...
3616 @end example
3617
3618 Actual config files typically use a variable such as @code{$_CHIPNAME}
3619 instead of literals like @option{str912}, to support more than one chip
3620 of each type. @xref{Config File Guidelines}.
3621
3622 @deffn Command {jtag names}
3623 Returns the names of all current TAPs in the scan chain.
3624 Use @command{jtag cget} or @command{jtag tapisenabled}
3625 to examine attributes and state of each TAP.
3626 @example
3627 foreach t [jtag names] @{
3628 puts [format "TAP: %s\n" $t]
3629 @}
3630 @end example
3631 @end deffn
3632
3633 @deffn Command {scan_chain}
3634 Displays the TAPs in the scan chain configuration,
3635 and their status.
3636 The set of TAPs listed by this command is fixed by
3637 exiting the OpenOCD configuration stage,
3638 but systems with a JTAG router can
3639 enable or disable TAPs dynamically.
3640 @end deffn
3641
3642 @c FIXME! "jtag cget" should be able to return all TAP
3643 @c attributes, like "$target_name cget" does for targets.
3644
3645 @c Probably want "jtag eventlist", and a "tap-reset" event
3646 @c (on entry to RESET state).
3647
3648 @section TAP Names
3649 @cindex dotted name
3650
3651 When TAP objects are declared with @command{jtag newtap},
3652 a @dfn{dotted.name} is created for the TAP, combining the
3653 name of a module (usually a chip) and a label for the TAP.
3654 For example: @code{xilinx.tap}, @code{str912.flash},
3655 @code{omap3530.jrc}, @code{dm6446.dsp}, or @code{stm32.cpu}.
3656 Many other commands use that dotted.name to manipulate or
3657 refer to the TAP. For example, CPU configuration uses the
3658 name, as does declaration of NAND or NOR flash banks.
3659
3660 The components of a dotted name should follow ``C'' symbol
3661 name rules: start with an alphabetic character, then numbers
3662 and underscores are OK; while others (including dots!) are not.
3663
3664 @section TAP Declaration Commands
3665
3666 @c shouldn't this be(come) a {Config Command}?
3667 @deffn Command {jtag newtap} chipname tapname configparams...
3668 Declares a new TAP with the dotted name @var{chipname}.@var{tapname},
3669 and configured according to the various @var{configparams}.
3670
3671 The @var{chipname} is a symbolic name for the chip.
3672 Conventionally target config files use @code{$_CHIPNAME},
3673 defaulting to the model name given by the chip vendor but
3674 overridable.
3675
3676 @cindex TAP naming convention
3677 The @var{tapname} reflects the role of that TAP,
3678 and should follow this convention:
3679
3680 @itemize @bullet
3681 @item @code{bs} -- For boundary scan if this is a separate TAP;
3682 @item @code{cpu} -- The main CPU of the chip, alternatively
3683 @code{arm} and @code{dsp} on chips with both ARM and DSP CPUs,
3684 @code{arm1} and @code{arm2} on chips with two ARMs, and so forth;
3685 @item @code{etb} -- For an embedded trace buffer (example: an ARM ETB11);
3686 @item @code{flash} -- If the chip has a flash TAP, like the str912;
3687 @item @code{jrc} -- For JTAG route controller (example: the ICEPick modules
3688 on many Texas Instruments chips, like the OMAP3530 on Beagleboards);
3689 @item @code{tap} -- Should be used only for FPGA- or CPLD-like devices
3690 with a single TAP;
3691 @item @code{unknownN} -- If you have no idea what the TAP is for (N is a number);
3692 @item @emph{when in doubt} -- Use the chip maker's name in their data sheet.
3693 For example, the Freescale i.MX31 has a SDMA (Smart DMA) with
3694 a JTAG TAP; that TAP should be named @code{sdma}.
3695 @end itemize
3696
3697 Every TAP requires at least the following @var{configparams}:
3698
3699 @itemize @bullet
3700 @item @code{-irlen} @var{NUMBER}
3701 @*The length in bits of the
3702 instruction register, such as 4 or 5 bits.
3703 @end itemize
3704
3705 A TAP may also provide optional @var{configparams}:
3706
3707 @itemize @bullet
3708 @item @code{-disable} (or @code{-enable})
3709 @*Use the @code{-disable} parameter to flag a TAP which is not
3710 linked into the scan chain after a reset using either TRST
3711 or the JTAG state machine's @sc{reset} state.
3712 You may use @code{-enable} to highlight the default state
3713 (the TAP is linked in).
3714 @xref{enablinganddisablingtaps,,Enabling and Disabling TAPs}.
3715 @item @code{-expected-id} @var{NUMBER}
3716 @*A non-zero @var{number} represents a 32-bit IDCODE
3717 which you expect to find when the scan chain is examined.
3718 These codes are not required by all JTAG devices.
3719 @emph{Repeat the option} as many times as required if more than one
3720 ID code could appear (for example, multiple versions).
3721 Specify @var{number} as zero to suppress warnings about IDCODE
3722 values that were found but not included in the list.
3723
3724 Provide this value if at all possible, since it lets OpenOCD
3725 tell when the scan chain it sees isn't right. These values
3726 are provided in vendors' chip documentation, usually a technical
3727 reference manual. Sometimes you may need to probe the JTAG
3728 hardware to find these values.
3729 @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
3730 @item @code{-ignore-version}
3731 @*Specify this to ignore the JTAG version field in the @code{-expected-id}
3732 option. When vendors put out multiple versions of a chip, or use the same
3733 JTAG-level ID for several largely-compatible chips, it may be more practical
3734 to ignore the version field than to update config files to handle all of
3735 the various chip IDs. The version field is defined as bit 28-31 of the IDCODE.
3736 @item @code{-ircapture} @var{NUMBER}
3737 @*The bit pattern loaded by the TAP into the JTAG shift register
3738 on entry to the @sc{ircapture} state, such as 0x01.
3739 JTAG requires the two LSBs of this value to be 01.
3740 By default, @code{-ircapture} and @code{-irmask} are set
3741 up to verify that two-bit value. You may provide
3742 additional bits if you know them, or indicate that
3743 a TAP doesn't conform to the JTAG specification.
3744 @item @code{-irmask} @var{NUMBER}
3745 @*A mask used with @code{-ircapture}
3746 to verify that instruction scans work correctly.
3747 Such scans are not used by OpenOCD except to verify that
3748 there seems to be no problems with JTAG scan chain operations.
3749 @end itemize
3750 @end deffn
3751
3752 @section Other TAP commands
3753
3754 @deffn Command {jtag cget} dotted.name @option{-event} event_name
3755 @deffnx Command {jtag configure} dotted.name @option{-event} event_name handler
3756 At this writing this TAP attribute
3757 mechanism is used only for event handling.
3758 (It is not a direct analogue of the @code{cget}/@code{configure}
3759 mechanism for debugger targets.)
3760 See the next section for information about the available events.
3761
3762 The @code{configure} subcommand assigns an event handler,
3763 a TCL string which is evaluated when the event is triggered.
3764 The @code{cget} subcommand returns that handler.
3765 @end deffn
3766
3767 @section TAP Events
3768 @cindex events
3769 @cindex TAP events
3770
3771 OpenOCD includes two event mechanisms.
3772 The one presented here applies to all JTAG TAPs.
3773 The other applies to debugger targets,
3774 which are associated with certain TAPs.
3775
3776 The TAP events currently defined are:
3777
3778 @itemize @bullet
3779 @item @b{post-reset}
3780 @* The TAP has just completed a JTAG reset.
3781 The tap may still be in the JTAG @sc{reset} state.
3782 Handlers for these events might perform initialization sequences
3783 such as issuing TCK cycles, TMS sequences to ensure
3784 exit from the ARM SWD mode, and more.
3785
3786 Because the scan chain has not yet been verified, handlers for these events
3787 @emph{should not issue commands which scan the JTAG IR or DR registers}
3788 of any particular target.
3789 @b{NOTE:} As this is written (September 2009), nothing prevents such access.
3790 @item @b{setup}
3791 @* The scan chain has been reset and verified.
3792 This handler may enable TAPs as needed.
3793 @item @b{tap-disable}
3794 @* The TAP needs to be disabled. This handler should
3795 implement @command{jtag tapdisable}
3796 by issuing the relevant JTAG commands.
3797 @item @b{tap-enable}
3798 @* The TAP needs to be enabled. This handler should
3799 implement @command{jtag tapenable}
3800 by issuing the relevant JTAG commands.
3801 @end itemize
3802
3803 If you need some action after each JTAG reset which isn't actually
3804 specific to any TAP (since you can't yet trust the scan chain's
3805 contents to be accurate), you might:
3806
3807 @example
3808 jtag configure CHIP.jrc -event post-reset @{
3809 echo "JTAG Reset done"
3810 ... non-scan jtag operations to be done after reset
3811 @}
3812 @end example
3813
3814
3815 @anchor{enablinganddisablingtaps}
3816 @section Enabling and Disabling TAPs
3817 @cindex JTAG Route Controller
3818 @cindex jrc
3819
3820 In some systems, a @dfn{JTAG Route Controller} (JRC)
3821 is used to enable and/or disable specific JTAG TAPs.
3822 Many ARM-based chips from Texas Instruments include
3823 an ``ICEPick'' module, which is a JRC.
3824 Such chips include DaVinci and OMAP3 processors.
3825
3826 A given TAP may not be visible until the JRC has been
3827 told to link it into the scan chain; and if the JRC
3828 has been told to unlink that TAP, it will no longer
3829 be visible.
3830 Such routers address problems that JTAG ``bypass mode''
3831 ignores, such as:
3832
3833 @itemize
3834 @item The scan chain can only go as fast as its slowest TAP.
3835 @item Having many TAPs slows instruction scans, since all
3836 TAPs receive new instructions.
3837 @item TAPs in the scan chain must be powered up, which wastes
3838 power and prevents debugging some power management mechanisms.
3839 @end itemize
3840
3841 The IEEE 1149.1 JTAG standard has no concept of a ``disabled'' tap,
3842 as implied by the existence of JTAG routers.
3843 However, the upcoming IEEE 1149.7 framework (layered on top of JTAG)
3844 does include a kind of JTAG router functionality.
3845
3846 @c (a) currently the event handlers don't seem to be able to
3847 @c fail in a way that could lead to no-change-of-state.
3848
3849 In OpenOCD, tap enabling/disabling is invoked by the Tcl commands
3850 shown below, and is implemented using TAP event handlers.
3851 So for example, when defining a TAP for a CPU connected to
3852 a JTAG router, your @file{target.cfg} file
3853 should define TAP event handlers using
3854 code that looks something like this:
3855
3856 @example
3857 jtag configure CHIP.cpu -event tap-enable @{
3858 ... jtag operations using CHIP.jrc
3859 @}
3860 jtag configure CHIP.cpu -event tap-disable @{
3861 ... jtag operations using CHIP.jrc
3862 @}
3863 @end example
3864
3865 Then you might want that CPU's TAP enabled almost all the time:
3866
3867 @example
3868 jtag configure $CHIP.jrc -event setup "jtag tapenable $CHIP.cpu"
3869 @end example
3870
3871 Note how that particular setup event handler declaration
3872 uses quotes to evaluate @code{$CHIP} when the event is configured.
3873 Using brackets @{ @} would cause it to be evaluated later,
3874 at runtime, when it might have a different value.
3875
3876 @deffn Command {jtag tapdisable} dotted.name
3877 If necessary, disables the tap
3878 by sending it a @option{tap-disable} event.
3879 Returns the string "1" if the tap
3880 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
3881 and "0" if it is disabled.
3882 @end deffn
3883
3884 @deffn Command {jtag tapenable} dotted.name
3885 If necessary, enables the tap
3886 by sending it a @option{tap-enable} event.
3887 Returns the string "1" if the tap
3888 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
3889 and "0" if it is disabled.
3890 @end deffn
3891
3892 @deffn Command {jtag tapisenabled} dotted.name
3893 Returns the string "1" if the tap
3894 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
3895 and "0" if it is disabled.
3896
3897 @quotation Note
3898 Humans will find the @command{scan_chain} command more helpful
3899 for querying the state of the JTAG taps.
3900 @end quotation
3901 @end deffn
3902
3903 @anchor{autoprobing}
3904 @section Autoprobing
3905 @cindex autoprobe
3906 @cindex JTAG autoprobe
3907
3908 TAP configuration is the first thing that needs to be done
3909 after interface and reset configuration. Sometimes it's
3910 hard finding out what TAPs exist, or how they are identified.
3911 Vendor documentation is not always easy to find and use.
3912
3913 To help you get past such problems, OpenOCD has a limited
3914 @emph{autoprobing} ability to look at the scan chain, doing
3915 a @dfn{blind interrogation} and then reporting the TAPs it finds.
3916 To use this mechanism, start the OpenOCD server with only data
3917 that configures your JTAG interface, and arranges to come up
3918 with a slow clock (many devices don't support fast JTAG clocks
3919 right when they come out of reset).
3920
3921 For example, your @file{openocd.cfg} file might have:
3922
3923 @example
3924 source [find interface/olimex-arm-usb-tiny-h.cfg]
3925 reset_config trst_and_srst
3926 jtag_rclk 8
3927 @end example
3928
3929 When you start the server without any TAPs configured, it will
3930 attempt to autoconfigure the TAPs. There are two parts to this:
3931
3932 @enumerate
3933 @item @emph{TAP discovery} ...
3934 After a JTAG reset (sometimes a system reset may be needed too),
3935 each TAP's data registers will hold the contents of either the
3936 IDCODE or BYPASS register.
3937 If JTAG communication is working, OpenOCD will see each TAP,
3938 and report what @option{-expected-id} to use with it.
3939 @item @emph{IR Length discovery} ...
3940 Unfortunately JTAG does not provide a reliable way to find out
3941 the value of the @option{-irlen} parameter to use with a TAP
3942 that is discovered.
3943 If OpenOCD can discover the length of a TAP's instruction
3944 register, it will report it.
3945 Otherwise you may need to consult vendor documentation, such
3946 as chip data sheets or BSDL files.
3947 @end enumerate
3948
3949 In many cases your board will have a simple scan chain with just
3950 a single device. Here's what OpenOCD reported with one board
3951 that's a bit more complex:
3952
3953 @example
3954 clock speed 8 kHz
3955 There are no enabled taps. AUTO PROBING MIGHT NOT WORK!!
3956 AUTO auto0.tap - use "jtag newtap auto0 tap -expected-id 0x2b900f0f ..."
3957 AUTO auto1.tap - use "jtag newtap auto1 tap -expected-id 0x07926001 ..."
3958 AUTO auto2.tap - use "jtag newtap auto2 tap -expected-id 0x0b73b02f ..."
3959 AUTO auto0.tap - use "... -irlen 4"
3960 AUTO auto1.tap - use "... -irlen 4"
3961 AUTO auto2.tap - use "... -irlen 6"
3962 no gdb ports allocated as no target has been specified
3963 @end example
3964
3965 Given that information, you should be able to either find some existing
3966 config files to use, or create your own. If you create your own, you
3967 would configure from the bottom up: first a @file{target.cfg} file
3968 with these TAPs, any targets associated with them, and any on-chip
3969 resources; then a @file{board.cfg} with off-chip resources, clocking,
3970 and so forth.
3971
3972 @node CPU Configuration
3973 @chapter CPU Configuration
3974 @cindex GDB target
3975
3976 This chapter discusses how to set up GDB debug targets for CPUs.
3977 You can also access these targets without GDB
3978 (@pxref{Architecture and Core Commands},
3979 and @ref{targetstatehandling,,Target State handling}) and
3980 through various kinds of NAND and NOR flash commands.
3981 If you have multiple CPUs you can have multiple such targets.
3982
3983 We'll start by looking at how to examine the targets you have,
3984 then look at how to add one more target and how to configure it.
3985
3986 @section Target List
3987 @cindex target, current
3988 @cindex target, list
3989
3990 All targets that have been set up are part of a list,
3991 where each member has a name.
3992 That name should normally be the same as the TAP name.
3993 You can display the list with the @command{targets}
3994 (plural!) command.
3995 This display often has only one CPU; here's what it might
3996 look like with more than one:
3997 @verbatim
3998 TargetName Type Endian TapName State
3999 -- ------------------ ---------- ------ ------------------ ------------
4000 0* at91rm9200.cpu arm920t little at91rm9200.cpu running
4001 1 MyTarget cortex_m little mychip.foo tap-disabled
4002 @end verbatim
4003
4004 One member of that list is the @dfn{current target}, which
4005 is implicitly referenced by many commands.
4006 It's the one marked with a @code{*} near the target name.
4007 In particular, memory addresses often refer to the address
4008 space seen by that current target.
4009 Commands like @command{mdw} (memory display words)
4010 and @command{flash erase_address} (erase NOR flash blocks)
4011 are examples; and there are many more.
4012
4013 Several commands let you examine the list of targets:
4014
4015 @deffn Command {target current}
4016 Returns the name of the current target.
4017 @end deffn
4018
4019 @deffn Command {target names}
4020 Lists the names of all current targets in the list.
4021 @example
4022 foreach t [target names] @{
4023 puts [format "Target: %s\n" $t]
4024 @}
4025 @end example
4026 @end deffn
4027
4028 @c yep, "target list" would have been better.
4029 @c plus maybe "target setdefault".
4030
4031 @deffn Command targets [name]
4032 @emph{Note: the name of this command is plural. Other target
4033 command names are singular.}
4034
4035 With no parameter, this command displays a table of all known
4036 targets in a user friendly form.
4037
4038 With a parameter, this command sets the current target to
4039 the given target with the given @var{name}; this is
4040 only relevant on boards which have more than one target.
4041 @end deffn
4042
4043 @section Target CPU Types
4044 @cindex target type
4045 @cindex CPU type
4046
4047 Each target has a @dfn{CPU type}, as shown in the output of
4048 the @command{targets} command. You need to specify that type
4049 when calling @command{target create}.
4050 The CPU type indicates more than just the instruction set.
4051 It also indicates how that instruction set is implemented,
4052 what kind of debug support it integrates,
4053 whether it has an MMU (and if so, what kind),
4054 what core-specific commands may be available
4055 (@pxref{Architecture and Core Commands}),
4056 and more.
4057
4058 It's easy to see what target types are supported,
4059 since there's a command to list them.
4060
4061 @anchor{targettypes}
4062 @deffn Command {target types}
4063 Lists all supported target types.
4064 At this writing, the supported CPU types are:
4065
4066 @itemize @bullet
4067 @item @code{arm11} -- this is a generation of ARMv6 cores
4068 @item @code{arm720t} -- this is an ARMv4 core with an MMU
4069 @item @code{arm7tdmi} -- this is an ARMv4 core
4070 @item @code{arm920t} -- this is an ARMv4 core with an MMU
4071 @item @code{arm926ejs} -- this is an ARMv5 core with an MMU
4072 @item @code{arm966e} -- this is an ARMv5 core
4073 @item @code{arm9tdmi} -- this is an ARMv4 core
4074 @item @code{avr} -- implements Atmel's 8-bit AVR instruction set.
4075 (Support for this is preliminary and incomplete.)
4076 @item @code{cortex_a} -- this is an ARMv7 core with an MMU
4077 @item @code{cortex_m} -- this is an ARMv7 core, supporting only the
4078 compact Thumb2 instruction set.
4079 @item @code{aarch64} -- this is an ARMv8-A core with an MMU
4080 @item @code{dragonite} -- resembles arm966e
4081 @item @code{dsp563xx} -- implements Freescale's 24-bit DSP.
4082 (Support for this is still incomplete.)
4083 @item @code{fa526} -- resembles arm920 (w/o Thumb)
4084 @item @code{feroceon} -- resembles arm926
4085 @item @code{mips_m4k} -- a MIPS core
4086 @item @code{xscale} -- this is actually an architecture,
4087 not a CPU type. It is based on the ARMv5 architecture.
4088 @item @code{openrisc} -- this is an OpenRISC 1000 core.
4089 The current implementation supports three JTAG TAP cores:
4090 @item @code{ls1_sap} -- this is the SAP on NXP LS102x CPUs,
4091 allowing access to physical memory addresses independently of CPU cores.
4092 @itemize @minus
4093 @item @code{OpenCores TAP} (See: @url{http://opencores.org/project,jtag})
4094 @item @code{Altera Virtual JTAG TAP} (See: @url{http://www.altera.com/literature/ug/ug_virtualjtag.pdf})
4095 @item @code{Xilinx BSCAN_* virtual JTAG interface} (See: @url{http://www.xilinx.com/support/documentation/sw_manuals/xilinx14_2/spartan6_hdl.pdf})
4096 @end itemize
4097 And two debug interfaces cores:
4098 @itemize @minus
4099 @item @code{Advanced debug interface} (See: @url{http://opencores.org/project,adv_debug_sys})
4100 @item @code{SoC Debug Interface} (See: @url{http://opencores.org/project,dbg_interface})
4101 @end itemize
4102 @end itemize
4103 @end deffn
4104
4105 To avoid being confused by the variety of ARM based cores, remember
4106 this key point: @emph{ARM is a technology licencing company}.
4107 (See: @url{http://www.arm.com}.)
4108 The CPU name used by OpenOCD will reflect the CPU design that was
4109 licenced, not a vendor brand which incorporates that design.
4110 Name prefixes like arm7, arm9, arm11, and cortex
4111 reflect design generations;
4112 while names like ARMv4, ARMv5, ARMv6, ARMv7 and ARMv8
4113 reflect an architecture version implemented by a CPU design.
4114
4115 @anchor{targetconfiguration}
4116 @section Target Configuration
4117
4118 Before creating a ``target'', you must have added its TAP to the scan chain.
4119 When you've added that TAP, you will have a @code{dotted.name}
4120 which is used to set up the CPU support.
4121 The chip-specific configuration file will normally configure its CPU(s)
4122 right after it adds all of the chip's TAPs to the scan chain.
4123
4124 Although you can set up a target in one step, it's often clearer if you
4125 use shorter commands and do it in two steps: create it, then configure
4126 optional parts.
4127 All operations on the target after it's created will use a new
4128 command, created as part of target creation.
4129
4130 The two main things to configure after target creation are
4131 a work area, which usually has target-specific defaults even
4132 if the board setup code overrides them later;
4133 and event handlers (@pxref{targetevents,,Target Events}), which tend
4134 to be much more board-specific.
4135 The key steps you use might look something like this
4136
4137 @example
4138 target create MyTarget cortex_m -chain-position mychip.cpu
4139 $MyTarget configure -work-area-phys 0x08000 -work-area-size 8096
4140 $MyTarget configure -event reset-deassert-pre @{ jtag_rclk 5 @}
4141 $MyTarget configure -event reset-init @{ myboard_reinit @}
4142 @end example
4143
4144 You should specify a working area if you can; typically it uses some
4145 on-chip SRAM.
4146 Such a working area can speed up many things, including bulk
4147 writes to target memory;
4148 flash operations like checking to see if memory needs to be erased;
4149 GDB memory checksumming;
4150 and more.
4151
4152 @quotation Warning
4153 On more complex chips, the work area can become
4154 inaccessible when application code
4155 (such as an operating system)
4156 enables or disables the MMU.
4157 For example, the particular MMU context used to acess the virtual
4158 address will probably matter ... and that context might not have
4159 easy access to other addresses needed.
4160 At this writing, OpenOCD doesn't have much MMU intelligence.
4161 @end quotation
4162
4163 It's often very useful to define a @code{reset-init} event handler.
4164 For systems that are normally used with a boot loader,
4165 common tasks include updating clocks and initializing memory
4166 controllers.
4167 That may be needed to let you write the boot loader into flash,
4168 in order to ``de-brick'' your board; or to load programs into
4169 external DDR memory without having run the boot loader.
4170
4171 @deffn Command {target create} target_name type configparams...
4172 This command creates a GDB debug target that refers to a specific JTAG tap.
4173 It enters that target into a list, and creates a new
4174 command (@command{@var{target_name}}) which is used for various
4175 purposes including additional configuration.
4176
4177 @itemize @bullet
4178 @item @var{target_name} ... is the name of the debug target.
4179 By convention this should be the same as the @emph{dotted.name}
4180 of the TAP associated with this target, which must be specified here
4181 using the @code{-chain-position @var{dotted.name}} configparam.
4182
4183 This name is also used to create the target object command,
4184 referred to here as @command{$target_name},
4185 and in other places the target needs to be identified.
4186 @item @var{type} ... specifies the target type. @xref{targettypes,,target types}.
4187 @item @var{configparams} ... all parameters accepted by
4188 @command{$target_name configure} are permitted.
4189 If the target is big-endian, set it here with @code{-endian big}.
4190
4191 You @emph{must} set the @code{-chain-position @var{dotted.name}} here.
4192 @end itemize
4193 @end deffn
4194
4195 @deffn Command {$target_name configure} configparams...
4196 The options accepted by this command may also be
4197 specified as parameters to @command{target create}.
4198 Their values can later be queried one at a time by
4199 using the @command{$target_name cget} command.
4200
4201 @emph{Warning:} changing some of these after setup is dangerous.
4202 For example, moving a target from one TAP to another;
4203 and changing its endianness.
4204
4205 @itemize @bullet
4206
4207 @item @code{-chain-position} @var{dotted.name} -- names the TAP
4208 used to access this target.
4209
4210 @item @code{-endian} (@option{big}|@option{little}) -- specifies
4211 whether the CPU uses big or little endian conventions
4212
4213 @item @code{-event} @var{event_name} @var{event_body} --
4214 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
4215 Note that this updates a list of named event handlers.
4216 Calling this twice with two different event names assigns
4217 two different handlers, but calling it twice with the
4218 same event name assigns only one handler.
4219
4220 @item @code{-work-area-backup} (@option{0}|@option{1}) -- says
4221 whether the work area gets backed up; by default,
4222 @emph{it is not backed up.}
4223 When possible, use a working_area that doesn't need to be backed up,
4224 since performing a backup slows down operations.
4225 For example, the beginning of an SRAM block is likely to
4226 be used by most build systems, but the end is often unused.
4227
4228 @item @code{-work-area-size} @var{size} -- specify work are size,
4229 in bytes. The same size applies regardless of whether its physical
4230 or virtual address is being used.
4231
4232 @item @code{-work-area-phys} @var{address} -- set the work area
4233 base @var{address} to be used when no MMU is active.
4234
4235 @item @code{-work-area-virt} @var{address} -- set the work area
4236 base @var{address} to be used when an MMU is active.
4237 @emph{Do not specify a value for this except on targets with an MMU.}
4238 The value should normally correspond to a static mapping for the
4239 @code{-work-area-phys} address, set up by the current operating system.
4240
4241 @anchor{rtostype}
4242 @item @code{-rtos} @var{rtos_type} -- enable rtos support for target,
4243 @var{rtos_type} can be one of @option{auto}, @option{eCos},
4244 @option{ThreadX}, @option{FreeRTOS}, @option{linux}, @option{ChibiOS},
4245 @option{embKernel}, @option{mqx}, @option{uCOS-III}
4246 @xref{gdbrtossupport,,RTOS Support}.
4247
4248 @item @code{-defer-examine} -- skip target examination at initial JTAG chain
4249 scan and after a reset. A manual call to arp_examine is required to
4250 access the target for debugging.
4251
4252 @item @code{-ap-num} @var{ap_number} -- set DAP access port for target,
4253 @var{ap_number} is the numeric index of the DAP AP the target is connected to.
4254 Use this option with systems where multiple, independent cores are connected
4255 to separate access ports of the same DAP.
4256
4257 @item @code{-ctibase} @var{address} -- set base address of Cross-Trigger interface (CTI) connected
4258 to the target. Currently, only the @code{aarch64} target makes use of this option, where it is
4259 a mandatory configuration for the target run control.
4260 @end itemize
4261 @end deffn
4262
4263 @section Other $target_name Commands
4264 @cindex object command
4265
4266 The Tcl/Tk language has the concept of object commands,
4267 and OpenOCD adopts that same model for targets.
4268
4269 A good Tk example is a on screen button.
4270 Once a button is created a button
4271 has a name (a path in Tk terms) and that name is useable as a first
4272 class command. For example in Tk, one can create a button and later
4273 configure it like this:
4274
4275 @example
4276 # Create
4277 button .foobar -background red -command @{ foo @}
4278 # Modify
4279 .foobar configure -foreground blue
4280 # Query
4281 set x [.foobar cget -background]
4282 # Report
4283 puts [format "The button is %s" $x]
4284 @end example
4285
4286 In OpenOCD's terms, the ``target'' is an object just like a Tcl/Tk
4287 button, and its object commands are invoked the same way.
4288
4289 @example
4290 str912.cpu mww 0x1234 0x42
4291 omap3530.cpu mww 0x5555 123
4292 @end example
4293
4294 The commands supported by OpenOCD target objects are:
4295
4296 @deffn Command {$target_name arp_examine} @option{allow-defer}
4297 @deffnx Command {$target_name arp_halt}
4298 @deffnx Command {$target_name arp_poll}
4299 @deffnx Command {$target_name arp_reset}
4300 @deffnx Command {$target_name arp_waitstate}
4301 Internal OpenOCD scripts (most notably @file{startup.tcl})
4302 use these to deal with specific reset cases.
4303 They are not otherwise documented here.
4304 @end deffn
4305
4306 @deffn Command {$target_name array2mem} arrayname width address count
4307 @deffnx Command {$target_name mem2array} arrayname width address count
4308 These provide an efficient script-oriented interface to memory.
4309 The @code{array2mem} primitive writes bytes, halfwords, or words;
4310 while @code{mem2array} reads them.
4311 In both cases, the TCL side uses an array, and
4312 the target side uses raw memory.
4313
4314 The efficiency comes from enabling the use of
4315 bulk JTAG data transfer operations.
4316 The script orientation comes from working with data
4317 values that are packaged for use by TCL scripts;
4318 @command{mdw} type primitives only print data they retrieve,
4319 and neither store nor return those values.
4320
4321 @itemize
4322 @item @var{arrayname} ... is the name of an array variable
4323 @item @var{width} ... is 8/16/32 - indicating the memory access size
4324 @item @var{address} ... is the target memory address
4325 @item @var{count} ... is the number of elements to process
4326 @end itemize
4327 @end deffn
4328
4329 @deffn Command {$target_name cget} queryparm
4330 Each configuration parameter accepted by
4331 @command{$target_name configure}
4332 can be individually queried, to return its current value.
4333 The @var{queryparm} is a parameter name
4334 accepted by that command, such as @code{-work-area-phys}.
4335 There are a few special cases:
4336
4337 @itemize @bullet
4338 @item @code{-event} @var{event_name} -- returns the handler for the
4339 event named @var{event_name}.
4340 This is a special case because setting a handler requires
4341 two parameters.
4342 @item @code{-type} -- returns the target type.
4343 This is a special case because this is set using
4344 @command{target create} and can't be changed
4345 using @command{$target_name configure}.
4346 @end itemize
4347
4348 For example, if you wanted to summarize information about
4349 all the targets you might use something like this:
4350
4351 @example
4352 foreach name [target names] @{
4353 set y [$name cget -endian]
4354 set z [$name cget -type]
4355 puts [format "Chip %d is %s, Endian: %s, type: %s" \
4356 $x $name $y $z]
4357 @}
4358 @end example
4359 @end deffn
4360
4361 @anchor{targetcurstate}
4362 @deffn Command {$target_name curstate}
4363 Displays the current target state:
4364 @code{debug-running},
4365 @code{halted},
4366 @code{reset},
4367 @code{running}, or @code{unknown}.
4368 (Also, @pxref{eventpolling,,Event Polling}.)
4369 @end deffn
4370
4371 @deffn Command {$target_name eventlist}
4372 Displays a table listing all event handlers
4373 currently associated with this target.
4374 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
4375 @end deffn
4376
4377 @deffn Command {$target_name invoke-event} event_name
4378 Invokes the handler for the event named @var{event_name}.
4379 (This is primarily intended for use by OpenOCD framework
4380 code, for example by the reset code in @file{startup.tcl}.)
4381 @end deffn
4382
4383 @deffn Command {$target_name mdw} addr [count]
4384 @deffnx Command {$target_name mdh} addr [count]
4385 @deffnx Command {$target_name mdb} addr [count]
4386 Display contents of address @var{addr}, as
4387 32-bit words (@command{mdw}), 16-bit halfwords (@command{mdh}),
4388 or 8-bit bytes (@command{mdb}).
4389 If @var{count} is specified, displays that many units.
4390 (If you want to manipulate the data instead of displaying it,
4391 see the @code{mem2array} primitives.)
4392 @end deffn
4393
4394 @deffn Command {$target_name mww} addr word
4395 @deffnx Command {$target_name mwh} addr halfword
4396 @deffnx Command {$target_name mwb} addr byte
4397 Writes the specified @var{word} (32 bits),
4398 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) pattern,
4399 at the specified address @var{addr}.
4400 @end deffn
4401
4402 @anchor{targetevents}
4403 @section Target Events
4404 @cindex target events
4405 @cindex events
4406 At various times, certain things can happen, or you want them to happen.
4407 For example:
4408 @itemize @bullet
4409 @item What should happen when GDB connects? Should your target reset?
4410 @item When GDB tries to flash the target, do you need to enable the flash via a special command?
4411 @item Is using SRST appropriate (and possible) on your system?
4412 Or instead of that, do you need to issue JTAG commands to trigger reset?
4413 SRST usually resets everything on the scan chain, which can be inappropriate.
4414 @item During reset, do you need to write to certain memory locations
4415 to set up system clocks or
4416 to reconfigure the SDRAM?
4417 How about configuring the watchdog timer, or other peripherals,
4418 to stop running while you hold the core stopped for debugging?
4419 @end itemize
4420
4421 All of the above items can be addressed by target event handlers.
4422 These are set up by @command{$target_name configure -event} or
4423 @command{target create ... -event}.
4424
4425 The programmer's model matches the @code{-command} option used in Tcl/Tk
4426 buttons and events. The two examples below act the same, but one creates
4427 and invokes a small procedure while the other inlines it.
4428
4429 @example
4430 proc my_attach_proc @{ @} @{
4431 echo "Reset..."
4432 reset halt
4433 @}
4434 mychip.cpu configure -event gdb-attach my_attach_proc
4435 mychip.cpu configure -event gdb-attach @{
4436 echo "Reset..."
4437 # To make flash probe and gdb load to flash work
4438 # we need a reset init.
4439 reset init
4440 @}
4441 @end example
4442
4443 The following target events are defined:
4444
4445 @itemize @bullet
4446 @item @b{debug-halted}
4447 @* The target has halted for debug reasons (i.e.: breakpoint)
4448 @item @b{debug-resumed}
4449 @* The target has resumed (i.e.: gdb said run)
4450 @item @b{early-halted}
4451 @* Occurs early in the halt process
4452 @item @b{examine-start}
4453 @* Before target examine is called.
4454 @item @b{examine-end}
4455 @* After target examine is called with no errors.
4456 @item @b{gdb-attach}
4457 @* When GDB connects. This is before any communication with the target, so this
4458 can be used to set up the target so it is possible to probe flash. Probing flash
4459 is necessary during gdb connect if gdb load is to write the image to flash. Another
4460 use of the flash memory map is for GDB to automatically hardware/software breakpoints
4461 depending on whether the breakpoint is in RAM or read only memory.
4462 @item @b{gdb-detach}
4463 @* When GDB disconnects
4464 @item @b{gdb-end}
4465 @* When the target has halted and GDB is not doing anything (see early halt)
4466 @item @b{gdb-flash-erase-start}
4467 @* Before the GDB flash process tries to erase the flash (default is
4468 @code{reset init})
4469 @item @b{gdb-flash-erase-end}
4470 @* After the GDB flash process has finished erasing the flash
4471 @item @b{gdb-flash-write-start}
4472 @* Before GDB writes to the flash
4473 @item @b{gdb-flash-write-end}
4474 @* After GDB writes to the flash (default is @code{reset halt})
4475 @item @b{gdb-start}
4476 @* Before the target steps, gdb is trying to start/resume the target
4477 @item @b{halted}
4478 @* The target has halted
4479 @item @b{reset-assert-pre}
4480 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4481 after @command{reset_init} was triggered
4482 but before either SRST alone is re-asserted on the scan chain,
4483 or @code{reset-assert} is triggered.
4484 @item @b{reset-assert}
4485 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4486 after @command{reset-assert-pre} was triggered.
4487 When such a handler is present, cores which support this event will use
4488 it instead of asserting SRST.
4489 This support is essential for debugging with JTAG interfaces which
4490 don't include an SRST line (JTAG doesn't require SRST), and for
4491 selective reset on scan chains that have multiple targets.
4492 @item @b{reset-assert-post}
4493 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4494 after @code{reset-assert} has been triggered.
4495 or the target asserted SRST on the entire scan chain.
4496 @item @b{reset-deassert-pre}
4497 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4498 after @code{reset-assert-post} has been triggered.
4499 @item @b{reset-deassert-post}
4500 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4501 after @code{reset-deassert-pre} has been triggered
4502 and (if the target is using it) after SRST has been
4503 released on the scan chain.
4504 @item @b{reset-end}
4505 @* Issued as the final step in @command{reset} processing.
4506 @item @b{reset-init}
4507 @* Used by @b{reset init} command for board-specific initialization.
4508 This event fires after @emph{reset-deassert-post}.
4509
4510 This is where you would configure PLLs and clocking, set up DRAM so
4511 you can download programs that don't fit in on-chip SRAM, set up pin
4512 multiplexing, and so on.
4513 (You may be able to switch to a fast JTAG clock rate here, after
4514 the target clocks are fully set up.)
4515 @item @b{reset-start}
4516 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4517 before @command{reset_init} is called.
4518
4519 This is the most robust place to use @command{jtag_rclk}
4520 or @command{adapter_khz} to switch to a low JTAG clock rate,
4521 when reset disables PLLs needed to use a fast clock.
4522 @item @b{resume-start}
4523 @* Before any target is resumed
4524 @item @b{resume-end}
4525 @* After all targets have resumed
4526 @item @b{resumed}
4527 @* Target has resumed
4528 @item @b{trace-config}
4529 @* After target hardware trace configuration was changed
4530 @end itemize
4531
4532 @node Flash Commands
4533 @chapter Flash Commands
4534
4535 OpenOCD has different commands for NOR and NAND flash;
4536 the ``flash'' command works with NOR flash, while
4537 the ``nand'' command works with NAND flash.
4538 This partially reflects different hardware technologies:
4539 NOR flash usually supports direct CPU instruction and data bus access,
4540 while data from a NAND flash must be copied to memory before it can be
4541 used. (SPI flash must also be copied to memory before use.)
4542 However, the documentation also uses ``flash'' as a generic term;
4543 for example, ``Put flash configuration in board-specific files''.
4544
4545 Flash Steps:
4546 @enumerate
4547 @item Configure via the command @command{flash bank}
4548 @* Do this in a board-specific configuration file,
4549 passing parameters as needed by the driver.
4550 @item Operate on the flash via @command{flash subcommand}
4551 @* Often commands to manipulate the flash are typed by a human, or run
4552 via a script in some automated way. Common tasks include writing a
4553 boot loader, operating system, or other data.
4554 @item GDB Flashing
4555 @* Flashing via GDB requires the flash be configured via ``flash
4556 bank'', and the GDB flash features be enabled.
4557 @xref{gdbconfiguration,,GDB Configuration}.
4558 @end enumerate
4559
4560 Many CPUs have the ablity to ``boot'' from the first flash bank.
4561 This means that misprogramming that bank can ``brick'' a system,
4562 so that it can't boot.
4563 JTAG tools, like OpenOCD, are often then used to ``de-brick'' the
4564 board by (re)installing working boot firmware.
4565
4566 @anchor{norconfiguration}
4567 @section Flash Configuration Commands
4568 @cindex flash configuration
4569
4570 @deffn {Config Command} {flash bank} name driver base size chip_width bus_width target [driver_options]
4571 Configures a flash bank which provides persistent storage
4572 for addresses from @math{base} to @math{base + size - 1}.
4573 These banks will often be visible to GDB through the target's memory map.
4574 In some cases, configuring a flash bank will activate extra commands;
4575 see the driver-specific documentation.
4576
4577 @itemize @bullet
4578 @item @var{name} ... may be used to reference the flash bank
4579 in other flash commands. A number is also available.
4580 @item @var{driver} ... identifies the controller driver
4581 associated with the flash bank being declared.
4582 This is usually @code{cfi} for external flash, or else
4583 the name of a microcontroller with embedded flash memory.
4584 @xref{flashdriverlist,,Flash Driver List}.
4585 @item @var{base} ... Base address of the flash chip.
4586 @item @var{size} ... Size of the chip, in bytes.
4587 For some drivers, this value is detected from the hardware.
4588 @item @var{chip_width} ... Width of the flash chip, in bytes;
4589 ignored for most microcontroller drivers.
4590 @item @var{bus_width} ... Width of the data bus used to access the
4591 chip, in bytes; ignored for most microcontroller drivers.
4592 @item @var{target} ... Names the target used to issue
4593 commands to the flash controller.
4594 @comment Actually, it's currently a controller-specific parameter...
4595 @item @var{driver_options} ... drivers may support, or require,
4596 additional parameters. See the driver-specific documentation
4597 for more information.
4598 @end itemize
4599 @quotation Note
4600 This command is not available after OpenOCD initialization has completed.
4601 Use it in board specific configuration files, not interactively.
4602 @end quotation
4603 @end deffn
4604
4605 @comment the REAL name for this command is "ocd_flash_banks"
4606 @comment less confusing would be: "flash list" (like "nand list")
4607 @deffn Command {flash banks}
4608 Prints a one-line summary of each device that was
4609 declared using @command{flash bank}, numbered from zero.
4610 Note that this is the @emph{plural} form;
4611 the @emph{singular} form is a very different command.
4612 @end deffn
4613
4614 @deffn Command {flash list}
4615 Retrieves a list of associative arrays for each device that was
4616 declared using @command{flash bank}, numbered from zero.
4617 This returned list can be manipulated easily from within scripts.
4618 @end deffn
4619
4620 @deffn Command {flash probe} num
4621 Identify the flash, or validate the parameters of the configured flash. Operation
4622 depends on the flash type.
4623 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
4624 Most flash commands will implicitly @emph{autoprobe} the bank;
4625 flash drivers can distinguish between probing and autoprobing,
4626 but most don't bother.
4627 @end deffn
4628
4629 @section Erasing, Reading, Writing to Flash
4630 @cindex flash erasing
4631 @cindex flash reading
4632 @cindex flash writing
4633 @cindex flash programming
4634 @anchor{flashprogrammingcommands}
4635
4636 One feature distinguishing NOR flash from NAND or serial flash technologies
4637 is that for read access, it acts exactly like any other addressible memory.
4638 This means you can use normal memory read commands like @command{mdw} or
4639 @command{dump_image} with it, with no special @command{flash} subcommands.
4640 @xref{memoryaccess,,Memory access}, and @ref{imageaccess,,Image access}.
4641
4642 Write access works differently. Flash memory normally needs to be erased
4643 before it's written. Erasing a sector turns all of its bits to ones, and
4644 writing can turn ones into zeroes. This is why there are special commands
4645 for interactive erasing and writing, and why GDB needs to know which parts
4646 of the address space hold NOR flash memory.
4647
4648 @quotation Note
4649 Most of these erase and write commands leverage the fact that NOR flash
4650 chips consume target address space. They implicitly refer to the current
4651 JTAG target, and map from an address in that target's address space
4652 back to a flash bank.
4653 @comment In May 2009, those mappings may fail if any bank associated
4654 @comment with that target doesn't succesfuly autoprobe ... bug worth fixing?
4655 A few commands use abstract addressing based on bank and sector numbers,
4656 and don't depend on searching the current target and its address space.
4657 Avoid confusing the two command models.
4658 @end quotation
4659
4660 Some flash chips implement software protection against accidental writes,
4661 since such buggy writes could in some cases ``brick'' a system.
4662 For such systems, erasing and writing may require sector protection to be
4663 disabled first.
4664 Examples include CFI flash such as ``Intel Advanced Bootblock flash'',
4665 and AT91SAM7 on-chip flash.
4666 @xref{flashprotect,,flash protect}.
4667
4668 @deffn Command {flash erase_sector} num first last
4669 Erase sectors in bank @var{num}, starting at sector @var{first}
4670 up to and including @var{last}.
4671 Sector numbering starts at 0.
4672 Providing a @var{last} sector of @option{last}
4673 specifies "to the end of the flash bank".
4674 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
4675 @end deffn
4676
4677 @deffn Command {flash erase_address} [@option{pad}] [@option{unlock}] address length
4678 Erase sectors starting at @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
4679 Unless @option{pad} is specified, @math{address} must begin a
4680 flash sector, and @math{address + length - 1} must end a sector.
4681 Specifying @option{pad} erases extra data at the beginning and/or
4682 end of the specified region, as needed to erase only full sectors.
4683 The flash bank to use is inferred from the @var{address}, and
4684 the specified length must stay within that bank.
4685 As a special case, when @var{length} is zero and @var{address} is
4686 the start of the bank, the whole flash is erased.
4687 If @option{unlock} is specified, then the flash is unprotected
4688 before erase starts.
4689 @end deffn
4690
4691 @deffn Command {flash fillw} address word length
4692 @deffnx Command {flash fillh} address halfword length
4693 @deffnx Command {flash fillb} address byte length
4694 Fills flash memory with the specified @var{word} (32 bits),
4695 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) pattern,
4696 starting at @var{address} and continuing
4697 for @var{length} units (word/halfword/byte).
4698 No erasure is done before writing; when needed, that must be done
4699 before issuing this command.
4700 Writes are done in blocks of up to 1024 bytes, and each write is
4701 verified by reading back the data and comparing it to what was written.
4702 The flash bank to use is inferred from the @var{address} of
4703 each block, and the specified length must stay within that bank.
4704 @end deffn
4705 @comment no current checks for errors if fill blocks touch multiple banks!
4706
4707 @deffn Command {flash write_bank} num filename [offset]
4708 Write the binary @file{filename} to flash bank @var{num},
4709 starting at @var{offset} bytes from the beginning of the bank. If @var{offset}
4710 is omitted, start at the beginning of the flash bank.
4711 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
4712 @end deffn
4713
4714 @deffn Command {flash read_bank} num filename [offset [length]]
4715 Read @var{length} bytes from the flash bank @var{num} starting at @var{offset}
4716 and write the contents to the binary @file{filename}. If @var{offset} is
4717 omitted, start at the beginning of the flash bank. If @var{length} is omitted,
4718 read the remaining bytes from the flash bank.
4719 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
4720 @end deffn
4721
4722 @deffn Command {flash verify_bank} num filename [offset]
4723 Compare the contents of the binary file @var{filename} with the contents of the
4724 flash bank @var{num} starting at @var{offset}. If @var{offset} is omitted,
4725 start at the beginning of the flash bank. Fail if the contents do not match.
4726 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
4727 @end deffn
4728
4729 @deffn Command {flash write_image} [erase] [unlock] filename [offset] [type]
4730 Write the image @file{filename} to the current target's flash bank(s).
4731 Only loadable sections from the image are written.
4732 A relocation @var{offset} may be specified, in which case it is added
4733 to the base address for each section in the image.
4734 The file [@var{type}] can be specified
4735 explicitly as @option{bin} (binary), @option{ihex} (Intel hex),
4736 @option{elf} (ELF file), @option{s19} (Motorola s19).
4737 @option{mem}, or @option{builder}.
4738 The relevant flash sectors will be erased prior to programming
4739 if the @option{erase} parameter is given. If @option{unlock} is
4740 provided, then the flash banks are unlocked before erase and
4741 program. The flash bank to use is inferred from the address of
4742 each image section.
4743
4744 @quotation Warning
4745 Be careful using the @option{erase} flag when the flash is holding
4746 data you want to preserve.
4747 Portions of the flash outside those described in the image's
4748 sections might be erased with no notice.
4749 @itemize
4750 @item
4751 When a section of the image being written does not fill out all the
4752 sectors it uses, the unwritten parts of those sectors are necessarily
4753 also erased, because sectors can't be partially erased.
4754 @item
4755 Data stored in sector "holes" between image sections are also affected.
4756 For example, "@command{flash write_image erase ...}" of an image with
4757 one byte at the beginning of a flash bank and one byte at the end
4758 erases the entire bank -- not just the two sectors being written.
4759 @end itemize
4760 Also, when flash protection is important, you must re-apply it after
4761 it has been removed by the @option{unlock} flag.
4762 @end quotation
4763
4764 @end deffn
4765
4766 @section Other Flash commands
4767 @cindex flash protection
4768
4769 @deffn Command {flash erase_check} num
4770 Check erase state of sectors in flash bank @var{num},
4771 and display that status.
4772 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
4773 @end deffn
4774
4775 @deffn Command {flash info} num [sectors]
4776 Print info about flash bank @var{num}, a list of protection blocks
4777 and their status. Use @option{sectors} to show a list of sectors instead.
4778
4779 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
4780 This command will first query the hardware, it does not print cached
4781 and possibly stale information.
4782 @end deffn
4783
4784 @anchor{flashprotect}
4785 @deffn Command {flash protect} num first last (@option{on}|@option{off})
4786 Enable (@option{on}) or disable (@option{off}) protection of flash blocks
4787 in flash bank @var{num}, starting at protection block @var{first}
4788 and continuing up to and including @var{last}.
4789 Providing a @var{last} block of @option{last}
4790 specifies "to the end of the flash bank".
4791 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
4792 The protection block is usually identical to a flash sector.
4793 Some devices may utilize a protection block distinct from flash sector.
4794 See @command{flash info} for a list of protection blocks.
4795 @end deffn
4796
4797 @deffn Command {flash padded_value} num value
4798 Sets the default value used for padding any image sections, This should
4799 normally match the flash bank erased value. If not specified by this
4800 comamnd or the flash driver then it defaults to 0xff.
4801 @end deffn
4802
4803 @anchor{program}
4804 @deffn Command {program} filename [verify] [reset] [exit] [offset]
4805 This is a helper script that simplifies using OpenOCD as a standalone
4806 programmer. The only required parameter is @option{filename}, the others are optional.
4807 @xref{Flash Programming}.
4808 @end deffn
4809
4810 @anchor{flashdriverlist}
4811 @section Flash Driver List
4812 As noted above, the @command{flash bank} command requires a driver name,
4813 and allows driver-specific options and behaviors.
4814 Some drivers also activate driver-specific commands.
4815
4816 @deffn {Flash Driver} virtual
4817 This is a special driver that maps a previously defined bank to another
4818 address. All bank settings will be copied from the master physical bank.
4819
4820 The @var{virtual} driver defines one mandatory parameters,
4821
4822 @itemize
4823 @item @var{master_bank} The bank that this virtual address refers to.
4824 @end itemize
4825
4826 So in the following example addresses 0xbfc00000 and 0x9fc00000 refer to
4827 the flash bank defined at address 0x1fc00000. Any cmds executed on
4828 the virtual banks are actually performed on the physical banks.
4829 @example
4830 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pic32mx 0x1fc00000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
4831 flash bank vbank0 virtual 0xbfc00000 0 0 0 \
4832 $_TARGETNAME $_FLASHNAME
4833 flash bank vbank1 virtual 0x9fc00000 0 0 0 \
4834 $_TARGETNAME $_FLASHNAME
4835 @end example
4836 @end deffn
4837
4838 @subsection External Flash
4839
4840 @deffn {Flash Driver} cfi
4841 @cindex Common Flash Interface
4842 @cindex CFI
4843 The ``Common Flash Interface'' (CFI) is the main standard for
4844 external NOR flash chips, each of which connects to a
4845 specific external chip select on the CPU.
4846 Frequently the first such chip is used to boot the system.
4847 Your board's @code{reset-init} handler might need to
4848 configure additional chip selects using other commands (like: @command{mww} to
4849 configure a bus and its timings), or
4850 perhaps configure a GPIO pin that controls the ``write protect'' pin
4851 on the flash chip.
4852 The CFI driver can use a target-specific working area to significantly
4853 speed up operation.
4854
4855 The CFI driver can accept the following optional parameters, in any order:
4856
4857 @itemize
4858 @item @var{jedec_probe} ... is used to detect certain non-CFI flash ROMs,
4859 like AM29LV010 and similar types.
4860 @item @var{x16_as_x8} ... when a 16-bit flash is hooked up to an 8-bit bus.
4861 @item @var{bus_swap} ... when data bytes in a 16-bit flash needs to be swapped.
4862 @item @var{data_swap} ... when data bytes in a 16-bit flash needs to be
4863 swapped when writing data values (ie. not CFI commands).
4864 @end itemize
4865
4866 To configure two adjacent banks of 16 MBytes each, both sixteen bits (two bytes)
4867 wide on a sixteen bit bus:
4868
4869 @example
4870 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x00000000 0x01000000 2 2 $_TARGETNAME
4871 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x01000000 0x01000000 2 2 $_TARGETNAME
4872 @end example
4873
4874 To configure one bank of 32 MBytes
4875 built from two sixteen bit (two byte) wide parts wired in parallel
4876 to create a thirty-two bit (four byte) bus with doubled throughput:
4877
4878 @example
4879 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x00000000 0x02000000 2 4 $_TARGETNAME
4880 @end example
4881
4882 @c "cfi part_id" disabled
4883 @end deffn
4884
4885 @deffn {Flash Driver} jtagspi
4886 @cindex Generic JTAG2SPI driver
4887 @cindex SPI
4888 @cindex jtagspi
4889 @cindex bscan_spi
4890 Several FPGAs and CPLDs can retrieve their configuration (bitstream) from a
4891 SPI flash connected to them. To access this flash from the host, the device
4892 is first programmed with a special proxy bitstream that
4893 exposes the SPI flash on the device's JTAG interface. The flash can then be
4894 accessed through JTAG.
4895
4896 Since signaling between JTAG and SPI is compatible, all that is required for
4897 a proxy bitstream is to connect TDI-MOSI, TDO-MISO, TCK-CLK and activate
4898 the flash chip select when the JTAG state machine is in SHIFT-DR. Such
4899 a bitstream for several Xilinx FPGAs can be found in
4900 @file{contrib/loaders/flash/fpga/xilinx_bscan_spi.py}. It requires
4901 @uref{https://github.com/m-labs/migen, migen} and a Xilinx toolchain to build.
4902
4903 This flash bank driver requires a target on a JTAG tap and will access that
4904 tap directly. Since no support from the target is needed, the target can be a
4905 "testee" dummy. Since the target does not expose the flash memory
4906 mapping, target commands that would otherwise be expected to access the flash
4907 will not work. These include all @command{*_image} and
4908 @command{$target_name m*} commands as well as @command{program}. Equivalent
4909 functionality is available through the @command{flash write_bank},
4910 @command{flash read_bank}, and @command{flash verify_bank} commands.
4911
4912 @itemize
4913 @item @var{ir} ... is loaded into the JTAG IR to map the flash as the JTAG DR.
4914 For the bitstreams generated from @file{xilinx_bscan_spi.py} this is the
4915 @var{USER1} instruction.
4916 @item @var{dr_length} ... is the length of the DR register. This will be 1 for
4917 @file{xilinx_bscan_spi.py} bitstreams and most other cases.
4918 @end itemize
4919
4920 @example
4921 target create $_TARGETNAME testee -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.fpga
4922 set _XILINX_USER1 0x02
4923 set _DR_LENGTH 1
4924 flash bank $_FLASHNAME spi 0x0 0 0 0 \
4925 $_TARGETNAME $_XILINX_USER1 $_DR_LENGTH
4926 @end example
4927 @end deffn
4928
4929 @deffn {Flash Driver} lpcspifi
4930 @cindex NXP SPI Flash Interface
4931 @cindex SPIFI
4932 @cindex lpcspifi
4933 NXP's LPC43xx and LPC18xx families include a proprietary SPI
4934 Flash Interface (SPIFI) peripheral that can drive and provide
4935 memory mapped access to external SPI flash devices.
4936
4937 The lpcspifi driver initializes this interface and provides
4938 program and erase functionality for these serial flash devices.
4939 Use of this driver @b{requires} a working area of at least 1kB
4940 to be configured on the target device; more than this will
4941 significantly reduce flash programming times.
4942
4943 The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter. All
4944 other parameters are ignored, and the flash size and layout
4945 are configured by the driver.
4946
4947 @example
4948 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpcspifi 0x14000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
4949 @end example
4950
4951 @end deffn
4952
4953 @deffn {Flash Driver} stmsmi
4954 @cindex STMicroelectronics Serial Memory Interface
4955 @cindex SMI
4956 @cindex stmsmi
4957 Some devices form STMicroelectronics (e.g. STR75x MCU family,
4958 SPEAr MPU family) include a proprietary
4959 ``Serial Memory Interface'' (SMI) controller able to drive external
4960 SPI flash devices.
4961 Depending on specific device and board configuration, up to 4 external
4962 flash devices can be connected.
4963
4964 SMI makes the flash content directly accessible in the CPU address
4965 space; each external device is mapped in a memory bank.
4966 CPU can directly read data, execute code and boot from SMI banks.
4967 Normal OpenOCD commands like @command{mdw} can be used to display
4968 the flash content.
4969
4970 The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter in order
4971 to identify the memory bank.
4972 All other parameters are ignored. Additional information, like
4973 flash size, are detected automatically.
4974
4975 @example
4976 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stmsmi 0xf8000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
4977 @end example
4978
4979 @end deffn
4980
4981 @deffn {Flash Driver} mrvlqspi
4982 This driver supports QSPI flash controller of Marvell's Wireless
4983 Microcontroller platform.
4984
4985 The flash size is autodetected based on the table of known JEDEC IDs
4986 hardcoded in the OpenOCD sources.
4987
4988 @example
4989 flash bank $_FLASHNAME mrvlqspi 0x0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 0x46010000
4990 @end example
4991
4992 @end deffn
4993
4994 @deffn {Flash Driver} ath79
4995 @cindex Atheros ath79 SPI driver
4996 @cindex ath79
4997 Members of ATH79 SoC family from Atheros include a SPI interface with 3
4998 chip selects.
4999 On reset a SPI flash connected to the first chip select (CS0) is made
5000 directly read-accessible in the CPU address space (up to 16MBytes)
5001 and is usually used to store the bootloader and operating system.
5002 Normal OpenOCD commands like @command{mdw} can be used to display
5003 the flash content while it is in memory-mapped mode (only the first
5004 4MBytes are accessible without additional configuration on reset).
5005
5006 The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter in order
5007 to identify the memory bank. The actual value for the base address
5008 is not otherwise used by the driver. However the mapping is passed
5009 to gdb. Thus for the memory mapped flash (chipselect CS0) the base
5010 address should be the actual memory mapped base address. For unmapped
5011 chipselects (CS1 and CS2) care should be taken to use a base address
5012 that does not overlap with real memory regions.
5013 Additional information, like flash size, are detected automatically.
5014 An optional additional parameter sets the chipselect for the bank,
5015 with the default CS0.
5016 CS1 and CS2 require additional GPIO setup before they can be used
5017 since the alternate function must be enabled on the GPIO pin
5018 CS1/CS2 is routed to on the given SoC.
5019
5020 @example
5021 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ath79 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5022
5023 # When using multiple chipselects the base should be different for each,
5024 # otherwise the write_image command is not able to distinguish the
5025 # banks.
5026 flash bank flash0 ath79 0x00000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME cs0
5027 flash bank flash1 ath79 0x10000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME cs1
5028 flash bank flash2 ath79 0x20000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME cs2
5029 @end example
5030
5031 @end deffn
5032
5033 @subsection Internal Flash (Microcontrollers)
5034
5035 @deffn {Flash Driver} aduc702x
5036 The ADUC702x analog microcontrollers from Analog Devices
5037 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
5038 The aduc702x flash driver works with models ADUC7019 through ADUC7028.
5039 The setup command only requires the @var{target} argument
5040 since all devices in this family have the same memory layout.
5041
5042 @example
5043 flash bank $_FLASHNAME aduc702x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5044 @end example
5045 @end deffn
5046
5047 @deffn {Flash Driver} ambiqmicro
5048 @cindex ambiqmicro
5049 @cindex apollo
5050 All members of the Apollo microcontroller family from
5051 Ambiq Micro include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
5052 The host connects over USB to an FTDI interface that communicates
5053 with the target using SWD.
5054
5055 The @var{ambiqmicro} driver reads the Chip Information Register detect
5056 the device class of the MCU.
5057 The Flash and Sram sizes directly follow device class, and are used
5058 to set up the flash banks.
5059 If this fails, the driver will use default values set to the minimum
5060 sizes of an Apollo chip.
5061
5062 All Apollo chips have two flash banks of the same size.
5063 In all cases the first flash bank starts at location 0,
5064 and the second bank starts after the first.
5065
5066 @example
5067 # Flash bank 0
5068 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ambiqmicro 0 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5069 # Flash bank 1 - same size as bank0, starts after bank 0.
5070 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ambiqmicro 0x00040000 0x00040000 0 0 \
5071 $_TARGETNAME
5072 @end example
5073
5074 Flash is programmed using custom entry points into the bootloader.
5075 This is the only way to program the flash as no flash control registers
5076 are available to the user.
5077
5078 The @var{ambiqmicro} driver adds some additional commands:
5079
5080 @deffn Command {ambiqmicro mass_erase} <bank>
5081 Erase entire bank.
5082 @end deffn
5083 @deffn Command {ambiqmicro page_erase} <bank> <first> <last>
5084 Erase device pages.
5085 @end deffn
5086 @deffn Command {ambiqmicro program_otp} <bank> <offset> <count>
5087 Program OTP is a one time operation to create write protected flash.
5088 The user writes sectors to sram starting at 0x10000010.
5089 Program OTP will write these sectors from sram to flash, and write protect
5090 the flash.
5091 @end deffn
5092 @end deffn
5093
5094 @anchor{at91samd}
5095 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91samd
5096 @cindex at91samd
5097 All members of the ATSAMD, ATSAMR, ATSAML and ATSAMC microcontroller
5098 families from Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M0+ core.
5099 This driver uses the same cmd names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
5100
5101 @deffn Command {at91samd chip-erase}
5102 Issues a complete Flash erase via the Device Service Unit (DSU). This can be
5103 used to erase a chip back to its factory state and does not require the
5104 processor to be halted.
5105 @end deffn
5106
5107 @deffn Command {at91samd set-security}
5108 Secures the Flash via the Set Security Bit (SSB) command. This prevents access
5109 to the Flash and can only be undone by using the chip-erase command which
5110 erases the Flash contents and turns off the security bit. Warning: at this
5111 time, openocd will not be able to communicate with a secured chip and it is
5112 therefore not possible to chip-erase it without using another tool.
5113
5114 @example
5115 at91samd set-security enable
5116 @end example
5117 @end deffn
5118
5119 @deffn Command {at91samd eeprom}
5120 Shows or sets the EEPROM emulation size configuration, stored in the User Row
5121 of the Flash. When setting, the EEPROM size must be specified in bytes and it
5122 must be one of the permitted sizes according to the datasheet. Settings are
5123 written immediately but only take effect on MCU reset. EEPROM emulation
5124 requires additional firmware support and the minumum EEPROM size may not be
5125 the same as the minimum that the hardware supports. Set the EEPROM size to 0
5126 in order to disable this feature.
5127
5128 @example
5129 at91samd eeprom
5130 at91samd eeprom 1024
5131 @end example
5132 @end deffn
5133
5134 @deffn Command {at91samd bootloader}
5135 Shows or sets the bootloader size configuration, stored in the User Row of the
5136 Flash. This is called the BOOTPROT region. When setting, the bootloader size
5137 must be specified in bytes and it must be one of the permitted sizes according
5138 to the datasheet. Settings are written immediately but only take effect on
5139 MCU reset. Setting the bootloader size to 0 disables bootloader protection.
5140
5141 @example
5142 at91samd bootloader
5143 at91samd bootloader 16384
5144 @end example
5145 @end deffn
5146
5147 @deffn Command {at91samd dsu_reset_deassert}
5148 This command releases internal reset held by DSU
5149 and prepares reset vector catch in case of reset halt.
5150 Command is used internally in event event reset-deassert-post.
5151 @end deffn
5152
5153 @end deffn
5154
5155 @anchor{at91sam3}
5156 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91sam3
5157 @cindex at91sam3
5158 All members of the AT91SAM3 microcontroller family from
5159 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M3 core. The driver
5160 currently (6/22/09) recognizes the AT91SAM3U[1/2/4][C/E] chips. Note
5161 that the driver was orginaly developed and tested using the
5162 AT91SAM3U4E, using a SAM3U-EK eval board. Support for other chips in
5163 the family was cribbed from the data sheet. @emph{Note to future
5164 readers/updaters: Please remove this worrysome comment after other
5165 chips are confirmed.}
5166
5167 The AT91SAM3U4[E/C] (256K) chips have two flash banks; most other chips
5168 have one flash bank. In all cases the flash banks are at
5169 the following fixed locations:
5170
5171 @example
5172 # Flash bank 0 - all chips
5173 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam3 0x00080000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
5174 # Flash bank 1 - only 256K chips
5175 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam3 0x00100000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
5176 @end example
5177
5178 Internally, the AT91SAM3 flash memory is organized as follows.
5179 Unlike the AT91SAM7 chips, these are not used as parameters
5180 to the @command{flash bank} command:
5181
5182 @itemize
5183 @item @emph{N-Banks:} 256K chips have 2 banks, others have 1 bank.
5184 @item @emph{Bank Size:} 128K/64K Per flash bank
5185 @item @emph{Sectors:} 16 or 8 per bank
5186 @item @emph{SectorSize:} 8K Per Sector
5187 @item @emph{PageSize:} 256 bytes per page. Note that OpenOCD operates on 'sector' sizes, not page sizes.
5188 @end itemize
5189
5190 The AT91SAM3 driver adds some additional commands:
5191
5192 @deffn Command {at91sam3 gpnvm}
5193 @deffnx Command {at91sam3 gpnvm clear} number
5194 @deffnx Command {at91sam3 gpnvm set} number
5195 @deffnx Command {at91sam3 gpnvm show} [@option{all}|number]
5196 With no parameters, @command{show} or @command{show all},
5197 shows the status of all GPNVM bits.
5198 With @command{show} @var{number}, displays that bit.
5199
5200 With @command{set} @var{number} or @command{clear} @var{number},
5201 modifies that GPNVM bit.
5202 @end deffn
5203
5204 @deffn Command {at91sam3 info}
5205 This command attempts to display information about the AT91SAM3
5206 chip. @emph{First} it read the @code{CHIPID_CIDR} [address 0x400e0740, see
5207 Section 28.2.1, page 505 of the AT91SAM3U 29/may/2009 datasheet,
5208 document id: doc6430A] and decodes the values. @emph{Second} it reads the
5209 various clock configuration registers and attempts to display how it
5210 believes the chip is configured. By default, the SLOWCLK is assumed to
5211 be 32768 Hz, see the command @command{at91sam3 slowclk}.
5212 @end deffn
5213
5214 @deffn Command {at91sam3 slowclk} [value]
5215 This command shows/sets the slow clock frequency used in the
5216 @command{at91sam3 info} command calculations above.
5217 @end deffn
5218 @end deffn
5219
5220 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91sam4
5221 @cindex at91sam4
5222 All members of the AT91SAM4 microcontroller family from
5223 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
5224 This driver uses the same cmd names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
5225 @end deffn
5226
5227 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91sam4l
5228 @cindex at91sam4l
5229 All members of the AT91SAM4L microcontroller family from
5230 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
5231 This driver uses the same cmd names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
5232
5233 The AT91SAM4L driver adds some additional commands:
5234 @deffn Command {at91sam4l smap_reset_deassert}
5235 This command releases internal reset held by SMAP
5236 and prepares reset vector catch in case of reset halt.
5237 Command is used internally in event event reset-deassert-post.
5238 @end deffn
5239 @end deffn
5240
5241 @deffn {Flash Driver} atsamv
5242 @cindex atsamv
5243 All members of the ATSAMV, ATSAMS, and ATSAME families from
5244 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M7 core.
5245 This driver uses the same cmd names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
5246 @end deffn
5247
5248 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91sam7
5249 All members of the AT91SAM7 microcontroller family from Atmel include
5250 internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores. The driver automatically
5251 recognizes a number of these chips using the chip identification
5252 register, and autoconfigures itself.
5253
5254 @example
5255 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam7 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5256 @end example
5257
5258 For chips which are not recognized by the controller driver, you must
5259 provide additional parameters in the following order:
5260
5261 @itemize
5262 @item @var{chip_model} ... label used with @command{flash info}
5263 @item @var{banks}
5264 @item @var{sectors_per_bank}
5265 @item @var{pages_per_sector}
5266 @item @var{pages_size}
5267 @item @var{num_nvm_bits}
5268 @item @var{freq_khz} ... required if an external clock is provided,
5269 optional (but recommended) when the oscillator frequency is known
5270 @end itemize
5271
5272 It is recommended that you provide zeroes for all of those values
5273 except the clock frequency, so that everything except that frequency
5274 will be autoconfigured.
5275 Knowing the frequency helps ensure correct timings for flash access.
5276
5277 The flash controller handles erases automatically on a page (128/256 byte)
5278 basis, so explicit erase commands are not necessary for flash programming.
5279 However, there is an ``EraseAll`` command that can erase an entire flash
5280 plane (of up to 256KB), and it will be used automatically when you issue
5281 @command{flash erase_sector} or @command{flash erase_address} commands.
5282
5283 @deffn Command {at91sam7 gpnvm} bitnum (@option{set}|@option{clear})
5284 Set or clear a ``General Purpose Non-Volatile Memory'' (GPNVM)
5285 bit for the processor. Each processor has a number of such bits,
5286 used for controlling features such as brownout detection (so they
5287 are not truly general purpose).
5288 @quotation Note
5289 This assumes that the first flash bank (number 0) is associated with
5290 the appropriate at91sam7 target.
5291 @end quotation
5292 @end deffn
5293 @end deffn
5294
5295 @deffn {Flash Driver} avr
5296 The AVR 8-bit microcontrollers from Atmel integrate flash memory.
5297 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete.}
5298 @comment - defines mass_erase ... pointless given flash_erase_address
5299 @end deffn
5300
5301 @deffn {Flash Driver} efm32
5302 All members of the EFM32 microcontroller family from Energy Micro include
5303 internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores. The driver automatically recognizes
5304 a number of these chips using the chip identification register, and
5305 autoconfigures itself.
5306 @example
5307 flash bank $_FLASHNAME efm32 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5308 @end example
5309 A special feature of efm32 controllers is that it is possible to completely disable the
5310 debug interface by writing the correct values to the 'Debug Lock Word'. OpenOCD supports
5311 this via the following command:
5312 @example
5313 efm32 debuglock num
5314 @end example
5315 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5316 Note that in order for this command to take effect, the target needs to be reset.
5317 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete. Unprotecting flash pages is not
5318 supported.}
5319 @end deffn
5320
5321 @deffn {Flash Driver} fm3
5322 All members of the FM3 microcontroller family from Fujitsu
5323 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
5324 The @var{fm3} driver uses the @var{target} parameter to select the
5325 correct bank config, it can currently be one of the following:
5326 @code{mb9bfxx1.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx2.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx3.cpu},
5327 @code{mb9bfxx4.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx5.cpu} or @code{mb9bfxx6.cpu}.
5328
5329 @example
5330 flash bank $_FLASHNAME fm3 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5331 @end example
5332 @end deffn
5333
5334 @deffn {Flash Driver} fm4
5335 All members of the FM4 microcontroller family from Spansion (formerly Fujitsu)
5336 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M4 cores.
5337 The @var{fm4} driver uses a @var{family} parameter to select the
5338 correct bank config, it can currently be one of the following:
5339 @code{MB9BFx64}, @code{MB9BFx65}, @code{MB9BFx66}, @code{MB9BFx67}, @code{MB9BFx68},
5340 @code{S6E2Cx8}, @code{S6E2Cx9}, @code{S6E2CxA} or @code{S6E2Dx},
5341 with @code{x} treated as wildcard and otherwise case (and any trailing
5342 characters) ignored.
5343
5344 @example
5345 flash bank $@{_FLASHNAME@}0 fm4 0x00000000 0 0 0 \
5346 $_TARGETNAME S6E2CCAJ0A
5347 flash bank $@{_FLASHNAME@}1 fm4 0x00100000 0 0 0 \
5348 $_TARGETNAME S6E2CCAJ0A
5349 @end example
5350 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete. Protection is not supported,
5351 nor is Chip Erase (only Sector Erase is implemented).}
5352 @end deffn
5353
5354 @deffn {Flash Driver} kinetis
5355 @cindex kinetis
5356 Kx, KLx, KVx and KE1x members of the Kinetis microcontroller family
5357 from NXP (former Freescale) include
5358 internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0+ or M4 cores. The driver automatically
5359 recognizes flash size and a number of flash banks (1-4) using the chip
5360 identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
5361 Use kinetis_ke driver for KE0x devices.
5362
5363 The @var{kinetis} driver defines option:
5364 @itemize
5365 @item -sim-base @var{addr} ... base of System Integration Module where chip identification resides. Driver tries two known locations if option is omitted.
5366 @end itemize
5367
5368 @example
5369 flash bank $_FLASHNAME kinetis 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5370 @end example
5371
5372 @deffn Command {kinetis create_banks}
5373 Configuration command enables automatic creation of additional flash banks
5374 based on real flash layout of device. Banks are created during device probe.
5375 Use 'flash probe 0' to force probe.
5376 @end deffn
5377
5378 @deffn Command {kinetis fcf_source} [protection|write]
5379 Select what source is used when writing to a Flash Configuration Field.
5380 @option{protection} mode builds FCF content from protection bits previously
5381 set by 'flash protect' command.
5382 This mode is default. MCU is protected from unwanted locking by immediate
5383 writing FCF after erase of relevant sector.
5384 @option{write} mode enables direct write to FCF.
5385 Protection cannot be set by 'flash protect' command. FCF is written along
5386 with the rest of a flash image.
5387 @emph{BEWARE: Incorrect flash configuration may permanently lock the device!}
5388 @end deffn
5389
5390 @deffn Command {kinetis fopt} [num]
5391 Set value to write to FOPT byte of Flash Configuration Field.
5392 Used in kinetis 'fcf_source protection' mode only.
5393 @end deffn
5394
5395 @deffn Command {kinetis mdm check_security}
5396 Checks status of device security lock. Used internally in examine-end event.
5397 @end deffn
5398
5399 @deffn Command {kinetis mdm halt}
5400 Issues a halt via the MDM-AP. This command can be used to break a watchdog reset
5401 loop when connecting to an unsecured target.
5402 @end deffn
5403
5404 @deffn Command {kinetis mdm mass_erase}
5405 Issues a complete flash erase via the MDM-AP. This can be used to erase a chip
5406 back to its factory state, removing security. It does not require the processor
5407 to be halted, however the target will remain in a halted state after this
5408 command completes.
5409 @end deffn
5410
5411 @deffn Command {kinetis nvm_partition}
5412 For FlexNVM devices only (KxxDX and KxxFX).
5413 Command shows or sets data flash or EEPROM backup size in kilobytes,
5414 sets two EEPROM blocks sizes in bytes and enables/disables loading
5415 of EEPROM contents to FlexRAM during reset.
5416
5417 For details see device reference manual, Flash Memory Module,
5418 Program Partition command.
5419
5420 Setting is possible only once after mass_erase.
5421 Reset the device after partition setting.
5422
5423 Show partition size:
5424 @example
5425 kinetis nvm_partition info
5426 @end example
5427
5428 Set 32 KB data flash, rest of FlexNVM is EEPROM backup. EEPROM has two blocks
5429 of 512 and 1536 bytes and its contents is loaded to FlexRAM during reset:
5430 @example
5431 kinetis nvm_partition dataflash 32 512 1536 on
5432 @end example
5433
5434 Set 16 KB EEPROM backup, rest of FlexNVM is a data flash. EEPROM has two blocks
5435 of 1024 bytes and its contents is not loaded to FlexRAM during reset:
5436 @example
5437 kinetis nvm_partition eebkp 16 1024 1024 off
5438 @end example
5439 @end deffn
5440
5441 @deffn Command {kinetis mdm reset}
5442 Issues a reset via the MDM-AP. This causes the MCU to output a low pulse on the
5443 RESET pin, which can be used to reset other hardware on board.
5444 @end deffn
5445
5446 @deffn Command {kinetis disable_wdog}
5447 For Kx devices only (KLx has different COP watchdog, it is not supported).
5448 Command disables watchdog timer.
5449 @end deffn
5450 @end deffn
5451
5452 @deffn {Flash Driver} kinetis_ke
5453 @cindex kinetis_ke
5454 KE0x members of the Kinetis microcontroller family from Freescale include
5455 internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0+. The driver automatically recognizes
5456 the KE0x sub-family using the chip identification register, and
5457 autoconfigures itself.
5458 Use kinetis (not kinetis_ke) driver for KE1x devices.
5459
5460 @example
5461 flash bank $_FLASHNAME kinetis_ke 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5462 @end example
5463
5464 @deffn Command {kinetis_ke mdm check_security}
5465 Checks status of device security lock. Used internally in examine-end event.
5466 @end deffn
5467
5468 @deffn Command {kinetis_ke mdm mass_erase}
5469 Issues a complete Flash erase via the MDM-AP.
5470 This can be used to erase a chip back to its factory state.
5471 Command removes security lock from a device (use of SRST highly recommended).
5472 It does not require the processor to be halted.
5473 @end deffn
5474
5475 @deffn Command {kinetis_ke disable_wdog}
5476 Command disables watchdog timer.
5477 @end deffn
5478 @end deffn
5479
5480 @deffn {Flash Driver} lpc2000
5481 This is the driver to support internal flash of all members of the
5482 LPC11(x)00 and LPC1300 microcontroller families and most members of
5483 the LPC800, LPC1500, LPC1700, LPC1800, LPC2000, LPC4000 and LPC54100
5484 microcontroller families from NXP.
5485
5486 @quotation Note
5487 There are LPC2000 devices which are not supported by the @var{lpc2000}
5488 driver:
5489 The LPC2888 is supported by the @var{lpc288x} driver.
5490 The LPC29xx family is supported by the @var{lpc2900} driver.
5491 @end quotation
5492
5493 The @var{lpc2000} driver defines two mandatory and one optional parameters,
5494 which must appear in the following order:
5495
5496 @itemize
5497 @item @var{variant} ... required, may be
5498 @option{lpc2000_v1} (older LPC21xx and LPC22xx)
5499 @option{lpc2000_v2} (LPC213x, LPC214x, LPC210[123], LPC23xx and LPC24xx)
5500 @option{lpc1700} (LPC175x and LPC176x and LPC177x/8x)
5501 @option{lpc4300} - available also as @option{lpc1800} alias (LPC18x[2357] and
5502 LPC43x[2357])
5503 @option{lpc800} (LPC8xx)
5504 @option{lpc1100} (LPC11(x)xx and LPC13xx)
5505 @option{lpc1500} (LPC15xx)
5506 @option{lpc54100} (LPC541xx)
5507 @option{lpc4000} (LPC40xx)
5508 or @option{auto} - automatically detects flash variant and size for LPC11(x)00,
5509 LPC8xx, LPC13xx, LPC17xx and LPC40xx
5510 @item @var{clock_kHz} ... the frequency, in kiloHertz,
5511 at which the core is running
5512 @item @option{calc_checksum} ... optional (but you probably want to provide this!),
5513 telling the driver to calculate a valid checksum for the exception vector table.
5514 @quotation Note
5515 If you don't provide @option{calc_checksum} when you're writing the vector
5516 table, the boot ROM will almost certainly ignore your flash image.
5517 However, if you do provide it,
5518 with most tool chains @command{verify_image} will fail.
5519 @end quotation
5520 @end itemize
5521
5522 LPC flashes don't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
5523
5524 @example
5525 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2000 0x0 0x7d000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME \
5526 lpc2000_v2 14765 calc_checksum
5527 @end example
5528
5529 @deffn {Command} {lpc2000 part_id} bank
5530 Displays the four byte part identifier associated with
5531 the specified flash @var{bank}.
5532 @end deffn
5533 @end deffn
5534
5535 @deffn {Flash Driver} lpc288x
5536 The LPC2888 microcontroller from NXP needs slightly different flash
5537 support from its lpc2000 siblings.
5538 The @var{lpc288x} driver defines one mandatory parameter,
5539 the programming clock rate in Hz.
5540 LPC flashes don't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
5541
5542 @example
5543 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc288x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 12000000
5544 @end example
5545 @end deffn
5546
5547 @deffn {Flash Driver} lpc2900
5548 This driver supports the LPC29xx ARM968E based microcontroller family
5549 from NXP.
5550
5551 The predefined parameters @var{base}, @var{size}, @var{chip_width} and
5552 @var{bus_width} of the @code{flash bank} command are ignored. Flash size and
5553 sector layout are auto-configured by the driver.
5554 The driver has one additional mandatory parameter: The CPU clock rate
5555 (in kHz) at the time the flash operations will take place. Most of the time this
5556 will not be the crystal frequency, but a higher PLL frequency. The
5557 @code{reset-init} event handler in the board script is usually the place where
5558 you start the PLL.
5559
5560 The driver rejects flashless devices (currently the LPC2930).
5561
5562 The EEPROM in LPC2900 devices is not mapped directly into the address space.
5563 It must be handled much more like NAND flash memory, and will therefore be
5564 handled by a separate @code{lpc2900_eeprom} driver (not yet available).
5565
5566 Sector protection in terms of the LPC2900 is handled transparently. Every time a
5567 sector needs to be erased or programmed, it is automatically unprotected.
5568 What is shown as protection status in the @code{flash info} command, is
5569 actually the LPC2900 @emph{sector security}. This is a mechanism to prevent a
5570 sector from ever being erased or programmed again. As this is an irreversible
5571 mechanism, it is handled by a special command (@code{lpc2900 secure_sector}),
5572 and not by the standard @code{flash protect} command.
5573
5574 Example for a 125 MHz clock frequency:
5575 @example
5576 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2900 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 125000
5577 @end example
5578
5579 Some @code{lpc2900}-specific commands are defined. In the following command list,
5580 the @var{bank} parameter is the bank number as obtained by the
5581 @code{flash banks} command.
5582
5583 @deffn Command {lpc2900 signature} bank
5584 Calculates a 128-bit hash value, the @emph{signature}, from the whole flash
5585 content. This is a hardware feature of the flash block, hence the calculation is
5586 very fast. You may use this to verify the content of a programmed device against
5587 a known signature.
5588 Example:
5589 @example
5590 lpc2900 signature 0
5591 signature: 0x5f40cdc8:0xc64e592e:0x10490f89:0x32a0f317
5592 @end example
5593 @end deffn
5594
5595 @deffn Command {lpc2900 read_custom} bank filename
5596 Reads the 912 bytes of customer information from the flash index sector, and
5597 saves it to a file in binary format.
5598 Example:
5599 @example
5600 lpc2900 read_custom 0 /path_to/customer_info.bin
5601 @end example
5602 @end deffn
5603
5604 The index sector of the flash is a @emph{write-only} sector. It cannot be
5605 erased! In order to guard against unintentional write access, all following
5606 commands need to be preceeded by a successful call to the @code{password}
5607 command:
5608
5609 @deffn Command {lpc2900 password} bank password
5610 You need to use this command right before each of the following commands:
5611 @code{lpc2900 write_custom}, @code{lpc2900 secure_sector},
5612 @code{lpc2900 secure_jtag}.
5613
5614 The password string is fixed to "I_know_what_I_am_doing".
5615 Example:
5616 @example
5617 lpc2900 password 0 I_know_what_I_am_doing
5618 Potentially dangerous operation allowed in next command!
5619 @end example
5620 @end deffn
5621
5622 @deffn Command {lpc2900 write_custom} bank filename type
5623 Writes the content of the file into the customer info space of the flash index
5624 sector. The filetype can be specified with the @var{type} field. Possible values
5625 for @var{type} are: @var{bin} (binary), @var{ihex} (Intel hex format),
5626 @var{elf} (ELF binary) or @var{s19} (Motorola S-records). The file must
5627 contain a single section, and the contained data length must be exactly
5628 912 bytes.
5629 @quotation Attention
5630 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
5631 @end quotation
5632 Example:
5633 @example
5634 lpc2900 write_custom 0 /path_to/customer_info.bin bin
5635 @end example
5636 @end deffn
5637
5638 @deffn Command {lpc2900 secure_sector} bank first last
5639 Secures the sector range from @var{first} to @var{last} (including) against
5640 further program and erase operations. The sector security will be effective
5641 after the next power cycle.
5642 @quotation Attention
5643 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
5644 @end quotation
5645 Secured sectors appear as @emph{protected} in the @code{flash info} command.
5646 Example:
5647 @example
5648 lpc2900 secure_sector 0 1 1
5649 flash info 0
5650 #0 : lpc2900 at 0x20000000, size 0x000c0000, (...)
5651 # 0: 0x00000000 (0x2000 8kB) not protected
5652 # 1: 0x00002000 (0x2000 8kB) protected
5653 # 2: 0x00004000 (0x2000 8kB) not protected
5654 @end example
5655 @end deffn
5656
5657 @deffn Command {lpc2900 secure_jtag} bank
5658 Irreversibly disable the JTAG port. The new JTAG security setting will be
5659 effective after the next power cycle.
5660 @quotation Attention
5661 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
5662 @end quotation
5663 Examples:
5664 @example
5665 lpc2900 secure_jtag 0
5666 @end example
5667 @end deffn
5668 @end deffn
5669
5670 @deffn {Flash Driver} mdr
5671 This drivers handles the integrated NOR flash on Milandr Cortex-M
5672 based controllers. A known limitation is that the Info memory can't be
5673 read or verified as it's not memory mapped.
5674
5675 @example
5676 flash bank <name> mdr <base> <size> \
5677 0 0 <target#> @var{type} @var{page_count} @var{sec_count}
5678 @end example
5679
5680 @itemize @bullet
5681 @item @var{type} - 0 for main memory, 1 for info memory
5682 @item @var{page_count} - total number of pages
5683 @item @var{sec_count} - number of sector per page count
5684 @end itemize
5685
5686 Example usage:
5687 @example
5688 if @{ [info exists IMEMORY] && [string equal $IMEMORY true] @} @{
5689 flash bank $@{_CHIPNAME@}_info.flash mdr 0x00000000 0x01000 \
5690 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 1 1 4
5691 @} else @{
5692 flash bank $_CHIPNAME.flash mdr 0x00000000 0x20000 \
5693 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 0 32 4
5694 @}
5695 @end example
5696 @end deffn
5697
5698 @deffn {Flash Driver} niietcm4
5699 This drivers handles the integrated NOR flash on NIIET Cortex-M4
5700 based controllers. Flash size and sector layout are auto-configured by the driver.
5701 Main flash memory is called "Bootflash" and has main region and info region.
5702 Info region is NOT memory mapped by default,
5703 but it can replace first part of main region if needed.
5704 Full erase, single and block writes are supported for both main and info regions.
5705 There is additional not memory mapped flash called "Userflash", which
5706 also have division into regions: main and info.
5707 Purpose of userflash - to store system and user settings.
5708 Driver has special commands to perform operations with this memmory.
5709
5710 @example
5711 flash bank $_FLASHNAME niietcm4 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5712 @end example
5713
5714 Some niietcm4-specific commands are defined:
5715
5716 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_read_byte} bank ('main'|'info') address
5717 Read byte from main or info userflash region.
5718 @end deffn
5719
5720 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_write_byte} bank ('main'|'info') address value
5721 Write byte to main or info userflash region.
5722 @end deffn
5723
5724 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_full_erase} bank
5725 Erase all userflash including info region.
5726 @end deffn
5727
5728 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_erase} bank ('main'|'info') first_sector last_sector
5729 Erase sectors of main or info userflash region, starting at sector first up to and including last.
5730 @end deffn
5731
5732 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_protect_check} bank ('main'|'info')
5733 Check sectors protect.
5734 @end deffn
5735
5736 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_protect} bank ('main'|'info') first_sector last_sector ('on'|'off')
5737 Protect sectors of main or info userflash region, starting at sector first up to and including last.
5738 @end deffn
5739
5740 @deffn Command {niietcm4 bflash_info_remap} bank ('on'|'off')
5741 Enable remapping bootflash info region to 0x00000000 (or 0x40000000 if external memory boot used).
5742 @end deffn
5743
5744 @deffn Command {niietcm4 extmem_cfg} bank ('gpioa'|'gpiob'|'gpioc'|'gpiod'|'gpioe'|'gpiof'|'gpiog'|'gpioh') pin_num ('func1'|'func3')
5745 Configure external memory interface for boot.
5746 @end deffn
5747
5748 @deffn Command {niietcm4 service_mode_erase} bank
5749 Perform emergency erase of all flash (bootflash and userflash).
5750 @end deffn
5751
5752 @deffn Command {niietcm4 driver_info} bank
5753 Show information about flash driver.
5754 @end deffn
5755
5756 @end deffn
5757
5758 @deffn {Flash Driver} nrf5
5759 All members of the nRF51 microcontroller families from Nordic Semiconductor
5760 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0 core.
5761 Also, the nRF52832 microcontroller from Nordic Semiconductor, which include
5762 internal flash and use an ARM Cortex-M4F core.
5763
5764 @example
5765 flash bank $_FLASHNAME nrf5 0 0x00000000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5766 @end example
5767
5768 Some nrf5-specific commands are defined:
5769
5770 @deffn Command {nrf5 mass_erase}
5771 Erases the contents of the code memory and user information
5772 configuration registers as well. It must be noted that this command
5773 works only for chips that do not have factory pre-programmed region 0
5774 code.
5775 @end deffn
5776
5777 @end deffn
5778
5779 @deffn {Flash Driver} ocl
5780 This driver is an implementation of the ``on chip flash loader''
5781 protocol proposed by Pavel Chromy.
5782
5783 It is a minimalistic command-response protocol intended to be used
5784 over a DCC when communicating with an internal or external flash
5785 loader running from RAM. An example implementation for AT91SAM7x is
5786 available in @file{contrib/loaders/flash/at91sam7x/}.
5787
5788 @example
5789 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ocl 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5790 @end example
5791 @end deffn
5792
5793 @deffn {Flash Driver} pic32mx
5794 The PIC32MX microcontrollers are based on the MIPS 4K cores,
5795 and integrate flash memory.
5796
5797 @example
5798 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pix32mx 0x1fc00000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5799 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pix32mx 0x1d000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5800 @end example
5801
5802 @comment numerous *disabled* commands are defined:
5803 @comment - chip_erase ... pointless given flash_erase_address
5804 @comment - lock, unlock ... pointless given protect on/off (yes?)
5805 @comment - pgm_word ... shouldn't bank be deduced from address??
5806 Some pic32mx-specific commands are defined:
5807 @deffn Command {pic32mx pgm_word} address value bank
5808 Programs the specified 32-bit @var{value} at the given @var{address}
5809 in the specified chip @var{bank}.
5810 @end deffn
5811 @deffn Command {pic32mx unlock} bank
5812 Unlock and erase specified chip @var{bank}.
5813 This will remove any Code Protection.
5814 @end deffn
5815 @end deffn
5816
5817 @deffn {Flash Driver} psoc4
5818 All members of the PSoC 41xx/42xx microcontroller family from Cypress
5819 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0 cores.
5820 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
5821 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
5822
5823 Note: Erased internal flash reads as 00.
5824 System ROM of PSoC 4 does not implement erase of a flash sector.
5825
5826 @example
5827 flash bank $_FLASHNAME psoc4 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5828 @end example
5829
5830 psoc4-specific commands
5831 @deffn Command {psoc4 flash_autoerase} num (on|off)
5832 Enables or disables autoerase mode for a flash bank.
5833
5834 If flash_autoerase is off, use mass_erase before flash programming.
5835 Flash erase command fails if region to erase is not whole flash memory.
5836
5837 If flash_autoerase is on, a sector is both erased and programmed in one
5838 system ROM call. Flash erase command is ignored.
5839 This mode is suitable for gdb load.
5840
5841 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5842 @end deffn
5843
5844 @deffn Command {psoc4 mass_erase} num
5845 Erases the contents of the flash memory, protection and security lock.
5846
5847 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5848 @end deffn
5849 @end deffn
5850
5851 @deffn {Flash Driver} sim3x
5852 All members of the SiM3 microcontroller family from Silicon Laboratories
5853 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores. It supports both JTAG
5854 and SWD interface.
5855 The @var{sim3x} driver tries to probe the device to auto detect the MCU.
5856 If this failes, it will use the @var{size} parameter as the size of flash bank.
5857
5858 @example
5859 flash bank $_FLASHNAME sim3x 0 $_CPUROMSIZE 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5860 @end example
5861
5862 There are 2 commands defined in the @var{sim3x} driver:
5863
5864 @deffn Command {sim3x mass_erase}
5865 Erases the complete flash. This is used to unlock the flash.
5866 And this command is only possible when using the SWD interface.
5867 @end deffn
5868
5869 @deffn Command {sim3x lock}
5870 Lock the flash. To unlock use the @command{sim3x mass_erase} command.
5871 @end deffn
5872 @end deffn
5873
5874 @deffn {Flash Driver} stellaris
5875 All members of the Stellaris LM3Sxxx, LM4x and Tiva C microcontroller
5876 families from Texas Instruments include internal flash. The driver
5877 automatically recognizes a number of these chips using the chip
5878 identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
5879
5880 @example
5881 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stellaris 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5882 @end example
5883
5884 @deffn Command {stellaris recover}
5885 Performs the @emph{Recovering a "Locked" Device} procedure to restore
5886 the flash and its associated nonvolatile registers to their factory
5887 default values (erased). This is the only way to remove flash
5888 protection or re-enable debugging if that capability has been
5889 disabled.
5890
5891 Note that the final "power cycle the chip" step in this procedure
5892 must be performed by hand, since OpenOCD can't do it.
5893 @quotation Warning
5894 if more than one Stellaris chip is connected, the procedure is
5895 applied to all of them.
5896 @end quotation
5897 @end deffn
5898 @end deffn
5899
5900 @deffn {Flash Driver} stm32f1x
5901 All members of the STM32F0, STM32F1 and STM32F3 microcontroller families
5902 from ST Microelectronics include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0/M3/M4 cores.
5903 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
5904 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
5905
5906 @example
5907 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5908 @end example
5909
5910 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
5911 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
5912 the flash driver.
5913
5914 @example
5915 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5916 @end example
5917
5918 If you have a target with dual flash banks then define the second bank
5919 as per the following example.
5920 @example
5921 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0x08080000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5922 @end example
5923
5924 Some stm32f1x-specific commands are defined:
5925
5926 @deffn Command {stm32f1x lock} num
5927 Locks the entire stm32 device.
5928 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5929 @end deffn
5930
5931 @deffn Command {stm32f1x unlock} num
5932 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
5933 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5934 @end deffn
5935
5936 @deffn Command {stm32f1x mass_erase} num
5937 Mass erases the entire stm32f1x device.
5938 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5939 @end deffn
5940
5941 @deffn Command {stm32f1x options_read} num
5942 Read and display the stm32 option bytes written by
5943 the @command{stm32f1x options_write} command.
5944 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5945 @end deffn
5946
5947 @deffn Command {stm32f1x options_write} num (@option{SWWDG}|@option{HWWDG}) (@option{RSTSTNDBY}|@option{NORSTSTNDBY}) (@option{RSTSTOP}|@option{NORSTSTOP})
5948 Writes the stm32 option byte with the specified values.
5949 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5950 @end deffn
5951 @end deffn
5952
5953 @deffn {Flash Driver} stm32f2x
5954 All members of the STM32F2, STM32F4 and STM32F7 microcontroller families from ST Microelectronics
5955 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3/M4/M7 cores.
5956 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
5957 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
5958
5959 @example
5960 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f2x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5961 @end example
5962
5963 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
5964 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
5965 the flash driver.
5966
5967 @example
5968 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f2x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5969 @end example
5970
5971 Some stm32f2x-specific commands are defined:
5972
5973 @deffn Command {stm32f2x lock} num
5974 Locks the entire stm32 device.
5975 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5976 @end deffn
5977
5978 @deffn Command {stm32f2x unlock} num
5979 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
5980 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5981 @end deffn
5982
5983 @deffn Command {stm32f2x mass_erase} num
5984 Mass erases the entire stm32f2x device.
5985 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5986 @end deffn
5987
5988 @deffn Command {stm32f2x options_read} num
5989 Reads and displays user options and (where implemented) boot_addr0, boot_addr1, optcr2.
5990 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5991 @end deffn
5992
5993 @deffn Command {stm32f2x options_write} num user_options boot_addr0 boot_addr1
5994 Writes user options and (where implemented) boot_addr0 and boot_addr1 in raw format.
5995 Warning: The meaning of the various bits depends on the device, always check datasheet!
5996 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{user_options} a
5997 12 bit value, consisting of bits 31-28 and 7-0 of FLASH_OPTCR, @var{boot_addr0} and
5998 @var{boot_addr1} two halfwords (of FLASH_OPTCR1).
5999 @end deffn
6000
6001 @deffn Command {stm32f2x optcr2_write} num optcr2
6002 Writes FLASH_OPTCR2 options. Warning: Clearing PCROPi bits requires a full mass erase!
6003 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{optcr2} a 32-bit word.
6004 @end deffn
6005 @end deffn
6006
6007 @deffn {Flash Driver} stm32h7x
6008 All members of the STM32H7 microcontroller families from ST Microelectronics
6009 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M7 core.
6010 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
6011 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6012
6013 @example
6014 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32h7x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6015 @end example
6016
6017 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
6018 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
6019 the flash driver.
6020
6021 @example
6022 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32h7x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6023 @end example
6024
6025 Some stm32h7x-specific commands are defined:
6026
6027 @deffn Command {stm32h7x lock} num
6028 Locks the entire stm32 device.
6029 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6030 @end deffn
6031
6032 @deffn Command {stm32h7x unlock} num
6033 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
6034 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6035 @end deffn
6036
6037 @deffn Command {stm32h7x mass_erase} num
6038 Mass erases the entire stm32h7x device.
6039 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6040 @end deffn
6041 @end deffn
6042
6043 @deffn {Flash Driver} stm32lx
6044 All members of the STM32L microcontroller families from ST Microelectronics
6045 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 and Cortex-M0+ cores.
6046 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
6047 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6048
6049 @example
6050 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32lx 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6051 @end example
6052
6053 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
6054 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
6055 the flash driver. If you use 0 as the bank base address, it tells the
6056 driver to autodetect the bank location assuming you're configuring the
6057 second bank.
6058
6059 @example
6060 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32lx 0x08000000 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6061 @end example
6062
6063 Some stm32lx-specific commands are defined:
6064
6065 @deffn Command {stm32lx lock} num
6066 Locks the entire stm32 device.
6067 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6068 @end deffn
6069
6070 @deffn Command {stm32lx unlock} num
6071 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
6072 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6073 @end deffn
6074
6075 @deffn Command {stm32lx mass_erase} num
6076 Mass erases the entire stm32lx device (all flash banks and EEPROM
6077 data). This is the only way to unlock a protected flash (unless RDP
6078 Level is 2 which can't be unlocked at all).
6079 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6080 @end deffn
6081 @end deffn
6082
6083 @deffn {Flash Driver} stm32l4x
6084 All members of the STM32L4 microcontroller families from ST Microelectronics
6085 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M4 cores.
6086 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
6087 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6088
6089 @example
6090 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32l4x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6091 @end example
6092
6093 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
6094 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
6095 the flash driver.
6096
6097 @example
6098 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32l4x 0x08000000 0x40000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6099 @end example
6100
6101 Some stm32l4x-specific commands are defined:
6102
6103 @deffn Command {stm32l4x lock} num
6104 Locks the entire stm32 device.
6105 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6106 @end deffn
6107
6108 @deffn Command {stm32l4x unlock} num
6109 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
6110 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6111 @end deffn
6112
6113 @deffn Command {stm32l4x mass_erase} num
6114 Mass erases the entire stm32l4x device.
6115 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6116 @end deffn
6117 @end deffn
6118
6119 @deffn {Flash Driver} str7x
6120 All members of the STR7 microcontroller family from ST Microelectronics
6121 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
6122 The @var{str7x} driver defines one mandatory parameter, @var{variant},
6123 which is either @code{STR71x}, @code{STR73x} or @code{STR75x}.
6124
6125 @example
6126 flash bank $_FLASHNAME str7x \
6127 0x40000000 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME STR71x
6128 @end example
6129
6130 @deffn Command {str7x disable_jtag} bank
6131 Activate the Debug/Readout protection mechanism
6132 for the specified flash bank.
6133 @end deffn
6134 @end deffn
6135
6136 @deffn {Flash Driver} str9x
6137 Most members of the STR9 microcontroller family from ST Microelectronics
6138 include internal flash and use ARM966E cores.
6139 The str9 needs the flash controller to be configured using
6140 the @command{str9x flash_config} command prior to Flash programming.
6141
6142 @example
6143 flash bank $_FLASHNAME str9x 0x40000000 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6144 str9x flash_config 0 4 2 0 0x80000
6145 @end example
6146
6147 @deffn Command {str9x flash_config} num bbsr nbbsr bbadr nbbadr
6148 Configures the str9 flash controller.
6149 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6150
6151 @itemize @bullet
6152 @item @var{bbsr} - Boot Bank Size register
6153 @item @var{nbbsr} - Non Boot Bank Size register
6154 @item @var{bbadr} - Boot Bank Start Address register
6155 @item @var{nbbadr} - Boot Bank Start Address register
6156 @end itemize
6157 @end deffn
6158
6159 @end deffn
6160
6161 @deffn {Flash Driver} str9xpec
6162 @cindex str9xpec
6163
6164 Only use this driver for locking/unlocking the device or configuring the option bytes.
6165 Use the standard str9 driver for programming.
6166 Before using the flash commands the turbo mode must be enabled using the
6167 @command{str9xpec enable_turbo} command.
6168
6169 Here is some background info to help
6170 you better understand how this driver works. OpenOCD has two flash drivers for
6171 the str9:
6172 @enumerate
6173 @item
6174 Standard driver @option{str9x} programmed via the str9 core. Normally used for
6175 flash programming as it is faster than the @option{str9xpec} driver.
6176 @item
6177 Direct programming @option{str9xpec} using the flash controller. This is an
6178 ISC compilant (IEEE 1532) tap connected in series with the str9 core. The str9
6179 core does not need to be running to program using this flash driver. Typical use
6180 for this driver is locking/unlocking the target and programming the option bytes.
6181 @end enumerate
6182
6183 Before we run any commands using the @option{str9xpec} driver we must first disable
6184 the str9 core. This example assumes the @option{str9xpec} driver has been
6185 configured for flash bank 0.
6186 @example
6187 # assert srst, we do not want core running
6188 # while accessing str9xpec flash driver
6189 jtag_reset 0 1
6190 # turn off target polling
6191 poll off
6192 # disable str9 core
6193 str9xpec enable_turbo 0
6194 # read option bytes
6195 str9xpec options_read 0
6196 # re-enable str9 core
6197 str9xpec disable_turbo 0
6198 poll on
6199 reset halt
6200 @end example
6201 The above example will read the str9 option bytes.
6202 When performing a unlock remember that you will not be able to halt the str9 - it
6203 has been locked. Halting the core is not required for the @option{str9xpec} driver
6204 as mentioned above, just issue the commands above manually or from a telnet prompt.
6205
6206 Several str9xpec-specific commands are defined:
6207
6208 @deffn Command {str9xpec disable_turbo} num
6209 Restore the str9 into JTAG chain.
6210 @end deffn
6211
6212 @deffn Command {str9xpec enable_turbo} num
6213 Enable turbo mode, will simply remove the str9 from the chain and talk
6214 directly to the embedded flash controller.
6215 @end deffn
6216
6217 @deffn Command {str9xpec lock} num
6218 Lock str9 device. The str9 will only respond to an unlock command that will
6219 erase the device.
6220 @end deffn
6221
6222 @deffn Command {str9xpec part_id} num
6223 Prints the part identifier for bank @var{num}.
6224 @end deffn
6225
6226 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_cmap} num (@option{bank0}|@option{bank1})
6227 Configure str9 boot bank.
6228 @end deffn
6229
6230 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_lvdsel} num (@option{vdd}|@option{vdd_vddq})
6231 Configure str9 lvd source.
6232 @end deffn
6233
6234 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_lvdthd} num (@option{2.4v}|@option{2.7v})
6235 Configure str9 lvd threshold.
6236 @end deffn
6237
6238 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_lvdwarn} bank (@option{vdd}|@option{vdd_vddq})
6239 Configure str9 lvd reset warning source.
6240 @end deffn
6241
6242 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_read} num
6243 Read str9 option bytes.
6244 @end deffn
6245
6246 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_write} num
6247 Write str9 option bytes.
6248 @end deffn
6249
6250 @deffn Command {str9xpec unlock} num
6251 unlock str9 device.
6252 @end deffn
6253
6254 @end deffn
6255
6256 @deffn {Flash Driver} tms470
6257 Most members of the TMS470 microcontroller family from Texas Instruments
6258 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
6259 This driver doesn't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
6260
6261 Some tms470-specific commands are defined:
6262
6263 @deffn Command {tms470 flash_keyset} key0 key1 key2 key3
6264 Saves programming keys in a register, to enable flash erase and write commands.
6265 @end deffn
6266
6267 @deffn Command {tms470 osc_mhz} clock_mhz
6268 Reports the clock speed, which is used to calculate timings.
6269 @end deffn
6270
6271 @deffn Command {tms470 plldis} (0|1)
6272 Disables (@var{1}) or enables (@var{0}) use of the PLL to speed up
6273 the flash clock.
6274 @end deffn
6275 @end deffn
6276
6277 @deffn {Flash Driver} xmc1xxx
6278 All members of the XMC1xxx microcontroller family from Infineon.
6279 This driver does not require the chip and bus width to be specified.
6280 @end deffn
6281
6282 @deffn {Flash Driver} xmc4xxx
6283 All members of the XMC4xxx microcontroller family from Infineon.
6284 This driver does not require the chip and bus width to be specified.
6285
6286 Some xmc4xxx-specific commands are defined:
6287
6288 @deffn Command {xmc4xxx flash_password} bank_id passwd1 passwd2
6289 Saves flash protection passwords which are used to lock the user flash
6290 @end deffn
6291
6292 @deffn Command {xmc4xxx flash_unprotect} bank_id user_level[0-1]
6293 Removes Flash write protection from the selected user bank
6294 @end deffn
6295
6296 @end deffn
6297
6298 @section NAND Flash Commands
6299 @cindex NAND
6300
6301 Compared to NOR or SPI flash, NAND devices are inexpensive
6302 and high density. Today's NAND chips, and multi-chip modules,
6303 commonly hold multiple GigaBytes of data.
6304
6305 NAND chips consist of a number of ``erase blocks'' of a given
6306 size (such as 128 KBytes), each of which is divided into a
6307 number of pages (of perhaps 512 or 2048 bytes each). Each
6308 page of a NAND flash has an ``out of band'' (OOB) area to hold
6309 Error Correcting Code (ECC) and other metadata, usually 16 bytes
6310 of OOB for every 512 bytes of page data.
6311
6312 One key characteristic of NAND flash is that its error rate
6313 is higher than that of NOR flash. In normal operation, that
6314 ECC is used to correct and detect errors. However, NAND
6315 blocks can also wear out and become unusable; those blocks
6316 are then marked "bad". NAND chips are even shipped from the
6317 manufacturer with a few bad blocks. The highest density chips
6318 use a technology (MLC) that wears out more quickly, so ECC
6319 support is increasingly important as a way to detect blocks
6320 that have begun to fail, and help to preserve data integrity
6321 with techniques such as wear leveling.
6322
6323 Software is used to manage the ECC. Some controllers don't
6324 support ECC directly; in those cases, software ECC is used.
6325 Other controllers speed up the ECC calculations with hardware.
6326 Single-bit error correction hardware is routine. Controllers
6327 geared for newer MLC chips may correct 4 or more errors for
6328 every 512 bytes of data.
6329
6330 You will need to make sure that any data you write using
6331 OpenOCD includes the apppropriate kind of ECC. For example,
6332 that may mean passing the @code{oob_softecc} flag when
6333 writing NAND data, or ensuring that the correct hardware
6334 ECC mode is used.
6335
6336 The basic steps for using NAND devices include:
6337 @enumerate
6338 @item Declare via the command @command{nand device}
6339 @* Do this in a board-specific configuration file,
6340 passing parameters as needed by the controller.
6341 @item Configure each device using @command{nand probe}.
6342 @* Do this only after the associated target is set up,
6343 such as in its reset-init script or in procures defined
6344 to access that device.
6345 @item Operate on the flash via @command{nand subcommand}
6346 @* Often commands to manipulate the flash are typed by a human, or run
6347 via a script in some automated way. Common task include writing a
6348 boot loader, operating system, or other data needed to initialize or
6349 de-brick a board.
6350 @end enumerate
6351
6352 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, the largest NAND
6353 flash fully supported by OpenOCD is 2 GiBytes (16 GiBits).
6354 This is because the variables used to hold offsets and lengths
6355 are only 32 bits wide.
6356 (Larger chips may work in some cases, unless an offset or length
6357 is larger than 0xffffffff, the largest 32-bit unsigned integer.)
6358 Some larger devices will work, since they are actually multi-chip
6359 modules with two smaller chips and individual chipselect lines.
6360
6361 @anchor{nandconfiguration}
6362 @subsection NAND Configuration Commands
6363 @cindex NAND configuration
6364
6365 NAND chips must be declared in configuration scripts,
6366 plus some additional configuration that's done after
6367 OpenOCD has initialized.
6368
6369 @deffn {Config Command} {nand device} name driver target [configparams...]
6370 Declares a NAND device, which can be read and written to
6371 after it has been configured through @command{nand probe}.
6372 In OpenOCD, devices are single chips; this is unlike some
6373 operating systems, which may manage multiple chips as if
6374 they were a single (larger) device.
6375 In some cases, configuring a device will activate extra
6376 commands; see the controller-specific documentation.
6377
6378 @b{NOTE:} This command is not available after OpenOCD
6379 initialization has completed. Use it in board specific
6380 configuration files, not interactively.
6381
6382 @itemize @bullet
6383 @item @var{name} ... may be used to reference the NAND bank
6384 in most other NAND commands. A number is also available.
6385 @item @var{driver} ... identifies the NAND controller driver
6386 associated with the NAND device being declared.
6387 @xref{nanddriverlist,,NAND Driver List}.
6388 @item @var{target} ... names the target used when issuing
6389 commands to the NAND controller.
6390 @comment Actually, it's currently a controller-specific parameter...
6391 @item @var{configparams} ... controllers may support, or require,
6392 additional parameters. See the controller-specific documentation
6393 for more information.
6394 @end itemize
6395 @end deffn
6396
6397 @deffn Command {nand list}
6398 Prints a summary of each device declared
6399 using @command{nand device}, numbered from zero.
6400 Note that un-probed devices show no details.
6401 @example
6402 > nand list
6403 #0: NAND 1GiB 3,3V 8-bit (Micron) pagesize: 2048, buswidth: 8,
6404 blocksize: 131072, blocks: 8192
6405 #1: NAND 1GiB 3,3V 8-bit (Micron) pagesize: 2048, buswidth: 8,
6406 blocksize: 131072, blocks: 8192
6407 >
6408 @end example
6409 @end deffn
6410
6411 @deffn Command {nand probe} num
6412 Probes the specified device to determine key characteristics
6413 like its page and block sizes, and how many blocks it has.
6414 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
6415 You must (successfully) probe a device before you can use
6416 it with most other NAND commands.
6417 @end deffn
6418
6419 @subsection Erasing, Reading, Writing to NAND Flash
6420
6421 @deffn Command {nand dump} num filename offset length [oob_option]
6422 @cindex NAND reading
6423 Reads binary data from the NAND device and writes it to the file,
6424 starting at the specified offset.
6425 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
6426
6427 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
6428 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
6429
6430 The @var{offset} and @var{length} must be exact multiples of the
6431 device's page size. They describe a data region; the OOB data
6432 associated with each such page may also be accessed.
6433
6434 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, no error correction
6435 was done on the data that's read, unless raw access was disabled
6436 and the underlying NAND controller driver had a @code{read_page}
6437 method which handled that error correction.
6438
6439 By default, only page data is saved to the specified file.
6440 Use an @var{oob_option} parameter to save OOB data:
6441 @itemize @bullet
6442 @item no oob_* parameter
6443 @*Output file holds only page data; OOB is discarded.
6444 @item @code{oob_raw}
6445 @*Output file interleaves page data and OOB data;
6446 the file will be longer than "length" by the size of the
6447 spare areas associated with each data page.
6448 Note that this kind of "raw" access is different from
6449 what's implied by @command{nand raw_access}, which just
6450 controls whether a hardware-aware access method is used.
6451 @item @code{oob_only}
6452 @*Output file has only raw OOB data, and will
6453 be smaller than "length" since it will contain only the
6454 spare areas associated with each data page.
6455 @end itemize
6456 @end deffn
6457
6458 @deffn Command {nand erase} num [offset length]
6459 @cindex NAND erasing
6460 @cindex NAND programming
6461 Erases blocks on the specified NAND device, starting at the
6462 specified @var{offset} and continuing for @var{length} bytes.
6463 Both of those values must be exact multiples of the device's
6464 block size, and the region they specify must fit entirely in the chip.
6465 If those parameters are not specified,
6466 the whole NAND chip will be erased.
6467 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
6468
6469 @b{NOTE:} This command will try to erase bad blocks, when told
6470 to do so, which will probably invalidate the manufacturer's bad
6471 block marker.
6472 For the remainder of the current server session, @command{nand info}
6473 will still report that the block ``is'' bad.
6474 @end deffn
6475
6476 @deffn Command {nand write} num filename offset [option...]
6477 @cindex NAND writing
6478 @cindex NAND programming
6479 Writes binary data from the file into the specified NAND device,
6480 starting at the specified offset. Those pages should already
6481 have been erased; you can't change zero bits to one bits.
6482 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
6483
6484 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
6485 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
6486
6487 The @var{offset} must be an exact multiple of the device's page size.
6488 All data in the file will be written, assuming it doesn't run
6489 past the end of the device.
6490 Only full pages are written, and any extra space in the last
6491 page will be filled with 0xff bytes. (That includes OOB data,
6492 if that's being written.)
6493
6494 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, bad blocks are
6495 ignored. That is, this routine will not skip bad blocks,
6496 but will instead try to write them. This can cause problems.
6497
6498 Provide at most one @var{option} parameter. With some
6499 NAND drivers, the meanings of these parameters may change
6500 if @command{nand raw_access} was used to disable hardware ECC.
6501 @itemize @bullet
6502 @item no oob_* parameter
6503 @*File has only page data, which is written.
6504 If raw acccess is in use, the OOB area will not be written.
6505 Otherwise, if the underlying NAND controller driver has
6506 a @code{write_page} routine, that routine may write the OOB
6507 with hardware-computed ECC data.
6508 @item @code{oob_only}
6509 @*File has only raw OOB data, which is written to the OOB area.
6510 Each page's data area stays untouched. @i{This can be a dangerous
6511 option}, since it can invalidate the ECC data.
6512 You may need to force raw access to use this mode.
6513 @item @code{oob_raw}
6514 @*File interleaves data and OOB data, both of which are written
6515 If raw access is enabled, the data is written first, then the
6516 un-altered OOB.
6517 Otherwise, if the underlying NAND controller driver has
6518 a @code{write_page} routine, that routine may modify the OOB
6519 before it's written, to include hardware-computed ECC data.
6520 @item @code{oob_softecc}
6521 @*File has only page data, which is written.
6522 The OOB area is filled with 0xff, except for a standard 1-bit
6523 software ECC code stored in conventional locations.
6524 You might need to force raw access to use this mode, to prevent
6525 the underlying driver from applying hardware ECC.
6526 @item @code{oob_softecc_kw}
6527 @*File has only page data, which is written.
6528 The OOB area is filled with 0xff, except for a 4-bit software ECC
6529 specific to the boot ROM in Marvell Kirkwood SoCs.
6530 You might need to force raw access to use this mode, to prevent
6531 the underlying driver from applying hardware ECC.
6532 @end itemize
6533 @end deffn
6534
6535 @deffn Command {nand verify} num filename offset [option...]
6536 @cindex NAND verification
6537 @cindex NAND programming
6538 Verify the binary data in the file has been programmed to the
6539 specified NAND device, starting at the specified offset.
6540 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
6541
6542 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
6543 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
6544
6545 The @var{offset} must be an exact multiple of the device's page size.
6546 All data in the file will be read and compared to the contents of the
6547 flash, assuming it doesn't run past the end of the device.
6548 As with @command{nand write}, only full pages are verified, so any extra
6549 space in the last page will be filled with 0xff bytes.
6550
6551 The same @var{options} accepted by @command{nand write},
6552 and the file will be processed similarly to produce the buffers that
6553 can be compared against the contents produced from @command{nand dump}.
6554
6555 @b{NOTE:} This will not work when the underlying NAND controller
6556 driver's @code{write_page} routine must update the OOB with a
6557 hardward-computed ECC before the data is written. This limitation may
6558 be removed in a future release.
6559 @end deffn
6560
6561 @subsection Other NAND commands
6562 @cindex NAND other commands
6563
6564 @deffn Command {nand check_bad_blocks} num [offset length]
6565 Checks for manufacturer bad block markers on the specified NAND
6566 device. If no parameters are provided, checks the whole
6567 device; otherwise, starts at the specified @var{offset} and
6568 continues for @var{length} bytes.
6569 Both of those values must be exact multiples of the device's
6570 block size, and the region they specify must fit entirely in the chip.
6571 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
6572
6573 @b{NOTE:} Before using this command you should force raw access
6574 with @command{nand raw_access enable} to ensure that the underlying
6575 driver will not try to apply hardware ECC.
6576 @end deffn
6577
6578 @deffn Command {nand info} num
6579 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
6580 This prints the one-line summary from "nand list", plus for
6581 devices which have been probed this also prints any known
6582 status for each block.
6583 @end deffn
6584
6585 @deffn Command {nand raw_access} num (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
6586 Sets or clears an flag affecting how page I/O is done.
6587 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
6588
6589 This flag is cleared (disabled) by default, but changing that
6590 value won't affect all NAND devices. The key factor is whether
6591 the underlying driver provides @code{read_page} or @code{write_page}
6592 methods. If it doesn't provide those methods, the setting of
6593 this flag is irrelevant; all access is effectively ``raw''.
6594
6595 When those methods exist, they are normally used when reading
6596 data (@command{nand dump} or reading bad block markers) or
6597 writing it (@command{nand write}). However, enabling
6598 raw access (setting the flag) prevents use of those methods,
6599 bypassing hardware ECC logic.
6600 @i{This can be a dangerous option}, since writing blocks
6601 with the wrong ECC data can cause them to be marked as bad.
6602 @end deffn
6603
6604 @anchor{nanddriverlist}
6605 @subsection NAND Driver List
6606 As noted above, the @command{nand device} command allows
6607 driver-specific options and behaviors.
6608 Some controllers also activate controller-specific commands.
6609
6610 @deffn {NAND Driver} at91sam9
6611 This driver handles the NAND controllers found on AT91SAM9 family chips from
6612 Atmel. It takes two extra parameters: address of the NAND chip;
6613 address of the ECC controller.
6614 @example
6615 nand device $NANDFLASH at91sam9 $CHIPNAME 0x40000000 0xfffffe800
6616 @end example
6617 AT91SAM9 chips support single-bit ECC hardware. The @code{write_page} and
6618 @code{read_page} methods are used to utilize the ECC hardware unless they are
6619 disabled by using the @command{nand raw_access} command. There are four
6620 additional commands that are needed to fully configure the AT91SAM9 NAND
6621 controller. Two are optional; most boards use the same wiring for ALE/CLE:
6622 @deffn Command {at91sam9 cle} num addr_line
6623 Configure the address line used for latching commands. The @var{num}
6624 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
6625 @end deffn
6626 @deffn Command {at91sam9 ale} num addr_line
6627 Configure the address line used for latching addresses. The @var{num}
6628 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
6629 @end deffn
6630
6631 For the next two commands, it is assumed that the pins have already been
6632 properly configured for input or output.
6633 @deffn Command {at91sam9 rdy_busy} num pio_base_addr pin
6634 Configure the RDY/nBUSY input from the NAND device. The @var{num}
6635 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}. @var{pio_base_addr}
6636 is the base address of the PIO controller and @var{pin} is the pin number.
6637 @end deffn
6638 @deffn Command {at91sam9 ce} num pio_base_addr pin
6639 Configure the chip enable input to the NAND device. The @var{num}
6640 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}. @var{pio_base_addr}
6641 is the base address of the PIO controller and @var{pin} is the pin number.
6642 @end deffn
6643 @end deffn
6644
6645 @deffn {NAND Driver} davinci
6646 This driver handles the NAND controllers found on DaVinci family
6647 chips from Texas Instruments.
6648 It takes three extra parameters:
6649 address of the NAND chip;
6650 hardware ECC mode to use (@option{hwecc1},
6651 @option{hwecc4}, @option{hwecc4_infix});
6652 address of the AEMIF controller on this processor.
6653 @example
6654 nand device davinci dm355.arm 0x02000000 hwecc4 0x01e10000
6655 @end example
6656 All DaVinci processors support the single-bit ECC hardware,
6657 and newer ones also support the four-bit ECC hardware.
6658 The @code{write_page} and @code{read_page} methods are used
6659 to implement those ECC modes, unless they are disabled using
6660 the @command{nand raw_access} command.
6661 @end deffn
6662
6663 @deffn {NAND Driver} lpc3180
6664 These controllers require an extra @command{nand device}
6665 parameter: the clock rate used by the controller.
6666 @deffn Command {lpc3180 select} num [mlc|slc]
6667 Configures use of the MLC or SLC controller mode.
6668 MLC implies use of hardware ECC.
6669 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
6670 @end deffn
6671
6672 At this writing, this driver includes @code{write_page}
6673 and @code{read_page} methods. Using @command{nand raw_access}
6674 to disable those methods will prevent use of hardware ECC
6675 in the MLC controller mode, but won't change SLC behavior.
6676 @end deffn
6677 @comment current lpc3180 code won't issue 5-byte address cycles
6678
6679 @deffn {NAND Driver} mx3
6680 This driver handles the NAND controller in i.MX31. The mxc driver
6681 should work for this chip aswell.
6682 @end deffn
6683
6684 @deffn {NAND Driver} mxc
6685 This driver handles the NAND controller found in Freescale i.MX
6686 chips. It has support for v1 (i.MX27 and i.MX31) and v2 (i.MX35).
6687 The driver takes 3 extra arguments, chip (@option{mx27},
6688 @option{mx31}, @option{mx35}), ecc (@option{noecc}, @option{hwecc})
6689 and optionally if bad block information should be swapped between
6690 main area and spare area (@option{biswap}), defaults to off.
6691 @example
6692 nand device mx35.nand mxc imx35.cpu mx35 hwecc biswap
6693 @end example
6694 @deffn Command {mxc biswap} bank_num [enable|disable]
6695 Turns on/off bad block information swaping from main area,
6696 without parameter query status.
6697 @end deffn
6698 @end deffn
6699
6700 @deffn {NAND Driver} orion
6701 These controllers require an extra @command{nand device}
6702 parameter: the address of the controller.
6703 @example
6704 nand device orion 0xd8000000
6705 @end example
6706 These controllers don't define any specialized commands.
6707 At this writing, their drivers don't include @code{write_page}
6708 or @code{read_page} methods, so @command{nand raw_access} won't
6709 change any behavior.
6710 @end deffn
6711
6712 @deffn {NAND Driver} s3c2410
6713 @deffnx {NAND Driver} s3c2412
6714 @deffnx {NAND Driver} s3c2440
6715 @deffnx {NAND Driver} s3c2443
6716 @deffnx {NAND Driver} s3c6400
6717 These S3C family controllers don't have any special
6718 @command{nand device} options, and don't define any
6719 specialized commands.
6720 At this writing, their drivers don't include @code{write_page}
6721 or @code{read_page} methods, so @command{nand raw_access} won't
6722 change any behavior.
6723 @end deffn
6724
6725 @section mFlash
6726
6727 @subsection mFlash Configuration
6728 @cindex mFlash Configuration
6729
6730 @deffn {Config Command} {mflash bank} soc base RST_pin target
6731 Configures a mflash for @var{soc} host bank at
6732 address @var{base}.
6733 The pin number format depends on the host GPIO naming convention.
6734 Currently, the mflash driver supports s3c2440 and pxa270.
6735
6736 Example for s3c2440 mflash where @var{RST pin} is GPIO B1:
6737
6738 @example
6739 mflash bank $_FLASHNAME s3c2440 0x10000000 1b 0
6740 @end example
6741
6742 Example for pxa270 mflash where @var{RST pin} is GPIO 43:
6743
6744 @example
6745 mflash bank $_FLASHNAME pxa270 0x08000000 43 0
6746 @end example
6747 @end deffn
6748
6749 @subsection mFlash commands
6750 @cindex mFlash commands
6751
6752 @deffn Command {mflash config pll} frequency
6753 Configure mflash PLL.
6754 The @var{frequency} is the mflash input frequency, in Hz.
6755 Issuing this command will erase mflash's whole internal nand and write new pll.
6756 After this command, mflash needs power-on-reset for normal operation.
6757 If pll was newly configured, storage and boot(optional) info also need to be update.
6758 @end deffn
6759
6760 @deffn Command {mflash config boot}
6761 Configure bootable option.
6762 If bootable option is set, mflash offer the first 8 sectors
6763 (4kB) for boot.
6764 @end deffn
6765
6766 @deffn Command {mflash config storage}
6767 Configure storage information.
6768 For the normal storage operation, this information must be
6769 written.
6770 @end deffn
6771
6772 @deffn Command {mflash dump} num filename offset size
6773 Dump @var{size} bytes, starting at @var{offset} bytes from the
6774 beginning of the bank @var{num}, to the file named @var{filename}.
6775 @end deffn
6776
6777 @deffn Command {mflash probe}
6778 Probe mflash.
6779 @end deffn
6780
6781 @deffn Command {mflash write} num filename offset
6782 Write the binary file @var{filename} to mflash bank @var{num}, starting at
6783 @var{offset} bytes from the beginning of the bank.
6784 @end deffn
6785
6786 @node Flash Programming
6787 @chapter Flash Programming
6788
6789 OpenOCD implements numerous ways to program the target flash, whether internal or external.
6790 Programming can be acheived by either using GDB @ref{programmingusinggdb,,Programming using GDB},
6791 or using the cmds given in @ref{flashprogrammingcommands,,Flash Programming Commands}.
6792
6793 @*To simplify using the flash cmds directly a jimtcl script is available that handles the programming and verify stage.
6794 OpenOCD will program/verify/reset the target and optionally shutdown.
6795
6796 The script is executed as follows and by default the following actions will be peformed.
6797 @enumerate
6798 @item 'init' is executed.
6799 @item 'reset init' is called to reset and halt the target, any 'reset init' scripts are executed.
6800 @item @code{flash write_image} is called to erase and write any flash using the filename given.
6801 @item @code{verify_image} is called if @option{verify} parameter is given.
6802 @item @code{reset run} is called if @option{reset} parameter is given.
6803 @item OpenOCD is shutdown if @option{exit} parameter is given.
6804 @end enumerate
6805
6806 An example of usage is given below. @xref{program}.
6807
6808 @example
6809 # program and verify using elf/hex/s19. verify and reset
6810 # are optional parameters
6811 openocd -f board/stm32f3discovery.cfg \
6812 -c "program filename.elf verify reset exit"
6813
6814 # binary files need the flash address passing
6815 openocd -f board/stm32f3discovery.cfg \
6816 -c "program filename.bin exit 0x08000000"
6817 @end example
6818
6819 @node PLD/FPGA Commands
6820 @chapter PLD/FPGA Commands
6821 @cindex PLD
6822 @cindex FPGA
6823
6824 Programmable Logic Devices (PLDs) and the more flexible
6825 Field Programmable Gate Arrays (FPGAs) are both types of programmable hardware.
6826 OpenOCD can support programming them.
6827 Although PLDs are generally restrictive (cells are less functional, and
6828 there are no special purpose cells for memory or computational tasks),
6829 they share the same OpenOCD infrastructure.
6830 Accordingly, both are called PLDs here.
6831
6832 @section PLD/FPGA Configuration and Commands
6833
6834 As it does for JTAG TAPs, debug targets, and flash chips (both NOR and NAND),
6835 OpenOCD maintains a list of PLDs available for use in various commands.
6836 Also, each such PLD requires a driver.
6837
6838 They are referenced by the number shown by the @command{pld devices} command,
6839 and new PLDs are defined by @command{pld device driver_name}.
6840
6841 @deffn {Config Command} {pld device} driver_name tap_name [driver_options]
6842 Defines a new PLD device, supported by driver @var{driver_name},
6843 using the TAP named @var{tap_name}.
6844 The driver may make use of any @var{driver_options} to configure its
6845 behavior.
6846 @end deffn
6847
6848 @deffn {Command} {pld devices}
6849 Lists the PLDs and their numbers.
6850 @end deffn
6851
6852 @deffn {Command} {pld load} num filename
6853 Loads the file @file{filename} into the PLD identified by @var{num}.
6854 The file format must be inferred by the driver.
6855 @end deffn
6856
6857 @section PLD/FPGA Drivers, Options, and Commands
6858
6859 Drivers may support PLD-specific options to the @command{pld device}
6860 definition command, and may also define commands usable only with
6861 that particular type of PLD.
6862
6863 @deffn {FPGA Driver} virtex2 [no_jstart]
6864 Virtex-II is a family of FPGAs sold by Xilinx.
6865 It supports the IEEE 1532 standard for In-System Configuration (ISC).
6866
6867 If @var{no_jstart} is non-zero, the JSTART instruction is not used after
6868 loading the bitstream. While required for Series2, Series3, and Series6, it
6869 breaks bitstream loading on Series7.
6870
6871 @deffn {Command} {virtex2 read_stat} num
6872 Reads and displays the Virtex-II status register (STAT)
6873 for FPGA @var{num}.
6874 @end deffn
6875 @end deffn
6876
6877 @node General Commands
6878 @chapter General Commands
6879 @cindex commands
6880
6881 The commands documented in this chapter here are common commands that
6882 you, as a human, may want to type and see the output of. Configuration type
6883 commands are documented elsewhere.
6884
6885 Intent:
6886 @itemize @bullet
6887 @item @b{Source Of Commands}
6888 @* OpenOCD commands can occur in a configuration script (discussed
6889 elsewhere) or typed manually by a human or supplied programatically,
6890 or via one of several TCP/IP Ports.
6891
6892 @item @b{From the human}
6893 @* A human should interact with the telnet interface (default port: 4444)
6894 or via GDB (default port 3333).
6895
6896 To issue commands from within a GDB session, use the @option{monitor}
6897 command, e.g. use @option{monitor poll} to issue the @option{poll}
6898 command. All output is relayed through the GDB session.
6899
6900 @item @b{Machine Interface}
6901 The Tcl interface's intent is to be a machine interface. The default Tcl
6902 port is 5555.
6903 @end itemize
6904
6905
6906 @section Server Commands
6907
6908 @deffn {Command} exit
6909 Exits the current telnet session.
6910 @end deffn
6911
6912 @deffn {Command} help [string]
6913 With no parameters, prints help text for all commands.
6914 Otherwise, prints each helptext containing @var{string}.
6915 Not every command provides helptext.
6916
6917 Configuration commands, and commands valid at any time, are
6918 explicitly noted in parenthesis.
6919 In most cases, no such restriction is listed; this indicates commands
6920 which are only available after the configuration stage has completed.
6921 @end deffn
6922
6923 @deffn Command sleep msec [@option{busy}]
6924 Wait for at least @var{msec} milliseconds before resuming.
6925 If @option{busy} is passed, busy-wait instead of sleeping.
6926 (This option is strongly discouraged.)
6927 Useful in connection with script files
6928 (@command{script} command and @command{target_name} configuration).
6929 @end deffn
6930
6931 @deffn Command shutdown [@option{error}]
6932 Close the OpenOCD server, disconnecting all clients (GDB, telnet,
6933 other). If option @option{error} is used, OpenOCD will return a
6934 non-zero exit code to the parent process.
6935 @end deffn
6936
6937 @anchor{debuglevel}
6938 @deffn Command debug_level [n]
6939 @cindex message level
6940 Display debug level.
6941 If @var{n} (from 0..4) is provided, then set it to that level.
6942 This affects the kind of messages sent to the server log.
6943 Level 0 is error messages only;
6944 level 1 adds warnings;
6945 level 2 adds informational messages;
6946 level 3 adds debugging messages;
6947 and level 4 adds verbose low-level debug messages.
6948 The default is level 2, but that can be overridden on
6949 the command line along with the location of that log
6950 file (which is normally the server's standard output).
6951 @xref{Running}.
6952 @end deffn
6953
6954 @deffn Command echo [-n] message
6955 Logs a message at "user" priority.
6956 Output @var{message} to stdout.
6957 Option "-n" suppresses trailing newline.
6958 @example
6959 echo "Downloading kernel -- please wait"
6960 @end example
6961 @end deffn
6962
6963 @deffn Command log_output [filename]
6964 Redirect logging to @var{filename};
6965 the initial log output channel is stderr.
6966 @end deffn
6967
6968 @deffn Command add_script_search_dir [directory]
6969 Add @var{directory} to the file/script search path.
6970 @end deffn
6971
6972 @deffn Command bindto [name]
6973 Specify address by name on which to listen for incoming TCP/IP connections.
6974 By default, OpenOCD will listen on all available interfaces.
6975 @end deffn
6976
6977 @anchor{targetstatehandling}
6978 @section Target State handling
6979 @cindex reset
6980 @cindex halt
6981 @cindex target initialization
6982
6983 In this section ``target'' refers to a CPU configured as
6984 shown earlier (@pxref{CPU Configuration}).
6985 These commands, like many, implicitly refer to
6986 a current target which is used to perform the
6987 various operations. The current target may be changed
6988 by using @command{targets} command with the name of the
6989 target which should become current.
6990
6991 @deffn Command reg [(number|name) [(value|'force')]]
6992 Access a single register by @var{number} or by its @var{name}.
6993 The target must generally be halted before access to CPU core
6994 registers is allowed. Depending on the hardware, some other
6995 registers may be accessible while the target is running.
6996
6997 @emph{With no arguments}:
6998 list all available registers for the current target,
6999 showing number, name, size, value, and cache status.
7000 For valid entries, a value is shown; valid entries
7001 which are also dirty (and will be written back later)
7002 are flagged as such.
7003
7004 @emph{With number/name}: display that register's value.
7005 Use @var{force} argument to read directly from the target,
7006 bypassing any internal cache.
7007
7008 @emph{With both number/name and value}: set register's value.
7009 Writes may be held in a writeback cache internal to OpenOCD,
7010 so that setting the value marks the register as dirty instead
7011 of immediately flushing that value. Resuming CPU execution
7012 (including by single stepping) or otherwise activating the
7013 relevant module will flush such values.
7014
7015 Cores may have surprisingly many registers in their
7016 Debug and trace infrastructure:
7017
7018 @example
7019 > reg
7020 ===== ARM registers
7021 (0) r0 (/32): 0x0000D3C2 (dirty)
7022 (1) r1 (/32): 0xFD61F31C
7023 (2) r2 (/32)
7024 ...
7025 (164) ETM_contextid_comparator_mask (/32)
7026 >
7027 @end example
7028 @end deffn
7029
7030 @deffn Command halt [ms]
7031 @deffnx Command wait_halt [ms]
7032 The @command{halt} command first sends a halt request to the target,
7033 which @command{wait_halt} doesn't.
7034 Otherwise these behave the same: wait up to @var{ms} milliseconds,
7035 or 5 seconds if there is no parameter, for the target to halt
7036 (and enter debug mode).
7037 Using 0 as the @var{ms} parameter prevents OpenOCD from waiting.
7038
7039 @quotation Warning
7040 On ARM cores, software using the @emph{wait for interrupt} operation
7041 often blocks the JTAG access needed by a @command{halt} command.
7042 This is because that operation also puts the core into a low
7043 power mode by gating the core clock;
7044 but the core clock is needed to detect JTAG clock transitions.
7045
7046 One partial workaround uses adaptive clocking: when the core is
7047 interrupted the operation completes, then JTAG clocks are accepted
7048 at least until the interrupt handler completes.
7049 However, this workaround is often unusable since the processor, board,
7050 and JTAG adapter must all support adaptive JTAG clocking.
7051 Also, it can't work until an interrupt is issued.
7052
7053 A more complete workaround is to not use that operation while you
7054 work with a JTAG debugger.
7055 Tasking environments generaly have idle loops where the body is the
7056 @emph{wait for interrupt} operation.
7057 (On older cores, it is a coprocessor action;
7058 newer cores have a @option{wfi} instruction.)
7059 Such loops can just remove that operation, at the cost of higher
7060 power consumption (because the CPU is needlessly clocked).
7061 @end quotation
7062
7063 @end deffn
7064
7065 @deffn Command resume [address]
7066 Resume the target at its current code position,
7067 or the optional @var{address} if it is provided.
7068 OpenOCD will wait 5 seconds for the target to resume.
7069 @end deffn
7070
7071 @deffn Command step [address]
7072 Single-step the target at its current code position,
7073 or the optional @var{address} if it is provided.
7074 @end deffn
7075
7076 @anchor{resetcommand}
7077 @deffn Command reset
7078 @deffnx Command {reset run}
7079 @deffnx Command {reset halt}
7080 @deffnx Command {reset init}
7081 Perform as hard a reset as possible, using SRST if possible.
7082 @emph{All defined targets will be reset, and target
7083 events will fire during the reset sequence.}
7084
7085 The optional parameter specifies what should
7086 happen after the reset.
7087 If there is no parameter, a @command{reset run} is executed.
7088 The other options will not work on all systems.
7089 @xref{Reset Configuration}.
7090
7091 @itemize @minus
7092 @item @b{run} Let the target run
7093 @item @b{halt} Immediately halt the target
7094 @item @b{init} Immediately halt the target, and execute the reset-init script
7095 @end itemize
7096 @end deffn
7097
7098 @deffn Command soft_reset_halt
7099 Requesting target halt and executing a soft reset. This is often used
7100 when a target cannot be reset and halted. The target, after reset is
7101 released begins to execute code. OpenOCD attempts to stop the CPU and
7102 then sets the program counter back to the reset vector. Unfortunately
7103 the code that was executed may have left the hardware in an unknown
7104 state.
7105 @end deffn
7106
7107 @section I/O Utilities
7108
7109 These commands are available when
7110 OpenOCD is built with @option{--enable-ioutil}.
7111 They are mainly useful on embedded targets,
7112 notably the ZY1000.
7113 Hosts with operating systems have complementary tools.
7114
7115 @emph{Note:} there are several more such commands.
7116
7117 @deffn Command append_file filename [string]*
7118 Appends the @var{string} parameters to
7119 the text file @file{filename}.
7120 Each string except the last one is followed by one space.
7121 The last string is followed by a newline.
7122 @end deffn
7123
7124 @deffn Command cat filename
7125 Reads and displays the text file @file{filename}.
7126 @end deffn
7127
7128 @deffn Command cp src_filename dest_filename
7129 Copies contents from the file @file{src_filename}
7130 into @file{dest_filename}.
7131 @end deffn
7132
7133 @deffn Command ip
7134 @emph{No description provided.}
7135 @end deffn
7136
7137 @deffn Command ls
7138 @emph{No description provided.}
7139 @end deffn
7140
7141 @deffn Command mac
7142 @emph{No description provided.}
7143 @end deffn
7144
7145 @deffn Command meminfo
7146 Display available RAM memory on OpenOCD host.
7147 Used in OpenOCD regression testing scripts.
7148 @end deffn
7149
7150 @deffn Command peek
7151 @emph{No description provided.}
7152 @end deffn
7153
7154 @deffn Command poke
7155 @emph{No description provided.}
7156 @end deffn
7157
7158 @deffn Command rm filename
7159 @c "rm" has both normal and Jim-level versions??
7160 Unlinks the file @file{filename}.
7161 @end deffn
7162
7163 @deffn Command trunc filename
7164 Removes all data in the file @file{filename}.
7165 @end deffn
7166
7167 @anchor{memoryaccess}
7168 @section Memory access commands
7169 @cindex memory access
7170
7171 These commands allow accesses of a specific size to the memory
7172 system. Often these are used to configure the current target in some
7173 special way. For example - one may need to write certain values to the
7174 SDRAM controller to enable SDRAM.
7175
7176 @enumerate
7177 @item Use the @command{targets} (plural) command
7178 to change the current target.
7179 @item In system level scripts these commands are deprecated.
7180 Please use their TARGET object siblings to avoid making assumptions
7181 about what TAP is the current target, or about MMU configuration.
7182 @end enumerate
7183
7184 @deffn Command mdw [phys] addr [count]
7185 @deffnx Command mdh [phys] addr [count]
7186 @deffnx Command mdb [phys] addr [count]
7187 Display contents of address @var{addr}, as
7188 32-bit words (@command{mdw}), 16-bit halfwords (@command{mdh}),
7189 or 8-bit bytes (@command{mdb}).
7190 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
7191 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
7192 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
7193 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
7194 If @var{count} is specified, displays that many units.
7195 (If you want to manipulate the data instead of displaying it,
7196 see the @code{mem2array} primitives.)
7197 @end deffn
7198
7199 @deffn Command mww [phys] addr word
7200 @deffnx Command mwh [phys] addr halfword
7201 @deffnx Command mwb [phys] addr byte
7202 Writes the specified @var{word} (32 bits),
7203 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) value,
7204 at the specified address @var{addr}.
7205 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
7206 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
7207 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
7208 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
7209 @end deffn
7210
7211 @anchor{imageaccess}
7212 @section Image loading commands
7213 @cindex image loading
7214 @cindex image dumping
7215
7216 @deffn Command {dump_image} filename address size
7217 Dump @var{size} bytes of target memory starting at @var{address} to the
7218 binary file named @var{filename}.
7219 @end deffn
7220
7221 @deffn Command {fast_load}
7222 Loads an image stored in memory by @command{fast_load_image} to the
7223 current target. Must be preceeded by fast_load_image.
7224 @end deffn
7225
7226 @deffn Command {fast_load_image} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}|@option{s19}]
7227 Normally you should be using @command{load_image} or GDB load. However, for
7228 testing purposes or when I/O overhead is significant(OpenOCD running on an embedded
7229 host), storing the image in memory and uploading the image to the target
7230 can be a way to upload e.g. multiple debug sessions when the binary does not change.
7231 Arguments are the same as @command{load_image}, but the image is stored in OpenOCD host
7232 memory, i.e. does not affect target. This approach is also useful when profiling
7233 target programming performance as I/O and target programming can easily be profiled
7234 separately.
7235 @end deffn
7236
7237 @deffn Command {load_image} filename address [[@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}|@option{s19}] @option{min_addr} @option{max_length}]
7238 Load image from file @var{filename} to target memory offset by @var{address} from its load address.
7239 The file format may optionally be specified
7240 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, @option{elf}, or @option{s19}).
7241 In addition the following arguments may be specifed:
7242 @var{min_addr} - ignore data below @var{min_addr} (this is w.r.t. to the target's load address + @var{address})
7243 @var{max_length} - maximum number of bytes to load.
7244 @example
7245 proc load_image_bin @{fname foffset address length @} @{
7246 # Load data from fname filename at foffset offset to
7247 # target at address. Load at most length bytes.
7248 load_image $fname [expr $address - $foffset] bin \
7249 $address $length
7250 @}
7251 @end example
7252 @end deffn
7253
7254 @deffn Command {test_image} filename [address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]]
7255 Displays image section sizes and addresses
7256 as if @var{filename} were loaded into target memory
7257 starting at @var{address} (defaults to zero).
7258 The file format may optionally be specified
7259 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
7260 @end deffn
7261
7262 @deffn Command {verify_image} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]
7263 Verify @var{filename} against target memory starting at @var{address}.
7264 The file format may optionally be specified
7265 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
7266 This will first attempt a comparison using a CRC checksum, if this fails it will try a binary compare.
7267 @end deffn
7268
7269 @deffn Command {verify_image_checksum} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]
7270 Verify @var{filename} against target memory starting at @var{address}.
7271 The file format may optionally be specified
7272 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
7273 This perform a comparison using a CRC checksum only
7274 @end deffn
7275
7276
7277 @section Breakpoint and Watchpoint commands
7278 @cindex breakpoint
7279 @cindex watchpoint
7280
7281 CPUs often make debug modules accessible through JTAG, with
7282 hardware support for a handful of code breakpoints and data
7283 watchpoints.
7284 In addition, CPUs almost always support software breakpoints.
7285
7286 @deffn Command {bp} [address len [@option{hw}]]
7287 With no parameters, lists all active breakpoints.
7288 Else sets a breakpoint on code execution starting
7289 at @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
7290 This is a software breakpoint, unless @option{hw} is specified
7291 in which case it will be a hardware breakpoint.
7292
7293 (@xref{arm9vectorcatch,,arm9 vector_catch}, or @pxref{xscalevectorcatch,,xscale vector_catch},
7294 for similar mechanisms that do not consume hardware breakpoints.)
7295 @end deffn
7296
7297 @deffn Command {rbp} address
7298 Remove the breakpoint at @var{address}.
7299 @end deffn
7300
7301 @deffn Command {rwp} address
7302 Remove data watchpoint on @var{address}
7303 @end deffn
7304
7305 @deffn Command {wp} [address len [(@option{r}|@option{w}|@option{a}) [value [mask]]]]
7306 With no parameters, lists all active watchpoints.
7307 Else sets a data watchpoint on data from @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
7308 The watch point is an "access" watchpoint unless
7309 the @option{r} or @option{w} parameter is provided,
7310 defining it as respectively a read or write watchpoint.
7311 If a @var{value} is provided, that value is used when determining if
7312 the watchpoint should trigger. The value may be first be masked
7313 using @var{mask} to mark ``don't care'' fields.
7314 @end deffn
7315
7316 @section Misc Commands
7317
7318 @cindex profiling
7319 @deffn Command {profile} seconds filename [start end]
7320 Profiling samples the CPU's program counter as quickly as possible,
7321 which is useful for non-intrusive stochastic profiling.
7322 Saves up to 10000 samples in @file{filename} using ``gmon.out''
7323 format. Optional @option{start} and @option{end} parameters allow to
7324 limit the address range.
7325 @end deffn
7326
7327 @deffn Command {version}
7328 Displays a string identifying the version of this OpenOCD server.
7329 @end deffn
7330
7331 @deffn Command {virt2phys} virtual_address
7332 Requests the current target to map the specified @var{virtual_address}
7333 to its corresponding physical address, and displays the result.
7334 @end deffn
7335
7336 @node Architecture and Core Commands
7337 @chapter Architecture and Core Commands
7338 @cindex Architecture Specific Commands
7339 @cindex Core Specific Commands
7340
7341 Most CPUs have specialized JTAG operations to support debugging.
7342 OpenOCD packages most such operations in its standard command framework.
7343 Some of those operations don't fit well in that framework, so they are
7344 exposed here as architecture or implementation (core) specific commands.
7345
7346 @anchor{armhardwaretracing}
7347 @section ARM Hardware Tracing
7348 @cindex tracing
7349 @cindex ETM
7350 @cindex ETB
7351
7352 CPUs based on ARM cores may include standard tracing interfaces,
7353 based on an ``Embedded Trace Module'' (ETM) which sends voluminous
7354 address and data bus trace records to a ``Trace Port''.
7355
7356 @itemize
7357 @item
7358 Development-oriented boards will sometimes provide a high speed
7359 trace connector for collecting that data, when the particular CPU
7360 supports such an interface.
7361 (The standard connector is a 38-pin Mictor, with both JTAG
7362 and trace port support.)
7363 Those trace connectors are supported by higher end JTAG adapters
7364 and some logic analyzer modules; frequently those modules can
7365 buffer several megabytes of trace data.
7366 Configuring an ETM coupled to such an external trace port belongs
7367 in the board-specific configuration file.
7368 @item
7369 If the CPU doesn't provide an external interface, it probably
7370 has an ``Embedded Trace Buffer'' (ETB) on the chip, which is a
7371 dedicated SRAM. 4KBytes is one common ETB size.
7372 Configuring an ETM coupled only to an ETB belongs in the CPU-specific
7373 (target) configuration file, since it works the same on all boards.
7374 @end itemize
7375
7376 ETM support in OpenOCD doesn't seem to be widely used yet.
7377
7378 @quotation Issues
7379 ETM support may be buggy, and at least some @command{etm config}
7380 parameters should be detected by asking the ETM for them.
7381
7382 ETM trigger events could also implement a kind of complex
7383 hardware breakpoint, much more powerful than the simple
7384 watchpoint hardware exported by EmbeddedICE modules.
7385 @emph{Such breakpoints can be triggered even when using the
7386 dummy trace port driver}.
7387
7388 It seems like a GDB hookup should be possible,
7389 as well as tracing only during specific states
7390 (perhaps @emph{handling IRQ 23} or @emph{calls foo()}).
7391
7392 There should be GUI tools to manipulate saved trace data and help
7393 analyse it in conjunction with the source code.
7394 It's unclear how much of a common interface is shared
7395 with the current XScale trace support, or should be
7396 shared with eventual Nexus-style trace module support.
7397
7398 At this writing (November 2009) only ARM7, ARM9, and ARM11 support
7399 for ETM modules is available. The code should be able to
7400 work with some newer cores; but not all of them support
7401 this original style of JTAG access.
7402 @end quotation
7403
7404 @subsection ETM Configuration
7405 ETM setup is coupled with the trace port driver configuration.
7406
7407 @deffn {Config Command} {etm config} target width mode clocking driver
7408 Declares the ETM associated with @var{target}, and associates it
7409 with a given trace port @var{driver}. @xref{traceportdrivers,,Trace Port Drivers}.
7410
7411 Several of the parameters must reflect the trace port capabilities,
7412 which are a function of silicon capabilties (exposed later
7413 using @command{etm info}) and of what hardware is connected to
7414 that port (such as an external pod, or ETB).
7415 The @var{width} must be either 4, 8, or 16,
7416 except with ETMv3.0 and newer modules which may also
7417 support 1, 2, 24, 32, 48, and 64 bit widths.
7418 (With those versions, @command{etm info} also shows whether
7419 the selected port width and mode are supported.)
7420
7421 The @var{mode} must be @option{normal}, @option{multiplexed},
7422 or @option{demultiplexed}.
7423 The @var{clocking} must be @option{half} or @option{full}.
7424
7425 @quotation Warning
7426 With ETMv3.0 and newer, the bits set with the @var{mode} and
7427 @var{clocking} parameters both control the mode.
7428 This modified mode does not map to the values supported by
7429 previous ETM modules, so this syntax is subject to change.
7430 @end quotation
7431
7432 @quotation Note
7433 You can see the ETM registers using the @command{reg} command.
7434 Not all possible registers are present in every ETM.
7435 Most of the registers are write-only, and are used to configure
7436 what CPU activities are traced.
7437 @end quotation
7438 @end deffn
7439
7440 @deffn Command {etm info}
7441 Displays information about the current target's ETM.
7442 This includes resource counts from the @code{ETM_CONFIG} register,
7443 as well as silicon capabilities (except on rather old modules).
7444 from the @code{ETM_SYS_CONFIG} register.
7445 @end deffn
7446
7447 @deffn Command {etm status}
7448 Displays status of the current target's ETM and trace port driver:
7449 is the ETM idle, or is it collecting data?
7450 Did trace data overflow?
7451 Was it triggered?
7452 @end deffn
7453
7454 @deffn Command {etm tracemode} [type context_id_bits cycle_accurate branch_output]
7455 Displays what data that ETM will collect.
7456 If arguments are provided, first configures that data.
7457 When the configuration changes, tracing is stopped
7458 and any buffered trace data is invalidated.
7459
7460 @itemize
7461 @item @var{type} ... describing how data accesses are traced,
7462 when they pass any ViewData filtering that that was set up.
7463 The value is one of
7464 @option{none} (save nothing),
7465 @option{data} (save data),
7466 @option{address} (save addresses),
7467 @option{all} (save data and addresses)
7468 @item @var{context_id_bits} ... 0, 8, 16, or 32
7469 @item @var{cycle_accurate} ... @option{enable} or @option{disable}
7470 cycle-accurate instruction tracing.
7471 Before ETMv3, enabling this causes much extra data to be recorded.
7472 @item @var{branch_output} ... @option{enable} or @option{disable}.
7473 Disable this unless you need to try reconstructing the instruction
7474 trace stream without an image of the code.
7475 @end itemize
7476 @end deffn
7477
7478 @deffn Command {etm trigger_debug} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
7479 Displays whether ETM triggering debug entry (like a breakpoint) is
7480 enabled or disabled, after optionally modifying that configuration.
7481 The default behaviour is @option{disable}.
7482 Any change takes effect after the next @command{etm start}.
7483
7484 By using script commands to configure ETM registers, you can make the
7485 processor enter debug state automatically when certain conditions,
7486 more complex than supported by the breakpoint hardware, happen.
7487 @end deffn
7488
7489 @subsection ETM Trace Operation
7490
7491 After setting up the ETM, you can use it to collect data.
7492 That data can be exported to files for later analysis.
7493 It can also be parsed with OpenOCD, for basic sanity checking.
7494
7495 To configure what is being traced, you will need to write
7496 various trace registers using @command{reg ETM_*} commands.
7497 For the definitions of these registers, read ARM publication
7498 @emph{IHI 0014, ``Embedded Trace Macrocell, Architecture Specification''}.
7499 Be aware that most of the relevant registers are write-only,
7500 and that ETM resources are limited. There are only a handful
7501 of address comparators, data comparators, counters, and so on.
7502
7503 Examples of scenarios you might arrange to trace include:
7504
7505 @itemize
7506 @item Code flow within a function, @emph{excluding} subroutines
7507 it calls. Use address range comparators to enable tracing
7508 for instruction access within that function's body.
7509 @item Code flow within a function, @emph{including} subroutines
7510 it calls. Use the sequencer and address comparators to activate
7511 tracing on an ``entered function'' state, then deactivate it by
7512 exiting that state when the function's exit code is invoked.
7513 @item Code flow starting at the fifth invocation of a function,
7514 combining one of the above models with a counter.
7515 @item CPU data accesses to the registers for a particular device,
7516 using address range comparators and the ViewData logic.
7517 @item Such data accesses only during IRQ handling, combining the above
7518 model with sequencer triggers which on entry and exit to the IRQ handler.
7519 @item @emph{... more}
7520 @end itemize
7521
7522 At this writing, September 2009, there are no Tcl utility
7523 procedures to help set up any common tracing scenarios.
7524
7525 @deffn Command {etm analyze}
7526 Reads trace data into memory, if it wasn't already present.
7527 Decodes and prints the data that was collected.
7528 @end deffn
7529
7530 @deffn Command {etm dump} filename
7531 Stores the captured trace data in @file{filename}.
7532 @end deffn
7533
7534 @deffn Command {etm image} filename [base_address] [type]
7535 Opens an image file.
7536 @end deffn
7537
7538 @deffn Command {etm load} filename
7539 Loads captured trace data from @file{filename}.
7540 @end deffn
7541
7542 @deffn Command {etm start}
7543 Starts trace data collection.
7544 @end deffn
7545
7546 @deffn Command {etm stop}
7547 Stops trace data collection.
7548 @end deffn
7549
7550 @anchor{traceportdrivers}
7551 @subsection Trace Port Drivers
7552
7553 To use an ETM trace port it must be associated with a driver.
7554
7555 @deffn {Trace Port Driver} dummy
7556 Use the @option{dummy} driver if you are configuring an ETM that's
7557 not connected to anything (on-chip ETB or off-chip trace connector).
7558 @emph{This driver lets OpenOCD talk to the ETM, but it does not expose
7559 any trace data collection.}
7560 @deffn {Config Command} {etm_dummy config} target
7561 Associates the ETM for @var{target} with a dummy driver.
7562 @end deffn
7563 @end deffn
7564
7565 @deffn {Trace Port Driver} etb
7566 Use the @option{etb} driver if you are configuring an ETM
7567 to use on-chip ETB memory.
7568 @deffn {Config Command} {etb config} target etb_tap
7569 Associates the ETM for @var{target} with the ETB at @var{etb_tap}.
7570 You can see the ETB registers using the @command{reg} command.
7571 @end deffn
7572 @deffn Command {etb trigger_percent} [percent]
7573 This displays, or optionally changes, ETB behavior after the
7574 ETM's configured @emph{trigger} event fires.
7575 It controls how much more trace data is saved after the (single)
7576 trace trigger becomes active.
7577
7578 @itemize
7579 @item The default corresponds to @emph{trace around} usage,
7580 recording 50 percent data before the event and the rest
7581 afterwards.
7582 @item The minimum value of @var{percent} is 2 percent,
7583 recording almost exclusively data before the trigger.
7584 Such extreme @emph{trace before} usage can help figure out
7585 what caused that event to happen.
7586 @item The maximum value of @var{percent} is 100 percent,
7587 recording data almost exclusively after the event.
7588 This extreme @emph{trace after} usage might help sort out
7589 how the event caused trouble.
7590 @end itemize
7591 @c REVISIT allow "break" too -- enter debug mode.
7592 @end deffn
7593
7594 @end deffn
7595
7596 @deffn {Trace Port Driver} oocd_trace
7597 This driver isn't available unless OpenOCD was explicitly configured
7598 with the @option{--enable-oocd_trace} option. You probably don't want
7599 to configure it unless you've built the appropriate prototype hardware;
7600 it's @emph{proof-of-concept} software.
7601
7602 Use the @option{oocd_trace} driver if you are configuring an ETM that's
7603 connected to an off-chip trace connector.
7604
7605 @deffn {Config Command} {oocd_trace config} target tty
7606 Associates the ETM for @var{target} with a trace driver which
7607 collects data through the serial port @var{tty}.
7608 @end deffn
7609
7610 @deffn Command {oocd_trace resync}
7611 Re-synchronizes with the capture clock.
7612 @end deffn
7613
7614 @deffn Command {oocd_trace status}
7615 Reports whether the capture clock is locked or not.
7616 @end deffn
7617 @end deffn
7618
7619
7620 @section Generic ARM
7621 @cindex ARM
7622
7623 These commands should be available on all ARM processors.
7624 They are available in addition to other core-specific
7625 commands that may be available.
7626
7627 @deffn Command {arm core_state} [@option{arm}|@option{thumb}]
7628 Displays the core_state, optionally changing it to process
7629 either @option{arm} or @option{thumb} instructions.
7630 The target may later be resumed in the currently set core_state.
7631 (Processors may also support the Jazelle state, but
7632 that is not currently supported in OpenOCD.)
7633 @end deffn
7634
7635 @deffn Command {arm disassemble} address [count [@option{thumb}]]
7636 @cindex disassemble
7637 Disassembles @var{count} instructions starting at @var{address}.
7638 If @var{count} is not specified, a single instruction is disassembled.
7639 If @option{thumb} is specified, or the low bit of the address is set,
7640 Thumb2 (mixed 16/32-bit) instructions are used;
7641 else ARM (32-bit) instructions are used.
7642 (Processors may also support the Jazelle state, but
7643 those instructions are not currently understood by OpenOCD.)
7644
7645 Note that all Thumb instructions are Thumb2 instructions,
7646 so older processors (without Thumb2 support) will still
7647 see correct disassembly of Thumb code.
7648 Also, ThumbEE opcodes are the same as Thumb2,
7649 with a handful of exceptions.
7650 ThumbEE disassembly currently has no explicit support.
7651 @end deffn
7652
7653 @deffn Command {arm mcr} pX op1 CRn CRm op2 value
7654 Write @var{value} to a coprocessor @var{pX} register
7655 passing parameters @var{CRn},
7656 @var{CRm}, opcodes @var{opc1} and @var{opc2},
7657 and using the MCR instruction.
7658 (Parameter sequence matches the ARM instruction, but omits
7659 an ARM register.)
7660 @end deffn
7661
7662 @deffn Command {arm mrc} pX coproc op1 CRn CRm op2
7663 Read a coprocessor @var{pX} register passing parameters @var{CRn},
7664 @var{CRm}, opcodes @var{opc1} and @var{opc2},
7665 and the MRC instruction.
7666 Returns the result so it can be manipulated by Jim scripts.
7667 (Parameter sequence matches the ARM instruction, but omits
7668 an ARM register.)
7669 @end deffn
7670
7671 @deffn Command {arm reg}
7672 Display a table of all banked core registers, fetching the current value from every
7673 core mode if necessary.
7674 @end deffn
7675
7676 @deffn Command {arm semihosting} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
7677 @cindex ARM semihosting
7678 Display status of semihosting, after optionally changing that status.
7679
7680 Semihosting allows for code executing on an ARM target to use the
7681 I/O facilities on the host computer i.e. the system where OpenOCD
7682 is running. The target application must be linked against a library
7683 implementing the ARM semihosting convention that forwards operation
7684 requests by using a special SVC instruction that is trapped at the
7685 Supervisor Call vector by OpenOCD.
7686 @end deffn
7687
7688 @deffn Command {arm semihosting_cmdline} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
7689 @cindex ARM semihosting
7690 Set the command line to be passed to the debuggee.
7691
7692 @example
7693 arm semihosting_cmdline argv0 argv1 argv2 ...
7694 @end example
7695
7696 This option lets one set the command line arguments to be passed to
7697 the program. The first argument (argv0) is the program name in a
7698 standard C environment (argv[0]). Depending on the program (not much
7699 programs look at argv[0]), argv0 is ignored and can be any string.
7700 @end deffn
7701
7702 @deffn Command {arm semihosting_fileio} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
7703 @cindex ARM semihosting
7704 Display status of semihosting fileio, after optionally changing that
7705 status.
7706
7707 Enabling this option forwards semihosting I/O to GDB process using the
7708 File-I/O remote protocol extension. This is especially useful for
7709 interacting with remote files or displaying console messages in the
7710 debugger.
7711 @end deffn
7712
7713 @section ARMv4 and ARMv5 Architecture
7714 @cindex ARMv4
7715 @cindex ARMv5
7716
7717 The ARMv4 and ARMv5 architectures are widely used in embedded systems,
7718 and introduced core parts of the instruction set in use today.
7719 That includes the Thumb instruction set, introduced in the ARMv4T
7720 variant.
7721
7722 @subsection ARM7 and ARM9 specific commands
7723 @cindex ARM7
7724 @cindex ARM9
7725
7726 These commands are specific to ARM7 and ARM9 cores, like ARM7TDMI, ARM720T,
7727 ARM9TDMI, ARM920T or ARM926EJ-S.
7728 They are available in addition to the ARM commands,
7729 and any other core-specific commands that may be available.
7730
7731 @deffn Command {arm7_9 dbgrq} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
7732 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of the
7733 the EmbeddedIce DBGRQ signal to force entry into debug mode,
7734 instead of breakpoints.
7735 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
7736
7737 This should be
7738 safe for all but ARM7TDMI-S cores (like NXP LPC).
7739 This feature is enabled by default on most ARM9 cores,
7740 including ARM9TDMI, ARM920T, and ARM926EJ-S.
7741 @end deffn
7742
7743 @deffn Command {arm7_9 dcc_downloads} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
7744 @cindex DCC
7745 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of the debug communications
7746 channel (DCC) to write larger (>128 byte) amounts of memory.
7747 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
7748
7749 DCC downloads offer a huge speed increase, but might be
7750 unsafe, especially with targets running at very low speeds. This command was introduced
7751 with OpenOCD rev. 60, and requires a few bytes of working area.
7752 @end deffn
7753
7754 @deffn Command {arm7_9 fast_memory_access} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
7755 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of memory writes and reads
7756 that don't check completion of the operation.
7757 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
7758
7759 This provides a huge speed increase, especially with USB JTAG
7760 cables (FT2232), but might be unsafe if used with targets running at very low
7761 speeds, like the 32kHz startup clock of an AT91RM9200.
7762 @end deffn
7763
7764 @subsection ARM720T specific commands
7765 @cindex ARM720T
7766
7767 These commands are available to ARM720T based CPUs,
7768 which are implementations of the ARMv4T architecture
7769 based on the ARM7TDMI-S integer core.
7770 They are available in addition to the ARM and ARM7/ARM9 commands.
7771
7772 @deffn Command {arm720t cp15} opcode [value]
7773 @emph{DEPRECATED -- avoid using this.
7774 Use the @command{arm mrc} or @command{arm mcr} commands instead.}
7775
7776 Display cp15 register returned by the ARM instruction @var{opcode};
7777 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
7778 The @var{opcode} should be the value of either an MRC or MCR instruction.
7779 @end deffn
7780
7781 @subsection ARM9 specific commands
7782 @cindex ARM9
7783
7784 ARM9-family cores are built around ARM9TDMI or ARM9E (including ARM9EJS)
7785 integer processors.
7786 Such cores include the ARM920T, ARM926EJ-S, and ARM966.
7787
7788 @c 9-june-2009: tried this on arm920t, it didn't work.
7789 @c no-params always lists nothing caught, and that's how it acts.
7790 @c 23-oct-2009: doesn't work _consistently_ ... as if the ICE
7791 @c versions have different rules about when they commit writes.
7792
7793 @anchor{arm9vectorcatch}
7794 @deffn Command {arm9 vector_catch} [@option{all}|@option{none}|list]
7795 @cindex vector_catch
7796 Vector Catch hardware provides a sort of dedicated breakpoint
7797 for hardware events such as reset, interrupt, and abort.
7798 You can use this to conserve normal breakpoint resources,
7799 so long as you're not concerned with code that branches directly
7800 to those hardware vectors.
7801
7802 This always finishes by listing the current configuration.
7803 If parameters are provided, it first reconfigures the
7804 vector catch hardware to intercept
7805 @option{all} of the hardware vectors,
7806 @option{none} of them,
7807 or a list with one or more of the following:
7808 @option{reset} @option{undef} @option{swi} @option{pabt} @option{dabt}
7809 @option{irq} @option{fiq}.
7810 @end deffn
7811
7812 @subsection ARM920T specific commands
7813 @cindex ARM920T
7814
7815 These commands are available to ARM920T based CPUs,
7816 which are implementations of the ARMv4T architecture
7817 built using the ARM9TDMI integer core.
7818 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
7819 and ARM9 commands.
7820
7821 @deffn Command {arm920t cache_info}
7822 Print information about the caches found. This allows to see whether your target
7823 is an ARM920T (2x16kByte cache) or ARM922T (2x8kByte cache).
7824 @end deffn
7825
7826 @deffn Command {arm920t cp15} regnum [value]
7827 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
7828 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
7829 This uses "physical access" and the register number is as
7830 shown in bits 38..33 of table 9-9 in the ARM920T TRM.
7831 (Not all registers can be written.)
7832 @end deffn
7833
7834 @deffn Command {arm920t cp15i} opcode [value [address]]
7835 @emph{DEPRECATED -- avoid using this.
7836 Use the @command{arm mrc} or @command{arm mcr} commands instead.}
7837
7838 Interpreted access using ARM instruction @var{opcode}, which should
7839 be the value of either an MRC or MCR instruction
7840 (as shown tables 9-11, 9-12, and 9-13 in the ARM920T TRM).
7841 If no @var{value} is provided, the result is displayed.
7842 Else if that value is written using the specified @var{address},
7843 or using zero if no other address is provided.
7844 @end deffn
7845
7846 @deffn Command {arm920t read_cache} filename
7847 Dump the content of ICache and DCache to a file named @file{filename}.
7848 @end deffn
7849
7850 @deffn Command {arm920t read_mmu} filename
7851 Dump the content of the ITLB and DTLB to a file named @file{filename}.
7852 @end deffn
7853
7854 @subsection ARM926ej-s specific commands
7855 @cindex ARM926ej-s
7856
7857 These commands are available to ARM926ej-s based CPUs,
7858 which are implementations of the ARMv5TEJ architecture
7859 based on the ARM9EJ-S integer core.
7860 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
7861 and ARM9 commands.
7862
7863 The Feroceon cores also support these commands, although
7864 they are not built from ARM926ej-s designs.
7865
7866 @deffn Command {arm926ejs cache_info}
7867 Print information about the caches found.
7868 @end deffn
7869
7870 @subsection ARM966E specific commands
7871 @cindex ARM966E
7872
7873 These commands are available to ARM966 based CPUs,
7874 which are implementations of the ARMv5TE architecture.
7875 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
7876 and ARM9 commands.
7877
7878 @deffn Command {arm966e cp15} regnum [value]
7879 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
7880 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
7881 The six bit @var{regnum} values are bits 37..32 from table 7-2 of the
7882 ARM966E-S TRM.
7883 There is no current control over bits 31..30 from that table,
7884 as required for BIST support.
7885 @end deffn
7886
7887 @subsection XScale specific commands
7888 @cindex XScale
7889
7890 Some notes about the debug implementation on the XScale CPUs:
7891
7892 The XScale CPU provides a special debug-only mini-instruction cache
7893 (mini-IC) in which exception vectors and target-resident debug handler
7894 code are placed by OpenOCD. In order to get access to the CPU, OpenOCD
7895 must point vector 0 (the reset vector) to the entry of the debug
7896 handler. However, this means that the complete first cacheline in the
7897 mini-IC is marked valid, which makes the CPU fetch all exception
7898 handlers from the mini-IC, ignoring the code in RAM.
7899
7900 To address this situation, OpenOCD provides the @code{xscale
7901 vector_table} command, which allows the user to explicity write
7902 individual entries to either the high or low vector table stored in
7903 the mini-IC.
7904
7905 It is recommended to place a pc-relative indirect branch in the vector
7906 table, and put the branch destination somewhere in memory. Doing so
7907 makes sure the code in the vector table stays constant regardless of
7908 code layout in memory:
7909 @example
7910 _vectors:
7911 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
7912 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
7913 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
7914 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
7915 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
7916 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
7917 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
7918 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
7919 .org 0x100
7920 .long real_reset_vector
7921 .long real_ui_handler
7922 .long real_swi_handler
7923 .long real_pf_abort
7924 .long real_data_abort
7925 .long 0 /* unused */
7926 .long real_irq_handler
7927 .long real_fiq_handler
7928 @end example
7929
7930 Alternatively, you may choose to keep some or all of the mini-IC
7931 vector table entries synced with those written to memory by your
7932 system software. The mini-IC can not be modified while the processor
7933 is executing, but for each vector table entry not previously defined
7934 using the @code{xscale vector_table} command, OpenOCD will copy the
7935 value from memory to the mini-IC every time execution resumes from a
7936 halt. This is done for both high and low vector tables (although the
7937 table not in use may not be mapped to valid memory, and in this case
7938 that copy operation will silently fail). This means that you will
7939 need to briefly halt execution at some strategic point during system
7940 start-up; e.g., after the software has initialized the vector table,
7941 but before exceptions are enabled. A breakpoint can be used to
7942 accomplish this once the appropriate location in the start-up code has
7943 been identified. A watchpoint over the vector table region is helpful
7944 in finding the location if you're not sure. Note that the same
7945 situation exists any time the vector table is modified by the system
7946 software.
7947
7948 The debug handler must be placed somewhere in the address space using
7949 the @code{xscale debug_handler} command. The allowed locations for the
7950 debug handler are either (0x800 - 0x1fef800) or (0xfe000800 -
7951 0xfffff800). The default value is 0xfe000800.
7952
7953 XScale has resources to support two hardware breakpoints and two
7954 watchpoints. However, the following restrictions on watchpoint
7955 functionality apply: (1) the value and mask arguments to the @code{wp}
7956 command are not supported, (2) the watchpoint length must be a
7957 power of two and not less than four, and can not be greater than the
7958 watchpoint address, and (3) a watchpoint with a length greater than
7959 four consumes all the watchpoint hardware resources. This means that
7960 at any one time, you can have enabled either two watchpoints with a
7961 length of four, or one watchpoint with a length greater than four.
7962
7963 These commands are available to XScale based CPUs,
7964 which are implementations of the ARMv5TE architecture.
7965
7966 @deffn Command {xscale analyze_trace}
7967 Displays the contents of the trace buffer.
7968 @end deffn
7969
7970 @deffn Command {xscale cache_clean_address} address
7971 Changes the address used when cleaning the data cache.
7972 @end deffn
7973
7974 @deffn Command {xscale cache_info}
7975 Displays information about the CPU caches.
7976 @end deffn
7977
7978 @deffn Command {xscale cp15} regnum [value]
7979 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
7980 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
7981 @end deffn
7982
7983 @deffn Command {xscale debug_handler} target address
7984 Changes the address used for the specified target's debug handler.
7985 @end deffn
7986
7987 @deffn Command {xscale dcache} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
7988 Enables or disable the CPU's data cache.
7989 @end deffn
7990
7991 @deffn Command {xscale dump_trace} filename
7992 Dumps the raw contents of the trace buffer to @file{filename}.
7993 @end deffn
7994
7995 @deffn Command {xscale icache} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
7996 Enables or disable the CPU's instruction cache.
7997 @end deffn
7998
7999 @deffn Command {xscale mmu} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8000 Enables or disable the CPU's memory management unit.
8001 @end deffn
8002
8003 @deffn Command {xscale trace_buffer} [@option{enable}|@option{disable} [@option{fill} [n] | @option{wrap}]]
8004 Displays the trace buffer status, after optionally
8005 enabling or disabling the trace buffer
8006 and modifying how it is emptied.
8007 @end deffn
8008
8009 @deffn Command {xscale trace_image} filename [offset [type]]
8010 Opens a trace image from @file{filename}, optionally rebasing
8011 its segment addresses by @var{offset}.
8012 The image @var{type} may be one of
8013 @option{bin} (binary), @option{ihex} (Intel hex),
8014 @option{elf} (ELF file), @option{s19} (Motorola s19),
8015 @option{mem}, or @option{builder}.
8016 @end deffn
8017
8018 @anchor{xscalevectorcatch}
8019 @deffn Command {xscale vector_catch} [mask]
8020 @cindex vector_catch
8021 Display a bitmask showing the hardware vectors to catch.
8022 If the optional parameter is provided, first set the bitmask to that value.
8023
8024 The mask bits correspond with bit 16..23 in the DCSR:
8025 @example
8026 0x01 Trap Reset
8027 0x02 Trap Undefined Instructions
8028 0x04 Trap Software Interrupt
8029 0x08 Trap Prefetch Abort
8030 0x10 Trap Data Abort
8031 0x20 reserved
8032 0x40 Trap IRQ
8033 0x80 Trap FIQ
8034 @end example
8035 @end deffn
8036
8037 @deffn Command {xscale vector_table} [(@option{low}|@option{high}) index value]
8038 @cindex vector_table
8039
8040 Set an entry in the mini-IC vector table. There are two tables: one for
8041 low vectors (at 0x00000000), and one for high vectors (0xFFFF0000), each
8042 holding the 8 exception vectors. @var{index} can be 1-7, because vector 0
8043 points to the debug handler entry and can not be overwritten.
8044 @var{value} holds the 32-bit opcode that is placed in the mini-IC.
8045
8046 Without arguments, the current settings are displayed.
8047
8048 @end deffn
8049
8050 @section ARMv6 Architecture
8051 @cindex ARMv6
8052
8053 @subsection ARM11 specific commands
8054 @cindex ARM11
8055
8056 @deffn Command {arm11 memwrite burst} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8057 Displays the value of the memwrite burst-enable flag,
8058 which is enabled by default.
8059 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
8060 Burst writes are only used for memory writes larger than 1 word.
8061 They improve performance by assuming that the CPU has read each data
8062 word over JTAG and completed its write before the next word arrives,
8063 instead of polling for a status flag to verify that completion.
8064 This is usually safe, because JTAG runs much slower than the CPU.
8065 @end deffn
8066
8067 @deffn Command {arm11 memwrite error_fatal} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8068 Displays the value of the memwrite error_fatal flag,
8069 which is enabled by default.
8070 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
8071 When set, certain memory write errors cause earlier transfer termination.
8072 @end deffn
8073
8074 @deffn Command {arm11 step_irq_enable} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8075 Displays the value of the flag controlling whether
8076 IRQs are enabled during single stepping;
8077 they are disabled by default.
8078 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that.
8079 @end deffn
8080
8081 @deffn Command {arm11 vcr} [value]
8082 @cindex vector_catch
8083 Displays the value of the @emph{Vector Catch Register (VCR)},
8084 coprocessor 14 register 7.
8085 If @var{value} is defined, first assigns that.
8086
8087 Vector Catch hardware provides dedicated breakpoints
8088 for certain hardware events.
8089 The specific bit values are core-specific (as in fact is using
8090 coprocessor 14 register 7 itself) but all current ARM11
8091 cores @emph{except the ARM1176} use the same six bits.
8092 @end deffn
8093
8094 @section ARMv7 and ARMv8 Architecture
8095 @cindex ARMv7
8096 @cindex ARMv8
8097
8098 @subsection ARMv7 and ARMv8 Debug Access Port (DAP) specific commands
8099 @cindex Debug Access Port
8100 @cindex DAP
8101 These commands are specific to ARM architecture v7 and v8 Debug Access Port (DAP),
8102 included on Cortex-M and Cortex-A systems.
8103 They are available in addition to other core-specific commands that may be available.
8104
8105 @deffn Command {dap apid} [num]
8106 Displays ID register from AP @var{num},
8107 defaulting to the currently selected AP.
8108 @end deffn
8109
8110 @deffn Command {dap apreg} ap_num reg [value]
8111 Displays content of a register @var{reg} from AP @var{ap_num}
8112 or set a new value @var{value}.
8113 @var{reg} is byte address of a word register, 0, 4, 8 ... 0xfc.
8114 @end deffn
8115
8116 @deffn Command {dap apsel} [num]
8117 Select AP @var{num}, defaulting to 0.
8118 @end deffn
8119
8120 @deffn Command {dap baseaddr} [num]
8121 Displays debug base address from MEM-AP @var{num},
8122 defaulting to the currently selected AP.
8123 @end deffn
8124
8125 @deffn Command {dap info} [num]
8126 Displays the ROM table for MEM-AP @var{num},
8127 defaulting to the currently selected AP.
8128 @end deffn
8129
8130 @deffn Command {dap memaccess} [value]
8131 Displays the number of extra tck cycles in the JTAG idle to use for MEM-AP
8132 memory bus access [0-255], giving additional time to respond to reads.
8133 If @var{value} is defined, first assigns that.
8134 @end deffn
8135
8136 @deffn Command {dap apcsw} [0 / 1]
8137 fix CSW_SPROT from register AP_REG_CSW on selected dap.
8138 Defaulting to 0.
8139 @end deffn
8140
8141 @deffn Command {dap ti_be_32_quirks} [@option{enable}]
8142 Set/get quirks mode for TI TMS450/TMS570 processors
8143 Disabled by default
8144 @end deffn
8145
8146
8147 @subsection ARMv7-A specific commands
8148 @cindex Cortex-A
8149
8150 @deffn Command {cortex_a cache_info}
8151 display information about target caches
8152 @end deffn
8153
8154 @deffn Command {cortex_a dacrfixup [@option{on}|@option{off}]}
8155 Work around issues with software breakpoints when the program text is
8156 mapped read-only by the operating system. This option sets the CP15 DACR
8157 to "all-manager" to bypass MMU permission checks on memory access.
8158 Defaults to 'off'.
8159 @end deffn
8160
8161 @deffn Command {cortex_a dbginit}
8162 Initialize core debug
8163 Enables debug by unlocking the Software Lock and clearing sticky powerdown indications
8164 @end deffn
8165
8166 @deffn Command {cortex_a smp_off}
8167 Disable SMP mode
8168 @end deffn
8169
8170 @deffn Command {cortex_a smp_on}
8171 Enable SMP mode
8172 @end deffn
8173
8174 @deffn Command {cortex_a smp_gdb} [core_id]
8175 Display/set the current core displayed in GDB
8176 @end deffn
8177
8178 @deffn Command {cortex_a maskisr} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
8179 Selects whether interrupts will be processed when single stepping
8180 @end deffn
8181
8182 @deffn Command {cache_config l2x} [base way]
8183 configure l2x cache
8184 @end deffn
8185
8186
8187 @subsection ARMv7-R specific commands
8188 @cindex Cortex-R
8189
8190 @deffn Command {cortex_r dbginit}
8191 Initialize core debug
8192 Enables debug by unlocking the Software Lock and clearing sticky powerdown indications
8193 @end deffn
8194
8195 @deffn Command {cortex_r maskisr} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
8196 Selects whether interrupts will be processed when single stepping
8197 @end deffn
8198
8199
8200 @subsection ARMv7-M specific commands
8201 @cindex tracing
8202 @cindex SWO
8203 @cindex SWV
8204 @cindex TPIU
8205 @cindex ITM
8206 @cindex ETM
8207
8208 @deffn Command {tpiu config} (@option{disable} | ((@option{external} | @option{internal (@var{filename} | -)}) @
8209 (@option{sync @var{port_width}} | ((@option{manchester} | @option{uart}) @var{formatter_enable})) @
8210 @var{TRACECLKIN_freq} [@var{trace_freq}]))
8211
8212 ARMv7-M architecture provides several modules to generate debugging
8213 information internally (ITM, DWT and ETM). Their output is directed
8214 through TPIU to be captured externally either on an SWO pin (this
8215 configuration is called SWV) or on a synchronous parallel trace port.
8216
8217 This command configures the TPIU module of the target and, if internal
8218 capture mode is selected, starts to capture trace output by using the
8219 debugger adapter features.
8220
8221 Some targets require additional actions to be performed in the
8222 @b{trace-config} handler for trace port to be activated.
8223
8224 Command options:
8225 @itemize @minus
8226 @item @option{disable} disable TPIU handling;
8227 @item @option{external} configure TPIU to let user capture trace
8228 output externally (with an additional UART or logic analyzer hardware);
8229 @item @option{internal @var{filename}} configure TPIU and debug adapter to
8230 gather trace data and append it to @var{filename} (which can be
8231 either a regular file or a named pipe);
8232 @item @option{internal -} configure TPIU and debug adapter to
8233 gather trace data, but not write to any file. Useful in conjunction with the @command{tcl_trace} command;
8234 @item @option{sync @var{port_width}} use synchronous parallel trace output
8235 mode, and set port width to @var{port_width};
8236 @item @option{manchester} use asynchronous SWO mode with Manchester
8237 coding;
8238 @item @option{uart} use asynchronous SWO mode with NRZ (same as
8239 regular UART 8N1) coding;
8240 @item @var{formatter_enable} is @option{on} or @option{off} to enable
8241 or disable TPIU formatter which needs to be used when both ITM and ETM
8242 data is to be output via SWO;
8243 @item @var{TRACECLKIN_freq} this should be specified to match target's
8244 current TRACECLKIN frequency (usually the same as HCLK);
8245 @item @var{trace_freq} trace port frequency. Can be omitted in
8246 internal mode to let the adapter driver select the maximum supported
8247 rate automatically.
8248 @end itemize
8249
8250 Example usage:
8251 @enumerate
8252 @item STM32L152 board is programmed with an application that configures
8253 PLL to provide core clock with 24MHz frequency; to use ITM output it's
8254 enough to:
8255 @example
8256 #include <libopencm3/cm3/itm.h>
8257 ...
8258 ITM_STIM8(0) = c;
8259 ...
8260 @end example
8261 (the most obvious way is to use the first stimulus port for printf,
8262 for that this ITM_STIM8 assignment can be used inside _write(); to make it
8263 blocking to avoid data loss, add @code{while (!(ITM_STIM8(0) &
8264 ITM_STIM_FIFOREADY));});
8265 @item An FT2232H UART is connected to the SWO pin of the board;
8266 @item Commands to configure UART for 12MHz baud rate:
8267 @example
8268 $ setserial /dev/ttyUSB1 spd_cust divisor 5
8269 $ stty -F /dev/ttyUSB1 38400
8270 @end example
8271 (FT2232H's base frequency is 60MHz, spd_cust allows to alias 38400
8272 baud with our custom divisor to get 12MHz)
8273 @item @code{itmdump -f /dev/ttyUSB1 -d1}
8274 @item OpenOCD invocation line:
8275 @example
8276 openocd -f interface/stlink-v2-1.cfg \
8277 -c "transport select hla_swd" \
8278 -f target/stm32l1.cfg \
8279 -c "tpiu config external uart off 24000000 12000000"
8280 @end example
8281 @end enumerate
8282 @end deffn
8283
8284 @deffn Command {itm port} @var{port} (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{on}|@option{off})
8285 Enable or disable trace output for ITM stimulus @var{port} (counting
8286 from 0). Port 0 is enabled on target creation automatically.
8287 @end deffn
8288
8289 @deffn Command {itm ports} (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{on}|@option{off})
8290 Enable or disable trace output for all ITM stimulus ports.
8291 @end deffn
8292
8293 @subsection Cortex-M specific commands
8294 @cindex Cortex-M
8295
8296 @deffn Command {cortex_m maskisr} (@option{auto}|@option{on}|@option{off})
8297 Control masking (disabling) interrupts during target step/resume.
8298
8299 The @option{auto} option handles interrupts during stepping a way they get
8300 served but don't disturb the program flow. The step command first allows
8301 pending interrupt handlers to execute, then disables interrupts and steps over
8302 the next instruction where the core was halted. After the step interrupts
8303 are enabled again. If the interrupt handlers don't complete within 500ms,
8304 the step command leaves with the core running.
8305
8306 Note that a free breakpoint is required for the @option{auto} option. If no
8307 breakpoint is available at the time of the step, then the step is taken
8308 with interrupts enabled, i.e. the same way the @option{off} option does.
8309
8310 Default is @option{auto}.
8311 @end deffn
8312
8313 @deffn Command {cortex_m vector_catch} [@option{all}|@option{none}|list]
8314 @cindex vector_catch
8315 Vector Catch hardware provides dedicated breakpoints
8316 for certain hardware events.
8317
8318 Parameters request interception of
8319 @option{all} of these hardware event vectors,
8320 @option{none} of them,
8321 or one or more of the following:
8322 @option{hard_err} for a HardFault exception;
8323 @option{mm_err} for a MemManage exception;
8324 @option{bus_err} for a BusFault exception;
8325 @option{irq_err},
8326 @option{state_err},
8327 @option{chk_err}, or
8328 @option{nocp_err} for various UsageFault exceptions; or
8329 @option{reset}.
8330 If NVIC setup code does not enable them,
8331 MemManage, BusFault, and UsageFault exceptions
8332 are mapped to HardFault.
8333 UsageFault checks for
8334 divide-by-zero and unaligned access
8335 must also be explicitly enabled.
8336
8337 This finishes by listing the current vector catch configuration.
8338 @end deffn
8339
8340 @deffn Command {cortex_m reset_config} (@option{srst}|@option{sysresetreq}|@option{vectreset})
8341 Control reset handling. The default @option{srst} is to use srst if fitted,
8342 otherwise fallback to @option{vectreset}.
8343 @itemize @minus
8344 @item @option{srst} use hardware srst if fitted otherwise fallback to @option{vectreset}.
8345 @item @option{sysresetreq} use NVIC SYSRESETREQ to reset system.
8346 @item @option{vectreset} use NVIC VECTRESET to reset system.
8347 @end itemize
8348 Using @option{vectreset} is a safe option for all current Cortex-M cores.
8349 This however has the disadvantage of only resetting the core, all peripherals
8350 are uneffected. A solution would be to use a @code{reset-init} event handler to manually reset
8351 the peripherals.
8352 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
8353 @end deffn
8354
8355 @subsection ARMv8-A specific commands
8356 @cindex ARMv8-A
8357 @cindex aarch64
8358
8359 @deffn Command {aarch64 cache_info}
8360 Display information about target caches
8361 @end deffn
8362
8363 @deffn Command {aarch64 dbginit}
8364 This command enables debugging by clearing the OS Lock and sticky power-down and reset
8365 indications. It also establishes the expected, basic cross-trigger configuration the aarch64
8366 target code relies on. In a configuration file, the command would typically be called from a
8367 @code{reset-end} or @code{reset-deassert-post} handler, to re-enable debugging after a system reset.
8368 However, normally it is not necessary to use the command at all.
8369 @end deffn
8370
8371 @deffn Command {aarch64 smp_on|smp_off}
8372 Enable and disable SMP handling. The state of SMP handling influences the way targets in an SMP group
8373 are handled by the run control. With SMP handling enabled, issuing halt or resume to one core will trigger
8374 halting or resuming of all cores in the group. The command @code{target smp} defines which targets are in the SMP
8375 group. With SMP handling disabled, all targets need to be treated individually.
8376 @end deffn
8377
8378 @section Intel Architecture
8379
8380 Intel Quark X10xx is the first product in the Quark family of SoCs. It is an IA-32
8381 (Pentium x86 ISA) compatible SoC. The core CPU in the X10xx is codenamed Lakemont.
8382 Lakemont version 1 (LMT1) is used in X10xx. The CPU TAP (Lakemont TAP) is used for
8383 software debug and the CLTAP is used for SoC level operations.
8384 Useful docs are here: https://communities.intel.com/community/makers/documentation
8385 @itemize
8386 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 OpenOCD/GDB/Eclipse App Note (web search for doc num 330015)
8387 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 Debug Operations User Guide (web search for doc num 329866)
8388 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 Datasheet (web search for doc num 329676)
8389 @end itemize
8390
8391 @subsection x86 32-bit specific commands
8392 The three main address spaces for x86 are memory, I/O and configuration space.
8393 These commands allow a user to read and write to the 64Kbyte I/O address space.
8394
8395 @deffn Command {x86_32 idw} address
8396 Display the contents of a 32-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
8397 @end deffn
8398
8399 @deffn Command {x86_32 idh} address
8400 Display the contents of a 16-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
8401 @end deffn
8402
8403 @deffn Command {x86_32 idb} address
8404 Display the contents of a 8-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
8405 @end deffn
8406
8407 @deffn Command {x86_32 iww} address
8408 Write the contents of a 32-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
8409 @end deffn
8410
8411 @deffn Command {x86_32 iwh} address
8412 Write the contents of a 16-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
8413 @end deffn
8414
8415 @deffn Command {x86_32 iwb} address
8416 Write the contents of a 8-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
8417 @end deffn
8418
8419 @section OpenRISC Architecture
8420
8421 The OpenRISC CPU is a soft core. It is used in a programmable SoC which can be
8422 configured with any of the TAP / Debug Unit available.
8423
8424 @subsection TAP and Debug Unit selection commands
8425 @deffn Command {tap_select} (@option{vjtag}|@option{mohor}|@option{xilinx_bscan})
8426 Select between the Altera Virtual JTAG , Xilinx Virtual JTAG and Mohor TAP.
8427 @end deffn
8428 @deffn Command {du_select} (@option{adv}|@option{mohor}) [option]
8429 Select between the Advanced Debug Interface and the classic one.
8430
8431 An option can be passed as a second argument to the debug unit.
8432
8433 When using the Advanced Debug Interface, option = 1 means the RTL core is
8434 configured with ADBG_USE_HISPEED = 1. This configuration skips status checking
8435 between bytes while doing read or write bursts.
8436 @end deffn
8437
8438 @subsection Registers commands
8439 @deffn Command {addreg} [name] [address] [feature] [reg_group]
8440 Add a new register in the cpu register list. This register will be
8441 included in the generated target descriptor file.
8442
8443 @strong{[feature]} must be "org.gnu.gdb.or1k.group[0..10]".
8444
8445 @strong{[reg_group]} can be anything. The default register list defines "system",
8446 "dmmu", "immu", "dcache", "icache", "mac", "debug", "perf", "power", "pic"
8447 and "timer" groups.
8448
8449 @emph{example:}
8450 @example
8451 addreg rtest 0x1234 org.gnu.gdb.or1k.group0 system
8452 @end example
8453
8454
8455 @end deffn
8456 @deffn Command {readgroup} (@option{group})
8457 Display all registers in @emph{group}.
8458
8459 @emph{group} can be "system",
8460 "dmmu", "immu", "dcache", "icache", "mac", "debug", "perf", "power", "pic",
8461 "timer" or any new group created with addreg command.
8462 @end deffn
8463
8464 @anchor{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing}
8465 @section Software Debug Messages and Tracing
8466 @cindex Linux-ARM DCC support
8467 @cindex tracing
8468 @cindex libdcc
8469 @cindex DCC
8470 OpenOCD can process certain requests from target software, when
8471 the target uses appropriate libraries.
8472 The most powerful mechanism is semihosting, but there is also
8473 a lighter weight mechanism using only the DCC channel.
8474
8475 Currently @command{target_request debugmsgs}
8476 is supported only for @option{arm7_9} and @option{cortex_m} cores.
8477 These messages are received as part of target polling, so
8478 you need to have @command{poll on} active to receive them.
8479 They are intrusive in that they will affect program execution
8480 times. If that is a problem, @pxref{armhardwaretracing,,ARM Hardware Tracing}.
8481
8482 See @file{libdcc} in the contrib dir for more details.
8483 In addition to sending strings, characters, and
8484 arrays of various size integers from the target,
8485 @file{libdcc} also exports a software trace point mechanism.
8486 The target being debugged may
8487 issue trace messages which include a 24-bit @dfn{trace point} number.
8488 Trace point support includes two distinct mechanisms,
8489 each supported by a command:
8490
8491 @itemize
8492 @item @emph{History} ... A circular buffer of trace points
8493 can be set up, and then displayed at any time.
8494 This tracks where code has been, which can be invaluable in
8495 finding out how some fault was triggered.
8496
8497 The buffer may overflow, since it collects records continuously.
8498 It may be useful to use some of the 24 bits to represent a
8499 particular event, and other bits to hold data.
8500
8501 @item @emph{Counting} ... An array of counters can be set up,
8502 and then displayed at any time.
8503 This can help establish code coverage and identify hot spots.
8504
8505 The array of counters is directly indexed by the trace point
8506 number, so trace points with higher numbers are not counted.
8507 @end itemize
8508
8509 Linux-ARM kernels have a ``Kernel low-level debugging
8510 via EmbeddedICE DCC channel'' option (CONFIG_DEBUG_ICEDCC,
8511 depends on CONFIG_DEBUG_LL) which uses this mechanism to
8512 deliver messages before a serial console can be activated.
8513 This is not the same format used by @file{libdcc}.
8514 Other software, such as the U-Boot boot loader, sometimes
8515 does the same thing.
8516
8517 @deffn Command {target_request debugmsgs} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}|@option{charmsg}]
8518 Displays current handling of target DCC message requests.
8519 These messages may be sent to the debugger while the target is running.
8520 The optional @option{enable} and @option{charmsg} parameters
8521 both enable the messages, while @option{disable} disables them.
8522
8523 With @option{charmsg} the DCC words each contain one character,
8524 as used by Linux with CONFIG_DEBUG_ICEDCC;
8525 otherwise the libdcc format is used.
8526 @end deffn
8527
8528 @deffn Command {trace history} [@option{clear}|count]
8529 With no parameter, displays all the trace points that have triggered
8530 in the order they triggered.
8531 With the parameter @option{clear}, erases all current trace history records.
8532 With a @var{count} parameter, allocates space for that many
8533 history records.
8534 @end deffn
8535
8536 @deffn Command {trace point} [@option{clear}|identifier]
8537 With no parameter, displays all trace point identifiers and how many times
8538 they have been triggered.
8539 With the parameter @option{clear}, erases all current trace point counters.
8540 With a numeric @var{identifier} parameter, creates a new a trace point counter
8541 and associates it with that identifier.
8542
8543 @emph{Important:} The identifier and the trace point number
8544 are not related except by this command.
8545 These trace point numbers always start at zero (from server startup,
8546 or after @command{trace point clear}) and count up from there.
8547 @end deffn
8548
8549
8550 @node JTAG Commands
8551 @chapter JTAG Commands
8552 @cindex JTAG Commands
8553 Most general purpose JTAG commands have been presented earlier.
8554 (@xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}, @ref{Reset Configuration}, and @ref{TAP Declaration}.)
8555 Lower level JTAG commands, as presented here,
8556 may be needed to work with targets which require special
8557 attention during operations such as reset or initialization.
8558
8559 To use these commands you will need to understand some
8560 of the basics of JTAG, including:
8561
8562 @itemize @bullet
8563 @item A JTAG scan chain consists of a sequence of individual TAP
8564 devices such as a CPUs.
8565 @item Control operations involve moving each TAP through the same
8566 standard state machine (in parallel)
8567 using their shared TMS and clock signals.
8568 @item Data transfer involves shifting data through the chain of
8569 instruction or data registers of each TAP, writing new register values
8570 while the reading previous ones.
8571 @item Data register sizes are a function of the instruction active in
8572 a given TAP, while instruction register sizes are fixed for each TAP.
8573 All TAPs support a BYPASS instruction with a single bit data register.
8574 @item The way OpenOCD differentiates between TAP devices is by
8575 shifting different instructions into (and out of) their instruction
8576 registers.
8577 @end itemize
8578
8579 @section Low Level JTAG Commands
8580
8581 These commands are used by developers who need to access
8582 JTAG instruction or data registers, possibly controlling
8583 the order of TAP state transitions.
8584 If you're not debugging OpenOCD internals, or bringing up a
8585 new JTAG adapter or a new type of TAP device (like a CPU or
8586 JTAG router), you probably won't need to use these commands.
8587 In a debug session that doesn't use JTAG for its transport protocol,
8588 these commands are not available.
8589
8590 @deffn Command {drscan} tap [numbits value]+ [@option{-endstate} tap_state]
8591 Loads the data register of @var{tap} with a series of bit fields
8592 that specify the entire register.
8593 Each field is @var{numbits} bits long with
8594 a numeric @var{value} (hexadecimal encouraged).
8595 The return value holds the original value of each
8596 of those fields.
8597
8598 For example, a 38 bit number might be specified as one
8599 field of 32 bits then one of 6 bits.
8600 @emph{For portability, never pass fields which are more
8601 than 32 bits long. Many OpenOCD implementations do not
8602 support 64-bit (or larger) integer values.}
8603
8604 All TAPs other than @var{tap} must be in BYPASS mode.
8605 The single bit in their data registers does not matter.
8606
8607 When @var{tap_state} is specified, the JTAG state machine is left
8608 in that state.
8609 For example @sc{drpause} might be specified, so that more
8610 instructions can be issued before re-entering the @sc{run/idle} state.
8611 If the end state is not specified, the @sc{run/idle} state is entered.
8612
8613 @quotation Warning
8614 OpenOCD does not record information about data register lengths,
8615 so @emph{it is important that you get the bit field lengths right}.
8616 Remember that different JTAG instructions refer to different
8617 data registers, which may have different lengths.
8618 Moreover, those lengths may not be fixed;
8619 the SCAN_N instruction can change the length of
8620 the register accessed by the INTEST instruction
8621 (by connecting a different scan chain).
8622 @end quotation
8623 @end deffn
8624
8625 @deffn Command {flush_count}
8626 Returns the number of times the JTAG queue has been flushed.
8627 This may be used for performance tuning.
8628
8629 For example, flushing a queue over USB involves a
8630 minimum latency, often several milliseconds, which does
8631 not change with the amount of data which is written.
8632 You may be able to identify performance problems by finding
8633 tasks which waste bandwidth by flushing small transfers too often,
8634 instead of batching them into larger operations.
8635 @end deffn
8636
8637 @deffn Command {irscan} [tap instruction]+ [@option{-endstate} tap_state]
8638 For each @var{tap} listed, loads the instruction register
8639 with its associated numeric @var{instruction}.
8640 (The number of bits in that instruction may be displayed
8641 using the @command{scan_chain} command.)
8642 For other TAPs, a BYPASS instruction is loaded.
8643
8644 When @var{tap_state} is specified, the JTAG state machine is left
8645 in that state.
8646 For example @sc{irpause} might be specified, so the data register
8647 can be loaded before re-entering the @sc{run/idle} state.
8648 If the end state is not specified, the @sc{run/idle} state is entered.
8649
8650 @quotation Note
8651 OpenOCD currently supports only a single field for instruction
8652 register values, unlike data register values.
8653 For TAPs where the instruction register length is more than 32 bits,
8654 portable scripts currently must issue only BYPASS instructions.
8655 @end quotation
8656 @end deffn
8657
8658 @deffn Command {jtag_reset} trst srst
8659 Set values of reset signals.
8660 The @var{trst} and @var{srst} parameter values may be
8661 @option{0}, indicating that reset is inactive (pulled or driven high),
8662 or @option{1}, indicating it is active (pulled or driven low).
8663 The @command{reset_config} command should already have been used
8664 to configure how the board and JTAG adapter treat these two
8665 signals, and to say if either signal is even present.
8666 @xref{Reset Configuration}.
8667
8668 Note that TRST is specially handled.
8669 It actually signifies JTAG's @sc{reset} state.
8670 So if the board doesn't support the optional TRST signal,
8671 or it doesn't support it along with the specified SRST value,
8672 JTAG reset is triggered with TMS and TCK signals
8673 instead of the TRST signal.
8674 And no matter how that JTAG reset is triggered, once
8675 the scan chain enters @sc{reset} with TRST inactive,
8676 TAP @code{post-reset} events are delivered to all TAPs
8677 with handlers for that event.
8678 @end deffn
8679
8680 @deffn Command {pathmove} start_state [next_state ...]
8681 Start by moving to @var{start_state}, which
8682 must be one of the @emph{stable} states.
8683 Unless it is the only state given, this will often be the
8684 current state, so that no TCK transitions are needed.
8685 Then, in a series of single state transitions
8686 (conforming to the JTAG state machine) shift to
8687 each @var{next_state} in sequence, one per TCK cycle.
8688 The final state must also be stable.
8689 @end deffn
8690
8691 @deffn Command {runtest} @var{num_cycles}
8692 Move to the @sc{run/idle} state, and execute at least
8693 @var{num_cycles} of the JTAG clock (TCK).
8694 Instructions often need some time
8695 to execute before they take effect.
8696 @end deffn
8697
8698 @c tms_sequence (short|long)
8699 @c ... temporary, debug-only, other than USBprog bug workaround...
8700
8701 @deffn Command {verify_ircapture} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
8702 Verify values captured during @sc{ircapture} and returned
8703 during IR scans. Default is enabled, but this can be
8704 overridden by @command{verify_jtag}.
8705 This flag is ignored when validating JTAG chain configuration.
8706 @end deffn
8707
8708 @deffn Command {verify_jtag} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
8709 Enables verification of DR and IR scans, to help detect
8710 programming errors. For IR scans, @command{verify_ircapture}
8711 must also be enabled.
8712 Default is enabled.
8713 @end deffn
8714
8715 @section TAP state names
8716 @cindex TAP state names
8717
8718 The @var{tap_state} names used by OpenOCD in the @command{drscan},
8719 @command{irscan}, and @command{pathmove} commands are the same
8720 as those used in SVF boundary scan documents, except that
8721 SVF uses @sc{idle} instead of @sc{run/idle}.
8722
8723 @itemize @bullet
8724 @item @b{RESET} ... @emph{stable} (with TMS high);
8725 acts as if TRST were pulsed
8726 @item @b{RUN/IDLE} ... @emph{stable}; don't assume this always means IDLE
8727 @item @b{DRSELECT}
8728 @item @b{DRCAPTURE}
8729 @item @b{DRSHIFT} ... @emph{stable}; TDI/TDO shifting
8730 through the data register
8731 @item @b{DREXIT1}
8732 @item @b{DRPAUSE} ... @emph{stable}; data register ready
8733 for update or more shifting
8734 @item @b{DREXIT2}
8735 @item @b{DRUPDATE}
8736 @item @b{IRSELECT}
8737 @item @b{IRCAPTURE}
8738 @item @b{IRSHIFT} ... @emph{stable}; TDI/TDO shifting
8739 through the instruction register
8740 @item @b{IREXIT1}
8741 @item @b{IRPAUSE} ... @emph{stable}; instruction register ready
8742 for update or more shifting
8743 @item @b{IREXIT2}
8744 @item @b{IRUPDATE}
8745 @end itemize
8746
8747 Note that only six of those states are fully ``stable'' in the
8748 face of TMS fixed (low except for @sc{reset})
8749 and a free-running JTAG clock. For all the
8750 others, the next TCK transition changes to a new state.
8751
8752 @itemize @bullet
8753 @item From @sc{drshift} and @sc{irshift}, clock transitions will
8754 produce side effects by changing register contents. The values
8755 to be latched in upcoming @sc{drupdate} or @sc{irupdate} states
8756 may not be as expected.
8757 @item @sc{run/idle}, @sc{drpause}, and @sc{irpause} are reasonable
8758 choices after @command{drscan} or @command{irscan} commands,
8759 since they are free of JTAG side effects.
8760 @item @sc{run/idle} may have side effects that appear at non-JTAG
8761 levels, such as advancing the ARM9E-S instruction pipeline.
8762 Consult the documentation for the TAP(s) you are working with.
8763 @end itemize
8764
8765 @node Boundary Scan Commands
8766 @chapter Boundary Scan Commands
8767
8768 One of the original purposes of JTAG was to support
8769 boundary scan based hardware testing.
8770 Although its primary focus is to support On-Chip Debugging,
8771 OpenOCD also includes some boundary scan commands.
8772
8773 @section SVF: Serial Vector Format
8774 @cindex Serial Vector Format
8775 @cindex SVF
8776
8777 The Serial Vector Format, better known as @dfn{SVF}, is a
8778 way to represent JTAG test patterns in text files.
8779 In a debug session using JTAG for its transport protocol,
8780 OpenOCD supports running such test files.
8781
8782 @deffn Command {svf} filename [@option{quiet}]
8783 This issues a JTAG reset (Test-Logic-Reset) and then
8784 runs the SVF script from @file{filename}.
8785 Unless the @option{quiet} option is specified,
8786 each command is logged before it is executed.
8787 @end deffn
8788
8789 @section XSVF: Xilinx Serial Vector Format
8790 @cindex Xilinx Serial Vector Format
8791 @cindex XSVF
8792
8793 The Xilinx Serial Vector Format, better known as @dfn{XSVF}, is a
8794 binary representation of SVF which is optimized for use with
8795 Xilinx devices.
8796 In a debug session using JTAG for its transport protocol,
8797 OpenOCD supports running such test files.
8798
8799 @quotation Important
8800 Not all XSVF commands are supported.
8801 @end quotation
8802
8803 @deffn Command {xsvf} (tapname|@option{plain}) filename [@option{virt2}] [@option{quiet}]
8804 This issues a JTAG reset (Test-Logic-Reset) and then
8805 runs the XSVF script from @file{filename}.
8806 When a @var{tapname} is specified, the commands are directed at
8807 that TAP.
8808 When @option{virt2} is specified, the @sc{xruntest} command counts
8809 are interpreted as TCK cycles instead of microseconds.
8810 Unless the @option{quiet} option is specified,
8811 messages are logged for comments and some retries.
8812 @end deffn
8813
8814 The OpenOCD sources also include two utility scripts
8815 for working with XSVF; they are not currently installed
8816 after building the software.
8817 You may find them useful:
8818
8819 @itemize
8820 @item @emph{svf2xsvf} ... converts SVF files into the extended XSVF
8821 syntax understood by the @command{xsvf} command; see notes below.
8822 @item @emph{xsvfdump} ... converts XSVF files into a text output format;
8823 understands the OpenOCD extensions.
8824 @end itemize
8825
8826 The input format accepts a handful of non-standard extensions.
8827 These include three opcodes corresponding to SVF extensions
8828 from Lattice Semiconductor (LCOUNT, LDELAY, LDSR), and
8829 two opcodes supporting a more accurate translation of SVF
8830 (XTRST, XWAITSTATE).
8831 If @emph{xsvfdump} shows a file is using those opcodes, it
8832 probably will not be usable with other XSVF tools.
8833
8834
8835 @node Utility Commands
8836 @chapter Utility Commands
8837 @cindex Utility Commands
8838
8839 @section RAM testing
8840 @cindex RAM testing
8841
8842 There is often a need to stress-test random access memory (RAM) for
8843 errors. OpenOCD comes with a Tcl implementation of well-known memory
8844 testing procedures allowing the detection of all sorts of issues with
8845 electrical wiring, defective chips, PCB layout and other common
8846 hardware problems.
8847
8848 To use them, you usually need to initialise your RAM controller first;
8849 consult your SoC's documentation to get the recommended list of
8850 register operations and translate them to the corresponding
8851 @command{mww}/@command{mwb} commands.
8852
8853 Load the memory testing functions with
8854
8855 @example
8856 source [find tools/memtest.tcl]
8857 @end example
8858
8859 to get access to the following facilities:
8860
8861 @deffn Command {memTestDataBus} address
8862 Test the data bus wiring in a memory region by performing a walking
8863 1's test at a fixed address within that region.
8864 @end deffn
8865
8866 @deffn Command {memTestAddressBus} baseaddress size
8867 Perform a walking 1's test on the relevant bits of the address and
8868 check for aliasing. This test will find single-bit address failures
8869 such as stuck-high, stuck-low, and shorted pins.
8870 @end deffn
8871
8872 @deffn Command {memTestDevice} baseaddress size
8873 Test the integrity of a physical memory device by performing an
8874 increment/decrement test over the entire region. In the process every
8875 storage bit in the device is tested as zero and as one.
8876 @end deffn
8877
8878 @deffn Command {runAllMemTests} baseaddress size
8879 Run all of the above tests over a specified memory region.
8880 @end deffn
8881
8882 @section Firmware recovery helpers
8883 @cindex Firmware recovery
8884
8885 OpenOCD includes an easy-to-use script to facilitate mass-market
8886 devices recovery with JTAG.
8887
8888 For quickstart instructions run:
8889 @example
8890 openocd -f tools/firmware-recovery.tcl -c firmware_help
8891 @end example
8892
8893 @node TFTP
8894 @chapter TFTP
8895 @cindex TFTP
8896 If OpenOCD runs on an embedded host (as ZY1000 does), then TFTP can
8897 be used to access files on PCs (either the developer's PC or some other PC).
8898
8899 The way this works on the ZY1000 is to prefix a filename by
8900 "/tftp/ip/" and append the TFTP path on the TFTP
8901 server (tftpd). For example,
8902
8903 @example
8904 load_image /tftp/10.0.0.96/c:\temp\abc.elf
8905 @end example
8906
8907 will load c:\temp\abc.elf from the developer pc (10.0.0.96) into memory as
8908 if the file was hosted on the embedded host.
8909
8910 In order to achieve decent performance, you must choose a TFTP server
8911 that supports a packet size bigger than the default packet size (512 bytes). There
8912 are numerous TFTP servers out there (free and commercial) and you will have to do
8913 a bit of googling to find something that fits your requirements.
8914
8915 @node GDB and OpenOCD
8916 @chapter GDB and OpenOCD
8917 @cindex GDB
8918 OpenOCD complies with the remote gdbserver protocol and, as such, can be used
8919 to debug remote targets.
8920 Setting up GDB to work with OpenOCD can involve several components:
8921
8922 @itemize
8923 @item The OpenOCD server support for GDB may need to be configured.
8924 @xref{gdbconfiguration,,GDB Configuration}.
8925 @item GDB's support for OpenOCD may need configuration,
8926 as shown in this chapter.
8927 @item If you have a GUI environment like Eclipse,
8928 that also will probably need to be configured.
8929 @end itemize
8930
8931 Of course, the version of GDB you use will need to be one which has
8932 been built to know about the target CPU you're using. It's probably
8933 part of the tool chain you're using. For example, if you are doing
8934 cross-development for ARM on an x86 PC, instead of using the native
8935 x86 @command{gdb} command you might use @command{arm-none-eabi-gdb}
8936 if that's the tool chain used to compile your code.
8937
8938 @section Connecting to GDB
8939 @cindex Connecting to GDB
8940 Use GDB 6.7 or newer with OpenOCD if you run into trouble. For
8941 instance GDB 6.3 has a known bug that produces bogus memory access
8942 errors, which has since been fixed; see
8943 @url{http://osdir.com/ml/gdb.bugs.discuss/2004-12/msg00018.html}
8944
8945 OpenOCD can communicate with GDB in two ways:
8946
8947 @enumerate
8948 @item
8949 A socket (TCP/IP) connection is typically started as follows:
8950 @example
8951 target remote localhost:3333
8952 @end example
8953 This would cause GDB to connect to the gdbserver on the local pc using port 3333.
8954
8955 It is also possible to use the GDB extended remote protocol as follows:
8956 @example
8957 target extended-remote localhost:3333
8958 @end example
8959 @item
8960 A pipe connection is typically started as follows:
8961 @example
8962 target remote | openocd -c "gdb_port pipe; log_output openocd.log"
8963 @end example
8964 This would cause GDB to run OpenOCD and communicate using pipes (stdin/stdout).
8965 Using this method has the advantage of GDB starting/stopping OpenOCD for the debug
8966 session. log_output sends the log output to a file to ensure that the pipe is
8967 not saturated when using higher debug level outputs.
8968 @end enumerate
8969
8970 To list the available OpenOCD commands type @command{monitor help} on the
8971 GDB command line.
8972
8973 @section Sample GDB session startup
8974
8975 With the remote protocol, GDB sessions start a little differently
8976 than they do when you're debugging locally.
8977 Here's an example showing how to start a debug session with a
8978 small ARM program.
8979 In this case the program was linked to be loaded into SRAM on a Cortex-M3.
8980 Most programs would be written into flash (address 0) and run from there.
8981
8982 @example
8983 $ arm-none-eabi-gdb example.elf
8984 (gdb) target remote localhost:3333
8985 Remote debugging using localhost:3333
8986 ...
8987 (gdb) monitor reset halt
8988 ...
8989 (gdb) load
8990 Loading section .vectors, size 0x100 lma 0x20000000
8991 Loading section .text, size 0x5a0 lma 0x20000100
8992 Loading section .data, size 0x18 lma 0x200006a0
8993 Start address 0x2000061c, load size 1720
8994 Transfer rate: 22 KB/sec, 573 bytes/write.
8995 (gdb) continue
8996 Continuing.
8997 ...
8998 @end example
8999
9000 You could then interrupt the GDB session to make the program break,
9001 type @command{where} to show the stack, @command{list} to show the
9002 code around the program counter, @command{step} through code,
9003 set breakpoints or watchpoints, and so on.
9004
9005 @section Configuring GDB for OpenOCD
9006
9007 OpenOCD supports the gdb @option{qSupported} packet, this enables information
9008 to be sent by the GDB remote server (i.e. OpenOCD) to GDB. Typical information includes
9009 packet size and the device's memory map.
9010 You do not need to configure the packet size by hand,
9011 and the relevant parts of the memory map should be automatically
9012 set up when you declare (NOR) flash banks.
9013
9014 However, there are other things which GDB can't currently query.
9015 You may need to set those up by hand.
9016 As OpenOCD starts up, you will often see a line reporting
9017 something like:
9018
9019 @example
9020 Info : lm3s.cpu: hardware has 6 breakpoints, 4 watchpoints
9021 @end example
9022
9023 You can pass that information to GDB with these commands:
9024
9025 @example
9026 set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit 6
9027 set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit 4
9028 @end example
9029
9030 With that particular hardware (Cortex-M3) the hardware breakpoints
9031 only work for code running from flash memory. Most other ARM systems
9032 do not have such restrictions.
9033
9034 Another example of useful GDB configuration came from a user who
9035 found that single stepping his Cortex-M3 didn't work well with IRQs
9036 and an RTOS until he told GDB to disable the IRQs while stepping:
9037
9038 @example
9039 define hook-step
9040 mon cortex_m maskisr on
9041 end
9042 define hookpost-step
9043 mon cortex_m maskisr off
9044 end
9045 @end example
9046
9047 Rather than typing such commands interactively, you may prefer to
9048 save them in a file and have GDB execute them as it starts, perhaps
9049 using a @file{.gdbinit} in your project directory or starting GDB
9050 using @command{gdb -x filename}.
9051
9052 @section Programming using GDB
9053 @cindex Programming using GDB
9054 @anchor{programmingusinggdb}
9055
9056 By default the target memory map is sent to GDB. This can be disabled by
9057 the following OpenOCD configuration option:
9058 @example
9059 gdb_memory_map disable
9060 @end example
9061 For this to function correctly a valid flash configuration must also be set
9062 in OpenOCD. For faster performance you should also configure a valid
9063 working area.
9064
9065 Informing GDB of the memory map of the target will enable GDB to protect any
9066 flash areas of the target and use hardware breakpoints by default. This means
9067 that the OpenOCD option @command{gdb_breakpoint_override} is not required when
9068 using a memory map. @xref{gdbbreakpointoverride,,gdb_breakpoint_override}.
9069
9070 To view the configured memory map in GDB, use the GDB command @option{info mem}.
9071 All other unassigned addresses within GDB are treated as RAM.
9072
9073 GDB 6.8 and higher set any memory area not in the memory map as inaccessible.
9074 This can be changed to the old behaviour by using the following GDB command
9075 @example
9076 set mem inaccessible-by-default off
9077 @end example
9078
9079 If @command{gdb_flash_program enable} is also used, GDB will be able to
9080 program any flash memory using the vFlash interface.
9081
9082 GDB will look at the target memory map when a load command is given, if any
9083 areas to be programmed lie within the target flash area the vFlash packets
9084 will be used.
9085
9086 If the target needs configuring before GDB programming, an event
9087 script can be executed:
9088 @example
9089 $_TARGETNAME configure -event EVENTNAME BODY
9090 @end example
9091
9092 To verify any flash programming the GDB command @option{compare-sections}
9093 can be used.
9094 @anchor{usingopenocdsmpwithgdb}
9095 @section Using OpenOCD SMP with GDB
9096 @cindex SMP
9097 For SMP support following GDB serial protocol packet have been defined :
9098 @itemize @bullet
9099 @item j - smp status request
9100 @item J - smp set request
9101 @end itemize
9102
9103 OpenOCD implements :
9104 @itemize @bullet
9105 @item @option{jc} packet for reading core id displayed by
9106 GDB connection. Reply is @option{XXXXXXXX} (8 hex digits giving core id) or
9107 @option{E01} for target not smp.
9108 @item @option{JcXXXXXXXX} (8 hex digits) packet for setting core id displayed at next GDB continue
9109 (core id -1 is reserved for returning to normal resume mode). Reply @option{E01}
9110 for target not smp or @option{OK} on success.
9111 @end itemize
9112
9113 Handling of this packet within GDB can be done :
9114 @itemize @bullet
9115 @item by the creation of an internal variable (i.e @option{_core}) by mean
9116 of function allocate_computed_value allowing following GDB command.
9117 @example
9118 set $_core 1
9119 #Jc01 packet is sent
9120 print $_core
9121 #jc packet is sent and result is affected in $
9122 @end example
9123
9124 @item by the usage of GDB maintenance command as described in following example (2 cpus in SMP with
9125 core id 0 and 1 @pxref{definecputargetsworkinginsmp,,Define CPU targets working in SMP}).
9126
9127 @example
9128 # toggle0 : force display of coreid 0
9129 define toggle0
9130 maint packet Jc0
9131 continue
9132 main packet Jc-1
9133 end
9134 # toggle1 : force display of coreid 1
9135 define toggle1
9136 maint packet Jc1
9137 continue
9138 main packet Jc-1
9139 end
9140 @end example
9141 @end itemize
9142
9143 @section RTOS Support
9144 @cindex RTOS Support
9145 @anchor{gdbrtossupport}
9146
9147 OpenOCD includes RTOS support, this will however need enabling as it defaults to disabled.
9148 It can be enabled by passing @option{-rtos} arg to the target. @xref{rtostype,,RTOS Type}.
9149
9150 @xref{Threads, Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads,
9151 Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads, gdb, GDB manual}, for details about relevant
9152 GDB commands.
9153
9154 @* An example setup is below:
9155
9156 @example
9157 $_TARGETNAME configure -rtos auto
9158 @end example
9159
9160 This will attempt to auto detect the RTOS within your application.
9161
9162 Currently supported rtos's include:
9163 @itemize @bullet
9164 @item @option{eCos}
9165 @item @option{ThreadX}
9166 @item @option{FreeRTOS}
9167 @item @option{linux}
9168 @item @option{ChibiOS}
9169 @item @option{embKernel}
9170 @item @option{mqx}
9171 @item @option{uCOS-III}
9172 @end itemize
9173
9174 @quotation Note
9175 Before an RTOS can be detected, it must export certain symbols; otherwise, it cannot
9176 be used by OpenOCD. Below is a list of the required symbols for each supported RTOS.
9177 @end quotation
9178
9179 @table @code
9180 @item eCos symbols
9181 Cyg_Thread::thread_list, Cyg_Scheduler_Base::current_thread.
9182 @item ThreadX symbols
9183 _tx_thread_current_ptr, _tx_thread_created_ptr, _tx_thread_created_count.
9184 @item FreeRTOS symbols
9185 @c The following is taken from recent texinfo to provide compatibility
9186 @c with ancient versions that do not support @raggedright
9187 @tex
9188 \begingroup
9189 \rightskip0pt plus2em \spaceskip.3333em \xspaceskip.5em\relax
9190 pxCurrentTCB, pxReadyTasksLists, xDelayedTaskList1, xDelayedTaskList2,
9191 pxDelayedTaskList, pxOverflowDelayedTaskList, xPendingReadyList,
9192 uxCurrentNumberOfTasks, uxTopUsedPriority.
9193 \par
9194 \endgroup
9195 @end tex
9196 @item linux symbols
9197 init_task.
9198 @item ChibiOS symbols
9199 rlist, ch_debug, chSysInit.
9200 @item embKernel symbols
9201 Rtos::sCurrentTask, Rtos::sListReady, Rtos::sListSleep,
9202 Rtos::sListSuspended, Rtos::sMaxPriorities, Rtos::sCurrentTaskCount.
9203 @item mqx symbols
9204 _mqx_kernel_data, MQX_init_struct.
9205 @item uC/OS-III symbols
9206 OSRunning, OSTCBCurPtr, OSTaskDbgListPtr, OSTaskQty
9207 @end table
9208
9209 For most RTOS supported the above symbols will be exported by default. However for
9210 some, eg. FreeRTOS and uC/OS-III, extra steps must be taken.
9211
9212 These RTOSes may require additional OpenOCD-specific file to be linked
9213 along with the project:
9214
9215 @table @code
9216 @item FreeRTOS
9217 contrib/rtos-helpers/FreeRTOS-openocd.c
9218 @item uC/OS-III
9219 contrib/rtos-helpers/uCOS-III-openocd.c
9220 @end table
9221
9222 @node Tcl Scripting API
9223 @chapter Tcl Scripting API
9224 @cindex Tcl Scripting API
9225 @cindex Tcl scripts
9226 @section API rules
9227
9228 Tcl commands are stateless; e.g. the @command{telnet} command has
9229 a concept of currently active target, the Tcl API proc's take this sort
9230 of state information as an argument to each proc.
9231
9232 There are three main types of return values: single value, name value
9233 pair list and lists.
9234
9235 Name value pair. The proc 'foo' below returns a name/value pair
9236 list.
9237
9238 @example
9239 > set foo(me) Duane
9240 > set foo(you) Oyvind
9241 > set foo(mouse) Micky
9242 > set foo(duck) Donald
9243 @end example
9244
9245 If one does this:
9246
9247 @example
9248 > set foo
9249 @end example
9250
9251 The result is:
9252
9253 @example
9254 me Duane you Oyvind mouse Micky duck Donald
9255 @end example
9256
9257 Thus, to get the names of the associative array is easy:
9258
9259 @verbatim
9260 foreach { name value } [set foo] {
9261 puts "Name: $name, Value: $value"
9262 }
9263 @end verbatim
9264
9265 Lists returned should be relatively small. Otherwise, a range
9266 should be passed in to the proc in question.
9267
9268 @section Internal low-level Commands
9269
9270 By "low-level," we mean commands that a human would typically not
9271 invoke directly.
9272
9273 Some low-level commands need to be prefixed with "ocd_"; e.g.
9274 @command{ocd_flash_banks}
9275 is the low-level API upon which @command{flash banks} is implemented.
9276
9277 @itemize @bullet
9278 @item @b{mem2array} <@var{varname}> <@var{width}> <@var{addr}> <@var{nelems}>
9279
9280 Read memory and return as a Tcl array for script processing
9281 @item @b{array2mem} <@var{varname}> <@var{width}> <@var{addr}> <@var{nelems}>
9282
9283 Convert a Tcl array to memory locations and write the values
9284 @item @b{ocd_flash_banks} <@var{driver}> <@var{base}> <@var{size}> <@var{chip_width}> <@var{bus_width}> <@var{target}> [@option{driver options} ...]
9285
9286 Return information about the flash banks
9287
9288 @item @b{capture} <@var{command}>
9289
9290 Run <@var{command}> and return full log output that was produced during
9291 its execution. Example:
9292
9293 @example
9294 > capture "reset init"
9295 @end example
9296
9297 @end itemize
9298
9299 OpenOCD commands can consist of two words, e.g. "flash banks". The
9300 @file{startup.tcl} "unknown" proc will translate this into a Tcl proc
9301 called "flash_banks".
9302
9303 @section OpenOCD specific Global Variables
9304
9305 Real Tcl has ::tcl_platform(), and platform::identify, and many other
9306 variables. JimTCL, as implemented in OpenOCD creates $ocd_HOSTOS which
9307 holds one of the following values:
9308
9309 @itemize @bullet
9310 @item @b{cygwin} Running under Cygwin
9311 @item @b{darwin} Darwin (Mac-OS) is the underlying operating sytem.
9312 @item @b{freebsd} Running under FreeBSD
9313 @item @b{openbsd} Running under OpenBSD
9314 @item @b{netbsd} Running under NetBSD
9315 @item @b{linux} Linux is the underlying operating sytem
9316 @item @b{mingw32} Running under MingW32
9317 @item @b{winxx} Built using Microsoft Visual Studio
9318 @item @b{ecos} Running under eCos
9319 @item @b{other} Unknown, none of the above.
9320 @end itemize
9321
9322 Note: 'winxx' was choosen because today (March-2009) no distinction is made between Win32 and Win64.
9323
9324 @quotation Note
9325 We should add support for a variable like Tcl variable
9326 @code{tcl_platform(platform)}, it should be called
9327 @code{jim_platform} (because it
9328 is jim, not real tcl).
9329 @end quotation
9330
9331 @section Tcl RPC server
9332 @cindex RPC
9333
9334 OpenOCD provides a simple RPC server that allows to run arbitrary Tcl
9335 commands and receive the results.
9336
9337 To access it, your application needs to connect to a configured TCP port
9338 (see @command{tcl_port}). Then it can pass any string to the
9339 interpreter terminating it with @code{0x1a} and wait for the return
9340 value (it will be terminated with @code{0x1a} as well). This can be
9341 repeated as many times as desired without reopening the connection.
9342
9343 Remember that most of the OpenOCD commands need to be prefixed with
9344 @code{ocd_} to get the results back. Sometimes you might also need the
9345 @command{capture} command.
9346
9347 See @file{contrib/rpc_examples/} for specific client implementations.
9348
9349 @section Tcl RPC server notifications
9350 @cindex RPC Notifications
9351
9352 Notifications are sent asynchronously to other commands being executed over
9353 the RPC server, so the port must be polled continuously.
9354
9355 Target event, state and reset notifications are emitted as Tcl associative arrays
9356 in the following format.
9357
9358 @verbatim
9359 type target_event event [event-name]
9360 type target_state state [state-name]
9361 type target_reset mode [reset-mode]
9362 @end verbatim
9363
9364 @deffn {Command} tcl_notifications [on/off]
9365 Toggle output of target notifications to the current Tcl RPC server.
9366 Only available from the Tcl RPC server.
9367 Defaults to off.
9368
9369 @end deffn
9370
9371 @section Tcl RPC server trace output
9372 @cindex RPC trace output
9373
9374 Trace data is sent asynchronously to other commands being executed over
9375 the RPC server, so the port must be polled continuously.
9376
9377 Target trace data is emitted as a Tcl associative array in the following format.
9378
9379 @verbatim
9380 type target_trace data [trace-data-hex-encoded]
9381 @end verbatim
9382
9383 @deffn {Command} tcl_trace [on/off]
9384 Toggle output of target trace data to the current Tcl RPC server.
9385 Only available from the Tcl RPC server.
9386 Defaults to off.
9387
9388 See an example application here:
9389 @url{https://github.com/apmorton/OpenOcdTraceUtil} [OpenOcdTraceUtil]
9390
9391 @end deffn
9392
9393 @node FAQ
9394 @chapter FAQ
9395 @cindex faq
9396 @enumerate
9397 @anchor{faqrtck}
9398 @item @b{RTCK, also known as: Adaptive Clocking - What is it?}
9399 @cindex RTCK
9400 @cindex adaptive clocking
9401 @*
9402
9403 In digital circuit design it is often refered to as ``clock
9404 synchronisation'' the JTAG interface uses one clock (TCK or TCLK)
9405 operating at some speed, your CPU target is operating at another.
9406 The two clocks are not synchronised, they are ``asynchronous''
9407
9408 In order for the two to work together they must be synchronised
9409 well enough to work; JTAG can't go ten times faster than the CPU,
9410 for example. There are 2 basic options:
9411 @enumerate
9412 @item
9413 Use a special "adaptive clocking" circuit to change the JTAG
9414 clock rate to match what the CPU currently supports.
9415 @item
9416 The JTAG clock must be fixed at some speed that's enough slower than
9417 the CPU clock that all TMS and TDI transitions can be detected.
9418 @end enumerate
9419
9420 @b{Does this really matter?} For some chips and some situations, this
9421 is a non-issue, like a 500MHz ARM926 with a 5 MHz JTAG link;
9422 the CPU has no difficulty keeping up with JTAG.
9423 Startup sequences are often problematic though, as are other
9424 situations where the CPU clock rate changes (perhaps to save
9425 power).
9426
9427 For example, Atmel AT91SAM chips start operation from reset with
9428 a 32kHz system clock. Boot firmware may activate the main oscillator
9429 and PLL before switching to a faster clock (perhaps that 500 MHz
9430 ARM926 scenario).
9431 If you're using JTAG to debug that startup sequence, you must slow
9432 the JTAG clock to sometimes 1 to 4kHz. After startup completes,
9433 JTAG can use a faster clock.
9434
9435 Consider also debugging a 500MHz ARM926 hand held battery powered
9436 device that enters a low power ``deep sleep'' mode, at 32kHz CPU
9437 clock, between keystrokes unless it has work to do. When would
9438 that 5 MHz JTAG clock be usable?
9439
9440 @b{Solution #1 - A special circuit}
9441
9442 In order to make use of this,
9443 your CPU, board, and JTAG adapter must all support the RTCK
9444 feature. Not all of them support this; keep reading!
9445
9446 The RTCK ("Return TCK") signal in some ARM chips is used to help with
9447 this problem. ARM has a good description of the problem described at
9448 this link: @url{http://www.arm.com/support/faqdev/4170.html} [checked
9449 28/nov/2008]. Link title: ``How does the JTAG synchronisation logic
9450 work? / how does adaptive clocking work?''.
9451
9452 The nice thing about adaptive clocking is that ``battery powered hand
9453 held device example'' - the adaptiveness works perfectly all the
9454 time. One can set a break point or halt the system in the deep power
9455 down code, slow step out until the system speeds up.
9456
9457 Note that adaptive clocking may also need to work at the board level,
9458 when a board-level scan chain has multiple chips.
9459 Parallel clock voting schemes are good way to implement this,
9460 both within and between chips, and can easily be implemented
9461 with a CPLD.
9462 It's not difficult to have logic fan a module's input TCK signal out
9463 to each TAP in the scan chain, and then wait until each TAP's RTCK comes
9464 back with the right polarity before changing the output RTCK signal.
9465 Texas Instruments makes some clock voting logic available
9466 for free (with no support) in VHDL form; see
9467 @url{http://tiexpressdsp.com/index.php/Adaptive_Clocking}
9468
9469 @b{Solution #2 - Always works - but may be slower}
9470
9471 Often this is a perfectly acceptable solution.
9472
9473 In most simple terms: Often the JTAG clock must be 1/10 to 1/12 of
9474 the target clock speed. But what that ``magic division'' is varies
9475 depending on the chips on your board.
9476 @b{ARM rule of thumb} Most ARM based systems require an 6:1 division;
9477 ARM11 cores use an 8:1 division.
9478 @b{Xilinx rule of thumb} is 1/12 the clock speed.
9479
9480 Note: most full speed FT2232 based JTAG adapters are limited to a
9481 maximum of 6MHz. The ones using USB high speed chips (FT2232H)
9482 often support faster clock rates (and adaptive clocking).
9483
9484 You can still debug the 'low power' situations - you just need to
9485 either use a fixed and very slow JTAG clock rate ... or else
9486 manually adjust the clock speed at every step. (Adjusting is painful
9487 and tedious, and is not always practical.)
9488
9489 It is however easy to ``code your way around it'' - i.e.: Cheat a little,
9490 have a special debug mode in your application that does a ``high power
9491 sleep''. If you are careful - 98% of your problems can be debugged
9492 this way.
9493
9494 Note that on ARM you may need to avoid using the @emph{wait for interrupt}
9495 operation in your idle loops even if you don't otherwise change the CPU
9496 clock rate.
9497 That operation gates the CPU clock, and thus the JTAG clock; which
9498 prevents JTAG access. One consequence is not being able to @command{halt}
9499 cores which are executing that @emph{wait for interrupt} operation.
9500
9501 To set the JTAG frequency use the command:
9502
9503 @example
9504 # Example: 1.234MHz
9505 adapter_khz 1234
9506 @end example
9507
9508
9509 @item @b{Win32 Pathnames} Why don't backslashes work in Windows paths?
9510
9511 OpenOCD uses Tcl and a backslash is an escape char. Use @{ and @}
9512 around Windows filenames.
9513
9514 @example
9515 > echo \a
9516
9517 > echo @{\a@}
9518 \a
9519 > echo "\a"
9520
9521 >
9522 @end example
9523
9524
9525 @item @b{Missing: cygwin1.dll} OpenOCD complains about a missing cygwin1.dll.
9526
9527 Make sure you have Cygwin installed, or at least a version of OpenOCD that
9528 claims to come with all the necessary DLLs. When using Cygwin, try launching
9529 OpenOCD from the Cygwin shell.
9530
9531 @item @b{Breakpoint Issue} I'm trying to set a breakpoint using GDB (or a frontend like Insight or
9532 Eclipse), but OpenOCD complains that "Info: arm7_9_common.c:213
9533 arm7_9_add_breakpoint(): sw breakpoint requested, but software breakpoints not enabled".
9534
9535 GDB issues software breakpoints when a normal breakpoint is requested, or to implement
9536 source-line single-stepping. On ARMv4T systems, like ARM7TDMI, ARM720T or ARM920T,
9537 software breakpoints consume one of the two available hardware breakpoints.
9538
9539 @item @b{LPC2000 Flash} When erasing or writing LPC2000 on-chip flash, the operation fails at random.
9540
9541 Make sure the core frequency specified in the @option{flash lpc2000} line matches the
9542 clock at the time you're programming the flash. If you've specified the crystal's
9543 frequency, make sure the PLL is disabled. If you've specified the full core speed
9544 (e.g. 60MHz), make sure the PLL is enabled.
9545
9546 @item @b{Amontec Chameleon} When debugging using an Amontec Chameleon in its JTAG Accelerator configuration,
9547 I keep getting "Error: amt_jtagaccel.c:184 amt_wait_scan_busy(): amt_jtagaccel timed
9548 out while waiting for end of scan, rtck was disabled".
9549
9550 Make sure your PC's parallel port operates in EPP mode. You might have to try several
9551 settings in your PC BIOS (ECP, EPP, and different versions of those).
9552
9553 @item @b{Data Aborts} When debugging with OpenOCD and GDB (plain GDB, Insight, or Eclipse),
9554 I get lots of "Error: arm7_9_common.c:1771 arm7_9_read_memory():
9555 memory read caused data abort".
9556
9557 The errors are non-fatal, and are the result of GDB trying to trace stack frames
9558 beyond the last valid frame. It might be possible to prevent this by setting up
9559 a proper "initial" stack frame, if you happen to know what exactly has to
9560 be done, feel free to add this here.
9561
9562 @b{Simple:} In your startup code - push 8 registers of zeros onto the
9563 stack before calling main(). What GDB is doing is ``climbing'' the run
9564 time stack by reading various values on the stack using the standard
9565 call frame for the target. GDB keeps going - until one of 2 things
9566 happen @b{#1} an invalid frame is found, or @b{#2} some huge number of
9567 stackframes have been processed. By pushing zeros on the stack, GDB
9568 gracefully stops.
9569
9570 @b{Debugging Interrupt Service Routines} - In your ISR before you call
9571 your C code, do the same - artifically push some zeros onto the stack,
9572 remember to pop them off when the ISR is done.
9573
9574 @b{Also note:} If you have a multi-threaded operating system, they
9575 often do not @b{in the intrest of saving memory} waste these few
9576 bytes. Painful...
9577
9578
9579 @item @b{JTAG Reset Config} I get the following message in the OpenOCD console (or log file):
9580 "Warning: arm7_9_common.c:679 arm7_9_assert_reset(): srst resets test logic, too".
9581
9582 This warning doesn't indicate any serious problem, as long as you don't want to
9583 debug your core right out of reset. Your .cfg file specified @option{jtag_reset
9584 trst_and_srst srst_pulls_trst} to tell OpenOCD that either your board,
9585 your debugger or your target uC (e.g. LPC2000) can't assert the two reset signals
9586 independently. With this setup, it's not possible to halt the core right out of
9587 reset, everything else should work fine.
9588
9589 @item @b{USB Power} When using OpenOCD in conjunction with Amontec JTAGkey and the Yagarto
9590 toolchain (Eclipse, arm-elf-gcc, arm-elf-gdb), the debugging seems to be
9591 unstable. When single-stepping over large blocks of code, GDB and OpenOCD
9592 quit with an error message. Is there a stability issue with OpenOCD?
9593
9594 No, this is not a stability issue concerning OpenOCD. Most users have solved
9595 this issue by simply using a self-powered USB hub, which they connect their
9596 Amontec JTAGkey to. Apparently, some computers do not provide a USB power
9597 supply stable enough for the Amontec JTAGkey to be operated.
9598
9599 @b{Laptops running on battery have this problem too...}
9600
9601 @item @b{GDB Disconnects} When using the Amontec JTAGkey, sometimes OpenOCD crashes with the following
9602 error message: "Error: gdb_server.c:101 gdb_get_char(): read: 10054".
9603 What does that mean and what might be the reason for this?
9604
9605 Error code 10054 corresponds to WSAECONNRESET, which means that the debugger (GDB)
9606 has closed the connection to OpenOCD. This might be a GDB issue.
9607
9608 @item @b{LPC2000 Flash} In the configuration file in the section where flash device configurations
9609 are described, there is a parameter for specifying the clock frequency
9610 for LPC2000 internal flash devices (e.g. @option{flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2000
9611 0x0 0x40000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME lpc2000_v1 14746 calc_checksum}), which must be
9612 specified in kilohertz. However, I do have a quartz crystal of a
9613 frequency that contains fractions of kilohertz (e.g. 14,745,600 Hz,
9614 i.e. 14,745.600 kHz). Is it possible to specify real numbers for the
9615 clock frequency?
9616
9617 No. The clock frequency specified here must be given as an integral number.
9618 However, this clock frequency is used by the In-Application-Programming (IAP)
9619 routines of the LPC2000 family only, which seems to be very tolerant concerning
9620 the given clock frequency, so a slight difference between the specified clock
9621 frequency and the actual clock frequency will not cause any trouble.
9622
9623 @item @b{Command Order} Do I have to keep a specific order for the commands in the configuration file?
9624
9625 Well, yes and no. Commands can be given in arbitrary order, yet the
9626 devices listed for the JTAG scan chain must be given in the right
9627 order (jtag newdevice), with the device closest to the TDO-Pin being
9628 listed first. In general, whenever objects of the same type exist
9629 which require an index number, then these objects must be given in the
9630 right order (jtag newtap, targets and flash banks - a target
9631 references a jtag newtap and a flash bank references a target).
9632
9633 You can use the ``scan_chain'' command to verify and display the tap order.
9634
9635 Also, some commands can't execute until after @command{init} has been
9636 processed. Such commands include @command{nand probe} and everything
9637 else that needs to write to controller registers, perhaps for setting
9638 up DRAM and loading it with code.
9639
9640 @anchor{faqtaporder}
9641 @item @b{JTAG TAP Order} Do I have to declare the TAPS in some
9642 particular order?
9643
9644 Yes; whenever you have more than one, you must declare them in
9645 the same order used by the hardware.
9646
9647 Many newer devices have multiple JTAG TAPs. For example: ST
9648 Microsystems STM32 chips have two TAPs, a ``boundary scan TAP'' and
9649 ``Cortex-M3'' TAP. Example: The STM32 reference manual, Document ID:
9650 RM0008, Section 26.5, Figure 259, page 651/681, the ``TDI'' pin is
9651 connected to the boundary scan TAP, which then connects to the
9652 Cortex-M3 TAP, which then connects to the TDO pin.
9653
9654 Thus, the proper order for the STM32 chip is: (1) The Cortex-M3, then
9655 (2) The boundary scan TAP. If your board includes an additional JTAG
9656 chip in the scan chain (for example a Xilinx CPLD or FPGA) you could
9657 place it before or after the STM32 chip in the chain. For example:
9658
9659 @itemize @bullet
9660 @item OpenOCD_TDI(output) -> STM32 TDI Pin (BS Input)
9661 @item STM32 BS TDO (output) -> STM32 Cortex-M3 TDI (input)
9662 @item STM32 Cortex-M3 TDO (output) -> SM32 TDO Pin
9663 @item STM32 TDO Pin (output) -> Xilinx TDI Pin (input)
9664 @item Xilinx TDO Pin -> OpenOCD TDO (input)
9665 @end itemize
9666
9667 The ``jtag device'' commands would thus be in the order shown below. Note:
9668
9669 @itemize @bullet
9670 @item jtag newtap Xilinx tap -irlen ...
9671 @item jtag newtap stm32 cpu -irlen ...
9672 @item jtag newtap stm32 bs -irlen ...
9673 @item # Create the debug target and say where it is
9674 @item target create stm32.cpu -chain-position stm32.cpu ...
9675 @end itemize
9676
9677
9678 @item @b{SYSCOMP} Sometimes my debugging session terminates with an error. When I look into the
9679 log file, I can see these error messages: Error: arm7_9_common.c:561
9680 arm7_9_execute_sys_speed(): timeout waiting for SYSCOMP
9681
9682 TODO.
9683
9684 @end enumerate
9685
9686 @node Tcl Crash Course
9687 @chapter Tcl Crash Course
9688 @cindex Tcl
9689
9690 Not everyone knows Tcl - this is not intended to be a replacement for
9691 learning Tcl, the intent of this chapter is to give you some idea of
9692 how the Tcl scripts work.
9693
9694 This chapter is written with two audiences in mind. (1) OpenOCD users
9695 who need to understand a bit more of how Jim-Tcl works so they can do
9696 something useful, and (2) those that want to add a new command to
9697 OpenOCD.
9698
9699 @section Tcl Rule #1
9700 There is a famous joke, it goes like this:
9701 @enumerate
9702 @item Rule #1: The wife is always correct
9703 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
9704 @end enumerate
9705
9706 The Tcl equal is this:
9707
9708 @enumerate
9709 @item Rule #1: Everything is a string
9710 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
9711 @end enumerate
9712
9713 As in the famous joke, the consequences of Rule #1 are profound. Once
9714 you understand Rule #1, you will understand Tcl.
9715
9716 @section Tcl Rule #1b
9717 There is a second pair of rules.
9718 @enumerate
9719 @item Rule #1: Control flow does not exist. Only commands
9720 @* For example: the classic FOR loop or IF statement is not a control
9721 flow item, they are commands, there is no such thing as control flow
9722 in Tcl.
9723 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
9724 @* Actually what happens is this: There are commands that by
9725 convention, act like control flow key words in other languages. One of
9726 those commands is the word ``for'', another command is ``if''.
9727 @end enumerate
9728
9729 @section Per Rule #1 - All Results are strings
9730 Every Tcl command results in a string. The word ``result'' is used
9731 deliberatly. No result is just an empty string. Remember: @i{Rule #1 -
9732 Everything is a string}
9733
9734 @section Tcl Quoting Operators
9735 In life of a Tcl script, there are two important periods of time, the
9736 difference is subtle.
9737 @enumerate
9738 @item Parse Time
9739 @item Evaluation Time
9740 @end enumerate
9741
9742 The two key items here are how ``quoted things'' work in Tcl. Tcl has
9743 three primary quoting constructs, the [square-brackets] the
9744 @{curly-braces@} and ``double-quotes''
9745
9746 By now you should know $VARIABLES always start with a $DOLLAR
9747 sign. BTW: To set a variable, you actually use the command ``set'', as
9748 in ``set VARNAME VALUE'' much like the ancient BASIC langauge ``let x
9749 = 1'' statement, but without the equal sign.
9750
9751 @itemize @bullet
9752 @item @b{[square-brackets]}
9753 @* @b{[square-brackets]} are command substitutions. It operates much
9754 like Unix Shell `back-ticks`. The result of a [square-bracket]
9755 operation is exactly 1 string. @i{Remember Rule #1 - Everything is a
9756 string}. These two statements are roughly identical:
9757 @example
9758 # bash example
9759 X=`date`
9760 echo "The Date is: $X"
9761 # Tcl example
9762 set X [date]
9763 puts "The Date is: $X"
9764 @end example
9765 @item @b{``double-quoted-things''}
9766 @* @b{``double-quoted-things''} are just simply quoted
9767 text. $VARIABLES and [square-brackets] are expanded in place - the
9768 result however is exactly 1 string. @i{Remember Rule #1 - Everything
9769 is a string}
9770 @example
9771 set x "Dinner"
9772 puts "It is now \"[date]\", $x is in 1 hour"
9773 @end example
9774 @item @b{@{Curly-Braces@}}
9775 @*@b{@{Curly-Braces@}} are magic: $VARIABLES and [square-brackets] are
9776 parsed, but are NOT expanded or executed. @{Curly-Braces@} are like
9777 'single-quote' operators in BASH shell scripts, with the added
9778 feature: @{curly-braces@} can be nested, single quotes can not. @{@{@{this is
9779 nested 3 times@}@}@} NOTE: [date] is a bad example;
9780 at this writing, Jim/OpenOCD does not have a date command.
9781 @end itemize
9782
9783 @section Consequences of Rule 1/2/3/4
9784
9785 The consequences of Rule 1 are profound.
9786
9787 @subsection Tokenisation & Execution.
9788
9789 Of course, whitespace, blank lines and #comment lines are handled in
9790 the normal way.
9791
9792 As a script is parsed, each (multi) line in the script file is
9793 tokenised and according to the quoting rules. After tokenisation, that
9794 line is immedatly executed.
9795
9796 Multi line statements end with one or more ``still-open''
9797 @{curly-braces@} which - eventually - closes a few lines later.
9798
9799 @subsection Command Execution
9800
9801 Remember earlier: There are no ``control flow''
9802 statements in Tcl. Instead there are COMMANDS that simply act like
9803 control flow operators.
9804
9805 Commands are executed like this:
9806
9807 @enumerate
9808 @item Parse the next line into (argc) and (argv[]).
9809 @item Look up (argv[0]) in a table and call its function.
9810 @item Repeat until End Of File.
9811 @end enumerate
9812
9813 It sort of works like this:
9814 @example
9815 for(;;)@{
9816 ReadAndParse( &argc, &argv );
9817
9818 cmdPtr = LookupCommand( argv[0] );
9819
9820 (*cmdPtr->Execute)( argc, argv );
9821 @}
9822 @end example
9823
9824 When the command ``proc'' is parsed (which creates a procedure
9825 function) it gets 3 parameters on the command line. @b{1} the name of
9826 the proc (function), @b{2} the list of parameters, and @b{3} the body
9827 of the function. Not the choice of words: LIST and BODY. The PROC
9828 command stores these items in a table somewhere so it can be found by
9829 ``LookupCommand()''
9830
9831 @subsection The FOR command
9832
9833 The most interesting command to look at is the FOR command. In Tcl,
9834 the FOR command is normally implemented in C. Remember, FOR is a
9835 command just like any other command.
9836
9837 When the ascii text containing the FOR command is parsed, the parser
9838 produces 5 parameter strings, @i{(If in doubt: Refer to Rule #1)} they
9839 are:
9840
9841 @enumerate 0
9842 @item The ascii text 'for'
9843 @item The start text
9844 @item The test expression
9845 @item The next text
9846 @item The body text
9847 @end enumerate
9848
9849 Sort of reminds you of ``main( int argc, char **argv )'' does it not?
9850 Remember @i{Rule #1 - Everything is a string.} The key point is this:
9851 Often many of those parameters are in @{curly-braces@} - thus the
9852 variables inside are not expanded or replaced until later.
9853
9854 Remember that every Tcl command looks like the classic ``main( argc,
9855 argv )'' function in C. In JimTCL - they actually look like this:
9856
9857 @example
9858 int
9859 MyCommand( Jim_Interp *interp,
9860 int *argc,
9861 Jim_Obj * const *argvs );
9862 @end example
9863
9864 Real Tcl is nearly identical. Although the newer versions have
9865 introduced a byte-code parser and intepreter, but at the core, it
9866 still operates in the same basic way.
9867
9868 @subsection FOR command implementation
9869
9870 To understand Tcl it is perhaps most helpful to see the FOR
9871 command. Remember, it is a COMMAND not a control flow structure.
9872
9873 In Tcl there are two underlying C helper functions.
9874
9875 Remember Rule #1 - You are a string.
9876
9877 The @b{first} helper parses and executes commands found in an ascii
9878 string. Commands can be seperated by semicolons, or newlines. While
9879 parsing, variables are expanded via the quoting rules.
9880
9881 The @b{second} helper evaluates an ascii string as a numerical
9882 expression and returns a value.
9883
9884 Here is an example of how the @b{FOR} command could be
9885 implemented. The pseudo code below does not show error handling.
9886 @example
9887 void Execute_AsciiString( void *interp, const char *string );
9888
9889 int Evaluate_AsciiExpression( void *interp, const char *string );
9890
9891 int
9892 MyForCommand( void *interp,
9893 int argc,
9894 char **argv )
9895 @{
9896 if( argc != 5 )@{
9897 SetResult( interp, "WRONG number of parameters");
9898 return ERROR;
9899 @}
9900
9901 // argv[0] = the ascii string just like C
9902
9903 // Execute the start statement.
9904 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[1] );
9905
9906 // Top of loop test
9907 for(;;)@{
9908 i = Evaluate_AsciiExpression(interp, argv[2]);
9909 if( i == 0 )
9910 break;
9911
9912 // Execute the body
9913 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[3] );
9914
9915 // Execute the LOOP part
9916 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[4] );
9917 @}
9918
9919 // Return no error
9920 SetResult( interp, "" );
9921 return SUCCESS;
9922 @}
9923 @end example
9924
9925 Every other command IF, WHILE, FORMAT, PUTS, EXPR, everything works
9926 in the same basic way.
9927
9928 @section OpenOCD Tcl Usage
9929
9930 @subsection source and find commands
9931 @b{Where:} In many configuration files
9932 @* Example: @b{ source [find FILENAME] }
9933 @*Remember the parsing rules
9934 @enumerate
9935 @item The @command{find} command is in square brackets,
9936 and is executed with the parameter FILENAME. It should find and return
9937 the full path to a file with that name; it uses an internal search path.
9938 The RESULT is a string, which is substituted into the command line in
9939 place of the bracketed @command{find} command.
9940 (Don't try to use a FILENAME which includes the "#" character.
9941 That character begins Tcl comments.)
9942 @item The @command{source} command is executed with the resulting filename;
9943 it reads a file and executes as a script.
9944 @end enumerate
9945 @subsection format command
9946 @b{Where:} Generally occurs in numerous places.
9947 @* Tcl has no command like @b{printf()}, instead it has @b{format}, which is really more like
9948 @b{sprintf()}.
9949 @b{Example}
9950 @example
9951 set x 6
9952 set y 7
9953 puts [format "The answer: %d" [expr $x * $y]]
9954 @end example
9955 @enumerate
9956 @item The SET command creates 2 variables, X and Y.
9957 @item The double [nested] EXPR command performs math
9958 @* The EXPR command produces numerical result as a string.
9959 @* Refer to Rule #1
9960 @item The format command is executed, producing a single string
9961 @* Refer to Rule #1.
9962 @item The PUTS command outputs the text.
9963 @end enumerate
9964 @subsection Body or Inlined Text
9965 @b{Where:} Various TARGET scripts.
9966 @example
9967 #1 Good
9968 proc someproc @{@} @{
9969 ... multiple lines of stuff ...
9970 @}
9971 $_TARGETNAME configure -event FOO someproc
9972 #2 Good - no variables
9973 $_TARGETNAME confgure -event foo "this ; that;"
9974 #3 Good Curly Braces
9975 $_TARGETNAME configure -event FOO @{
9976 puts "Time: [date]"
9977 @}
9978 #4 DANGER DANGER DANGER
9979 $_TARGETNAME configure -event foo "puts \"Time: [date]\""
9980 @end example
9981 @enumerate
9982 @item The $_TARGETNAME is an OpenOCD variable convention.
9983 @*@b{$_TARGETNAME} represents the last target created, the value changes
9984 each time a new target is created. Remember the parsing rules. When
9985 the ascii text is parsed, the @b{$_TARGETNAME} becomes a simple string,
9986 the name of the target which happens to be a TARGET (object)
9987 command.
9988 @item The 2nd parameter to the @option{-event} parameter is a TCBODY
9989 @*There are 4 examples:
9990 @enumerate
9991 @item The TCLBODY is a simple string that happens to be a proc name
9992 @item The TCLBODY is several simple commands seperated by semicolons
9993 @item The TCLBODY is a multi-line @{curly-brace@} quoted string
9994 @item The TCLBODY is a string with variables that get expanded.
9995 @end enumerate
9996
9997 In the end, when the target event FOO occurs the TCLBODY is
9998 evaluated. Method @b{#1} and @b{#2} are functionally identical. For
9999 Method @b{#3} and @b{#4} it is more interesting. What is the TCLBODY?
10000
10001 Remember the parsing rules. In case #3, @{curly-braces@} mean the
10002 $VARS and [square-brackets] are expanded later, when the EVENT occurs,
10003 and the text is evaluated. In case #4, they are replaced before the
10004 ``Target Object Command'' is executed. This occurs at the same time
10005 $_TARGETNAME is replaced. In case #4 the date will never
10006 change. @{BTW: [date] is a bad example; at this writing,
10007 Jim/OpenOCD does not have a date command@}
10008 @end enumerate
10009 @subsection Global Variables
10010 @b{Where:} You might discover this when writing your own procs @* In
10011 simple terms: Inside a PROC, if you need to access a global variable
10012 you must say so. See also ``upvar''. Example:
10013 @example
10014 proc myproc @{ @} @{
10015 set y 0 #Local variable Y
10016 global x #Global variable X
10017 puts [format "X=%d, Y=%d" $x $y]
10018 @}
10019 @end example
10020 @section Other Tcl Hacks
10021 @b{Dynamic variable creation}
10022 @example
10023 # Dynamically create a bunch of variables.
10024 for @{ set x 0 @} @{ $x < 32 @} @{ set x [expr $x + 1]@} @{
10025 # Create var name
10026 set vn [format "BIT%d" $x]
10027 # Make it a global
10028 global $vn
10029 # Set it.
10030 set $vn [expr (1 << $x)]
10031 @}
10032 @end example
10033 @b{Dynamic proc/command creation}
10034 @example
10035 # One "X" function - 5 uart functions.
10036 foreach who @{A B C D E@}
10037 proc [format "show_uart%c" $who] @{ @} "show_UARTx $who"
10038 @}
10039 @end example
10040
10041 @include fdl.texi
10042
10043 @node OpenOCD Concept Index
10044 @comment DO NOT use the plain word ``Index'', reason: CYGWIN filename
10045 @comment case issue with ``Index.html'' and ``index.html''
10046 @comment Occurs when creating ``--html --no-split'' output
10047 @comment This fix is based on: http://sourceware.org/ml/binutils/2006-05/msg00215.html
10048 @unnumbered OpenOCD Concept Index
10049
10050 @printindex cp
10051
10052 @node Command and Driver Index
10053 @unnumbered Command and Driver Index
10054 @printindex fn
10055
10056 @bye

Linking to existing account procedure

If you already have an account and want to add another login method you MUST first sign in with your existing account and then change URL to read https://review.openocd.org/login/?link to get to this page again but this time it'll work for linking. Thank you.

SSH host keys fingerprints

1024 SHA256:YKx8b7u5ZWdcbp7/4AeXNaqElP49m6QrwfXaqQGJAOk gerrit-code-review@openocd.zylin.com (DSA)
384 SHA256:jHIbSQa4REvwCFG4cq5LBlBLxmxSqelQPem/EXIrxjk gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
521 SHA256:UAOPYkU9Fjtcao0Ul/Rrlnj/OsQvt+pgdYSZ4jOYdgs gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
256 SHA256:A13M5QlnozFOvTllybRZH6vm7iSt0XLxbA48yfc2yfY gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
256 SHA256:spYMBqEYoAOtK7yZBrcwE8ZpYt6b68Cfh9yEVetvbXg gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ED25519)
+--[ED25519 256]--+
|=..              |
|+o..   .         |
|*.o   . .        |
|+B . . .         |
|Bo. = o S        |
|Oo.+ + =         |
|oB=.* = . o      |
| =+=.+   + E     |
|. .=o   . o      |
+----[SHA256]-----+
2048 SHA256:0Onrb7/PHjpo6iVZ7xQX2riKN83FJ3KGU0TvI0TaFG4 gerrit-code-review@openocd.zylin.com (RSA)